Ib 0600871 Engk
Ib 0600871 Engk
Ib 0600871 Engk
INVERTER
FR-E800
FR-E800
Instruction Manual (Communication)
Compact, high functionality inverters
FR-E800 Instruction
Model
Manual (Communication)
HEAD OFFICE: TOKYO BUILDING 2-7-3, MARUNOUCHI, CHIYODA-KU, TOKYO 100-8310, JAPAN
CONTENTS
2.1 Outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
2.2 Wiring. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
2.5.1 Outline. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
2.5.2 CC-Link IE TSN configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
2.5.3 Initial setting for CC-Link IE TSN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
2.5.4 Parameters related to CC-Link IE TSN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
2.6.1 Outline. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
2.6.2 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
2.6.3 Initial setting for CC-Link IE Field Network Basic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
2.6.4 Parameters related to CC-Link IE Field Network Basic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
2.6.5 Group number setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
2.7 MODBUS/TCP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
2.7.1 Outline. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
2.7.2 Initial setting for MODBUS/TCP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
2.7.3 Parameters related to MODBUS/TCP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
1
2.10.3 Parameters related to SLMP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
2
Chapter 4 Other Communication Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
CONTENTS
Chapter 6 Appendix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
3
4
CHAPTER 1
CHAPTER 1 Introduction
4
10
5
1 Introduction
The contents described in this chapter must be read before using this product.
Always read the instructions before use.
Abbreviations
Item Description
Operation panel, parameter unit (FR-PU07), LCD operation panel (FR-LU08), and enclosure surface
PU
operation panel (FR-PA07)
Parameter unit (FR-PU07), LCD operation panel (FR-LU08), and enclosure surface operation panel
Parameter unit
(FR-PA07)
Inverter Mitsubishi Electric FR-E800 series inverter
E800 Standard model (RS-485 + SIL2/PLd functional safety)
E800-E Ethernet model (Ethernet + SIL2/PLd functional safety)
E800-SCE Safety communication model (Ethernet + SIL3/PLe functional safety)
FM type inverter Standard model with terminal FM (pulse output)
AM type inverter Standard model with terminal AM (voltage output)
Vector control compatible option FR-A8AP E kit
Pr. Parameter number (Number assigned to function)
PU operation Operation using the PU (operation panel / parameter unit)
External operation Operation using the control circuit signals
Combined operation Combined operation using the PU (operation panel / parameter unit) and External operation
Mitsubishi Electric standard
SF-JR
efficiency motor
Mitsubishi Electric constant-torque
SF-HRCA
motor
Mitsubishi Electric high-
SF-PR
performance energy-saving motor
Mitsubishi Electric high-
performance energy-saving motor SF-PR-SC
with encoder
Mitsubishi Electric Vector control
SF-V5RU
dedicated motor
Mitsubishi Electric geared motor GM-[]
Mitsubishi Electric inverter-driven
geared motor for encoder feedback GM-DZ, GM-DP
control
Mitsubishi Electric PM motor MM-GKR, EM-A
D E F G H I J K L M N O P
Q R S T U V W X Y Z - _
Trademarks
• MODBUS is a registered trademark of SCHNEIDER ELECTRIC USA, INC.
• BACnet is a registered trademark of the American Society of Heating, Refrigerating and Air-Conditioning Engineers
(ASHRAE).
• DeviceNet and EtherNet/IP are registered trademarks of ODVA (Open DeviceNet Vendor Association, INC).
• PROFIBUS and PROFINET are either trademarks or registered trademarks of PROFIBUS & PROFINET International.
• CC-Link IE TSN and CC-Link IE Field Network Basic are registered trademarks of CC-Link Partner Association.
• EtherCAT® is registered trademark and patented technology, licensed by Beckhoff Automation GmbH, Germany.
6 1. Introduction
• Other company and product names herein are the trademarks and registered trademarks of their respective owners.
3
Precautions
• Some of the communication protocols and the plug-in options cannot be used together as shown in the following table. For
the application and protocol settings, refer to page 223. 4
6
CC-Link IE TSN
EtherNet/IP
PROFINET
BACnet/IP
EtherCAT
CC-Link IE TSN — × × × × ×
9
CC-Link IE Field Network Basic × — × ×
BACnet/IP — × ×
EtherNet/IP × — × × 10
PROFINET × × × — ×
EtherCAT × × × × × — × × ×
CC-Link (when the FR-A8NC E kit is installed) × × × — × ×
PROFIBUS-DP (when the FR-A8NP E kit is
× × — ×
installed)
DeviceNet (when the FR-A8ND E kit is installed) × × × —
NOTE
• FR Configurator2 can be used for any communication protocol or plug-in option.
1. Introduction
7
1.1 Product checking
Inverter model
FR-E8 2 0 - 0008 E PA
A B C D E F
Rating plate
Inverter model MODEL :FR-E820-0008EPA
Input rating INPUT :XXXXX
SERIAL SERIAL:XXXXXXXXXXX
• D: The communication type and the functional safety specification are shown.
Symbol Communication / functional safety
None Standard model (RS-485 + SIL2/PLd)
E Ethernet model (Ethernet + SIL2/PLd)
SCE Safety communication model (Ethernet + SIL3/PLe)
8 1. Introduction
1.1 Product checking
• E: The output specification for monitoring and the rated frequency are shown for the standard model, and the
communication protocol group is shown for the Ethernet model and the safety communication model. The control logic is
fixed to the source logic for the safety communication model.
1
Rated Control logic
Symbol Monitoring/protocol specification frequency
(initial setting)
Input signal
(initial status)
Safety stop
signal
2
-1 Pulse (terminal FM) 60 Hz Sink logic
-4 Voltage (terminal AM) 50 Hz Source logic
-5 Voltage (terminal AM) 60 Hz Sink logic 3
Protocol group A (CC-Link IE TSN, CC-Link IE Field Network Basic,
PA 60 Hz Sink logic Source logic
MODBUS/TCP, EtherNet/IP, and BACnet/IP)
(fixed)
Protocol group B (CC-Link IE TSN, CC-Link IE Field Network Basic, Sink logic / source
PB
MODBUS/TCP, PROFINET)
50 Hz
logic*1 4
Sink logic / source
PC*2 Protocol group C (EtherCAT) 50 Hz
logic*1
*1 The initial status of the control logic differs depending on the inverter model.
Sink logic for the models indicated with the applicable motor capacity (kW)
5
Source logic for the models indicated with the rated current (A)
*2 Available for the Ethernet model only.
6
• F: Availability of circuit board coating / plated conductors is shown.
Symbol Circuit board coating*1 Plated conductor
None Without coating Without plated conductors 7
-60 With coating Without plated conductors
-06*2 With coating With plated conductors
NOTE
• In this Instruction Manual, the inverter model name consists of the applicable motor capacity and the rated current. 9
(Example) FR-E820-0008(0.1K)
1. Introduction
1.1 Product checking
9
1.2 Related manuals
When using this inverter for the first time, prepare the following manuals as required and use the inverter safely. The latest
version of e-Manual Viewer and the latest PDF manuals can be downloaded from the Mitsubishi Electric FA Global Website.
https://www.mitsubishielectric.com/app/fa/download/search.do?kisyu=/inv&mode=manual
• e-Manual refers to the Mitsubishi FA electronic book manuals that can be browsed using a dedicated tool.
• e-Manual has the following features:
Required information can be cross-searched in multiple manuals.
Pages that users often browse can be bookmarked.
Manuals related to the FR-E800 inverter are shown in the following table.
FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Connection) Manuals describing installation, wiring, specifications, outline
FR-E860 Instruction Manual (Connection) dimensions, standards, and how to connect options.
10 1. Introduction
1.2 Related manuals
CHAPTER 2
CHAPTER 2 Ethernet Communication
4
11
2 Ethernet Communication
2.1 Outline
Ethernet communication is available for the Ethernet model and the safety communication model.
*1 While "1 (initial value)" is set in Pr.1399 Inverter identification enable/disable selection, this LED blinks when the MAC/IP address of the
inverter match to the MAC/IP address specified by using engineering software such as FR Configurator2.
12 2. Ethernet Communication
2.1 Outline
2.2 Wiring 1
4. Connect the programmable controller (master) and the inverters with Ethernet cables. (Refer to page 15.) 4
Programmable
controller (master) Inverter Inverter 5
Ethernet cable
Power
supply
M Power
supply
M
7
NOTE
• Refer to the Master Module User's Manual for detailed network configurations.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.2 Wiring
13
• Recommended products (as of October 2020)
Model Manufacturer
SC-E5EW series*1 Mitsubishi Electric System & Service Co., Ltd.
*1 SC-E5EW cable is for in-enclosure and indoor uses. SC-E5EW-L cable is for outdoor use.
NOTE
• Depending on the cable connector shape, the cable may not be connected to the inverter.
Hubs
Use hubs that meet the following conditions. Operation is not guaranteed if the hubs do not meet these conditions.
• Compliance with the IEEE 802.3 (100BASE-TX)
• Support of the auto MDI/MDI-X function
• Support of the auto-negotiation function
• Switching hub (layer 2 switch)*1
*1 A repeater hub is not available.
NOTE
• A general-purpose switching hub cannot be used for EtherCAT communication. For star or ring topology, use an EtherCAT
branch slave.
14 2. Ethernet Communication
2.2 Wiring
2.3 Ethernet cable connection 1
This section explains Ethernet cable connection and the relevant precautions. For the details of the network configuration and
the cables and hubs used for wiring, refer to page 13 onwards. 2
7
Reinstallation
1. Turn OFF the power of the programmable controller and the inverter.
8
2. Remove the inverter front cover.
3. Check the orientation of the connectors. Insert the connector part of the Ethernet cable to the communication
connector until it clicks.
9
Removal
1. Turn OFF the power of the programmable controller and the inverter. 10
2. Remove the inverter front cover.
3. Hold down the latch on the Ethernet cable connector, and pull out the cable while holding the latch.
NOTE
• For PROFINET communication, refer to page 169.
• For EtherCAT communication, refer to page 194.
• There is no need to distinguish between PORT1 and PORT2 on the inverter (except for PROFINET and EtherCAT).
• When only one connector is used in star topology, either PORT1 or PORT2 is applicable.
• When using two connectors for line topology, an Ethernet cable can be connected to the connectors in any combination. For
example, the cable can be connected across two of PORT1 or across PORT1 and PORT2.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.3 Ethernet cable connection
15
Connection between Connection between
PORT1 and PORT1, PORT2 and PORT2 PORT1 and PORT2
Connector for Connector for Connector for Connector for Connector for Connector for Connector for Connector for
communication communication communication communication communication communication communication communication
(PORT1) (PORT2) (PORT1) (PORT2) (PORT1) (PORT2) (PORT1) (PORT2)
Network configuration
Check the network configuration before wiring, and perform correct wiring. For example, using ring topology for the FR-E800-
(SC)EPA or FR-E800-(SC)EPB may cause system failure.
16 2. Ethernet Communication
2.3 Ethernet cable connection
2.4 Initial setting for Ethernet communication 1
Use the following parameters to perform required settings for Ethernet communication between the inverter and other devices.
To make communication between other devices and the inverter, perform the initial settings of the inverter parameters to match 2
the communication specifications of the devices. Data communication cannot be made if the initial settings are not made or if
there is any setting error.
Initial Setting
3
Pr. Name Description
value range
1434
IP address 1 (Ethernet) 192
N600*1*2 4
1435
IP address 2 (Ethernet) 168
N601*1*2
0 to 255 Enter the IP address of the inverter to be connected to Ethernet.
1436
N602 *1*2 IP address 3 (Ethernet) 50 5
1437
IP address 4 (Ethernet) 1
N603*1*2
*1 The setting is applied after an inverter reset or next power-ON. 6
*2 The setting is not available for the FR-E800-EPC.
* * * . * * * . * * * . * * *
9
10
2. Ethernet Communication
2.4 Initial setting for Ethernet communication
17
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
2.5.1 Outline
Data can be transmitted to IT systems while performing real-time cyclic communication control.
Some functions are not supported depending on the date of manufacture of the inverter. For details of specification changes,
refer to page 284.
Communication specifications
The communication specification varies depending on the specification of the master.
Item Description
Communication speed 100 Mbps (10 Mbps is not supported.)
Authentication class A (Compatible with protocol versions 2.0*1 and 1.0)
Cycle time*2 5000 to 6400000 μs
NOTE
• To use the CC-Link IE TSN, do not install the FR-A8NC E kit to the inverter. (Installing the FR-A8NC E kit disables CC-Link
IE TSN.)
18 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
Operation status LEDs
LED name Description LED status Remarks 1
OFF Power-OFF
Blinking green Data transmission not performed
NS Communication status Solid green
Blinking red
Data transmission in progress
Communication interrupted
2
Solid red Duplicate IP address detected
OFF Power-OFF / during inverter reset
MS Inverter status Green Operating properly 3
Red Fault detected
OFF Power-OFF/link-down
LINK1 Connector for communication (PORT1) status Blinking green
Solid green
Link-up (Data reception in progress)
Link-up
4
OFF Power-OFF/link-down
LINK2 Connector for communication (PORT2) status Blinking green Link-up (Data reception in progress)
Solid green Link-up 5
Combination with the master station
When all remote stations are authentication class A products 6
Master station
Master station communication Network configuration
speed
• Line topology / star topology / combination of line topology and star
7
• MELSEC iQ-R series master/local module topology*1
RJ71GN11-T2, RJ71GN11-EIP 1 Gbps • Connection sequence: Master station → Remote station
• MELSEC iQ-F series master/local module
FX5-CCLGN-MS
(communication speed: 1 Gbps) → General-purpose switching
hub*2 → Remote station (communication speed: 100 Mbps)
8
• Master station that supports both 1 Gbps and 100 • Line topology / star topology / combination of line topology and star
Mbps communication speeds 100 Mbps topology
• Remote station (communication speed: 100 Mbps)
• Line topology / star topology / combination of line topology and star
9
topology*1
• MELSEC iQ-R series Motion module 1 Gbps • Connection sequence: Master station → Remote station
RD78G[]/GH[] (communication speed: 1 Gbps) → General-purpose switching 10
• MELSEC iQ-F series Motion module hub*2 → Remote station (communication speed: 100 Mbps)
FX5-[]SSC-G • Line topology / star topology / combination of line topology and star
100 Mbps topology
• Remote station (communication speed: 100 Mbps)
When both authentication class B and class A products are used as remote stations
Master station
Master station communication Network configuration
speed
• Line topology / star topology / combination of line topology and star
topology*1
• MELSEC iQ-R series master/local module • Connection sequence: Master station → Remote station
1 Gbps
RJ71GN11-T2, RJ71GN11-EIP (authentication class B, communication speed: 1 Gbps) → General-
• MELSEC iQ-F series master/local module purpose switching hub*2 → Remote station (authentication class A,
FX5-CCLGN-MS communication speed: 100 Mbps)
• Master station that supports both 1 Gbps and 100 • Line topology / star topology / combination of line topology and star
Mbps communication speeds topology
100 Mbps
• Connection sequence: Master station → Remote station
(authentication class B) → Remote station (authentication class A)
• Line topology / star topology / combination of line topology and star
topology*1
• Connection sequence: Master station → Remote station
1 Gbps
• MELSEC iQ-R series Motion module (authentication class B, communication speed: 1 Gbps) → General-
RD78G[]/GH[] purpose switching hub*2 → Remote station (authentication class A,
• MELSEC iQ-F series Motion module communication speed: 100 Mbps)
FX5-[]SSC-G • Line topology / star topology / combination of line topology and star
topology
100 Mbps
• Connection sequence: Master station → Remote station
(authentication class B) → Remote station (authentication class A)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
19
*1 Line topology is available for the products whose communication speed settings are the same.
*2 Use the product that supports 1 Gbps / 100 Mbps.
NOTE
• When all remote stations are authentication class A products, up to 120 units can be connected.
20 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
Compatible firmware version of the master station
Model
Compatible with protocol Compatible with protocol 1
version 2.0 version 1.0
RJ71GN11-T2 15 or later 12 or later
RJ71GN11-EIP 01 or later
FX5-CCLGN-MS 1.010 or later 1.001 or later 2
RD78G[]/GH[] 20 or later
FX5-[]SSC-G 1.002 or later
Related manuals
For details of network configurations, refer to the Master Module User's Manual. 7
Name Manual number
MELSEC iQ-R CC-Link IE TSN User's Manual (Startup) SH-082127ENG
MELSEC iQ-R CC-Link IE TSN User's Manual (Application) SH-082129ENG 8
MELSEC iQ-F FX5 User's Manual (CC-Link IE TSN) SH-082215ENG
MELSEC iQ-R Motion Module User's Manual (Startup) IB-0300406ENG
MELSEC iQ-R Motion Module User's Manual (Application) IB-0300411ENG
9
2.5.2 CC-Link IE TSN configuration
Procedure 10
The following shows the procedure to connect the inverter with a Mitsubishi Electric master device.
Before communication
1. Connect each unit with an Ethernet cable. (Refer to page 15.)
3. Set "45238" (CC-Link IE TSN) in any of Pr.1427 to Pr.1430 Ethernet function selection 1 to 4. (Refer to page 27.)
In the initial status, Pr.1429 = "45238" (CC-Link IE TSN) and setting is not required.
Registering a profile
1. Start the engineering software (GX Works3).
2. On the menu bar, select [Tool] > [Profile Management] > [Register...].
3. Select a CSP+ file to be registered on the "Register Profile" screen, and click the [Register] button.
NOTE
• A profile is a compressed file (such as *.zip, *.ipar, and *.cspp). Register a profile without decompressing the file.
• Profile registration is not required for the next time onwards.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
21
Creating a project file
1. For information on creating and opening a project, go to [Help] > [GX Works3 Help].
Detecting an Inverter
Detection is not possible when the data link is not established with the master module. For details, refer to the Master Module
User's Manual.
1. In the "Navigation" window, select [Parameter] > [Module Information] then select the module name.
3. In the "Setting Item" window, go to [Network Configuration Settings] then click next to the [Detailed Setting] field.
22 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
5. Read the cautions in the "Connected/Disconnected Module Detection" window and click [Execute].
6. The FR-E800-E or the FR-E800-SCE will appear on the screen when it is detected. (FR-E800-E inverters are
4
displayed in the following example.) Click [Close with Reflecting the Setting] to close the window.
Host Station
8
10
2. In the "Setting Item" window, go to [Network Configuration Settings] then click next to the [Detailed Setting] field.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
23
3. In the "CC-Link IE TSN Configuration" window, set "Low-Speed" for [Communication Period Setting].
4. Set "1000.00 μs" (initial value) for [Communication Period Interval Setting (Do not Set it in Units of 1us)].
• When RJ71GN11-T2 is the master
Set "20.00 μs" (initial value) for [System Reservation Time].
Consider the scaling factor in [Multiple Period Setting] - [Low-Speed] to change the settings for [Basic Period Setting]. Refer to
the following examples.
[Communication Period Interval Setting] = "5000.00 μs" / "16 (initial value)" (minimum value)
[System Reservation Time] = "200.00 μs" / "16 (initial value)" (minimum value)
5. Set "Mixture of Authentication Class B/A or Authentication Class A Only" for [Authentication Class Setting].
24 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
7. Set "1 Gbps" for [Communication Speed].
2
System setting window (communication speed setting of the master: 100 Mbps)
1. Select [Basic Settings] in the "Setting Item List" window. 3
6
2. In the "Setting Item" window, go to [Network Configuration Settings] then click next to the [Detailed Setting] field.
7
3. In the "CC-Link IE TSN Configuration" window, set "Basic Period" for [Communication Period Setting]. When
[Multiple Period Setting] is used, set "Normal-Speed" or "Low-Speed".
9
10
4. Set "5000.00 μs" or larger value for [Communication Period Interval Setting (Do not Set it in Units of 1us)]. Set
"200.00 μs" for [System Reservation Time].
Consider the scaling factor in [Multiple Period Setting] - [Normal-Speed] or [Low-Speed] to change the settings for [Basic Period
Setting]. Refer to the following examples.
[Communication Period Interval Setting] = "5000.00 μs" / "16 (initial value for [Low-Speed])" (minimum value)
[System Reservation Time] = "200.00 μs" / "16 (initial value for [Low-Speed])" (minimum value)
5. Set "Mixture of Authentication Class B/A or Authentication Class A Only" for [Authentication Class Setting].
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
25
6. Select [Application Settings] in the "Setting Item List" window.
Checking communication
The following table shows the status of the LEDs when communication is established between the programmable controller
and the inverter. Check the "CC-Link IE TSN/CC-Link IE Field Diagnostics" window to confirm that the communication is
established between them.
NS MS LINK1 LINK2
Solid green Solid green *1
Blinking green
*1 The LED on either LINK1 or LINK2 will blink depending on the port (port 1 or 2) the Ethernet cable is connected to.
NOTE
• If the FR-E800-(SC)E cannot be detected, on the menu bar select [Diagnostics (D)] → [CC-Link IE TSN/CC-Link IE Field
Diagnostics]. The "CC-Link IE TSN/CC-Link IE Field Diagnostics" window will be displayed. Broken or disconnected wires can
be detected.
• The network configuration diagram is displayed in star topology even if the devices are connected in line topology.
XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX
26 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
2.5.3 Initial setting for CC-Link IE TSN 1
Use the following parameters to perform required settings for Ethernet communication between the inverter and other devices.
To make communication between other devices and the inverter, perform the initial settings of the inverter parameters to match
the communication specifications of the devices. Data communication cannot be made if the initial settings are not made or if 2
there is any setting error.
Initial
Pr. Name
value
Setting range Description 3
1210 CC-Link IE TSN protocol
0 0, 9999 Set the CC-Link IE TSN protocol version.
N120*1 version selection
1427
N630*1
Ethernet function
selection 1
5001 4
502, 5000 to 5002, 5006
1428 Ethernet function
45237 to 5008, 5010 to 5013,
N631*1 selection 2
1429 Ethernet function
45238
9999, 34962*3, 44818*2, Set the application, protocol, etc.
45237, 45238, 47808*2,
5
N632*1 selection 3
61450
1430 Ethernet function
9999
N633*1 selection 4
6
*1 The setting is applied after an inverter reset or next power-ON.
*2 The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPA and the FR-E800-SCEPA.
*3 The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPB and the FR-E800-SCEPB.
9
CC-Link IE TSN protocol version selection (Pr.1210)
• Set the CC-Link IE TSN protocol version.
Pr.1210 setting Description
10
0 (initial value) Protocol version 2.0
9999 Protocol version 1.0
NOTE
• When the setting is changed after the communication is established, also reset the master station.
• When the protocol version 2.0 is used, the master station also must be compatible with the protocol version 2.0.
1426 Link speed and duplex mode Set the communication speed and the communication
0 0 to 4
N641*1 selection mode (full-duplex/half-duplex).
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
27
Pr. Name Initial value Setting range Description
1442
IP filter address 1 (Ethernet) 0
N660*1
1443
IP filter address 2 (Ethernet) 0
N661*1
0 to 255
1444
*1 IP filter address 3 (Ethernet) 0
N662
1445 Set the range of connectable IP addresses for the
*1 IP filter address 4 (Ethernet) 0 network devices. (When Pr.1442 to Pr.1445 = "0 (initial
N663 value)", the function is invalid.)
1446 IP filter address 2 range
9999
N664*1 specification (Ethernet)
1447 IP filter address 3 range
9999 0 to 255, 9999
N665*1 specification (Ethernet)
1448 IP filter address 4 range
9999
N666*1 specification (Ethernet)
5*2, 100*2, 12288 to
13787, 20488,
20489, 24672, Set the index number for inverter parameters, inverter
1320 to
User Defined Cyclic 24689, 24698, control parameters, and CiA402 drive profile. Functions
1329
Communication Input 1 to 10 9999 24703, 24705, can be assigned to remote registers RWwn+4 to
N810 to
Mapping 24707, 24708, RWwn+17 when Pr.544 = "38".
N819*1
24719, 24721,
24728 to 24730
9999 Function disabled
*2 *2
6 , 101 , 12288 to
13787, 16384 to
16483, 20488,
20489, 20981 to
Set the index number for inverter parameters, monitor
1330 to 20990, 20992*3,
User Defined Cyclic data, inverter control parameters, and CiA402 drive
1343 24639, 24643,
Communication Output 1 to 14 9999 profile. Functions can be assigned to remote registers
N850 to 24644, 24673 to
Mapping RWrn+4 to RWrn+1F when Pr.544 = "38".
N863*1 24676, 24692,
24695, 24820,
24826, 24828,
25858
9999 Function disabled
Pr.1389 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the index
User Defined Cyclic
0 to 2, 256 to 258, number is specified using Pr.1320
1389*1 Communication Input Sub 1 0
512 to 514 Pr.1389 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the index
and 2 Mapping
number is specified using Pr.1321
Pr.1390 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the index
User Defined Cyclic
0 to 2, 256 to 258, number is specified using Pr.1322
1390*1 Communication Input Sub 3 0
512 to 514 Pr.1390 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the index
and 4 Mapping
number is specified using Pr.1323
Pr.1391 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the index
User Defined Cyclic
0 to 2, 256 to 258, number is specified using Pr.1324
1391*1 Communication Input Sub 5 0
512 to 514 Pr.1391 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the index
and 6 Mapping
number is specified using Pr.1325
Pr.1392 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the index
User Defined Cyclic
0 to 2, 256 to 258, number is specified using Pr.1326
1392*1 Communication Input Sub 7 0
512 to 514 Pr.1392 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the index
and 8 Mapping
number is specified using Pr.1327
Pr.1393 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the index
User Defined Cyclic
0 to 2, 256 to 258, number is specified using Pr.1328
1393*1 Communication Input Sub 9 0
512 to 514 Pr.1393 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the index
and 10 Mapping
number is specified using Pr.1329
28 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
Pr. Name Initial value Setting range Description
804 Torque command source In the torque control mode, the torque command source
0 0, 1, 3 to 6
D400 selection can be selected.
810 Torque limit input method 6
0 0 to 2 The torque limit input method can be selected.
H700 selection
*1 The setting is applied after an inverter reset or next power-ON.
*2
*3
The setting is available for the FR-E800-EPB and the FR-E800-SCEPB, but the function is disabled.
Available for the Ethernet model only.
7
Precautions for CC-Link IE TSN communication
• For CC-Link IE TSN, do not change initial values of Pr.1449 to Pr.1454 used to specify the Ethernet IP address range for 8
command source selection as the IP address is not used. Setting a value other than the initial value in any of the above
parameters may cause an Ethernet communication fault (E.EHR). If the fault occurs, reset the setting of the relevant
parameter to the initial value, or set "9999" in Pr.1432 Ethernet communication check time interval. 9
CC-Link extended setting (Pr.544)
• Use this parameter to select the function of the remote registers for the CC-Link IE TSN.
10
Pr.544 setting Description
0 (initial value), 1, 12, 14, 18 Compatible with the octuple setting of CC-Link Ver.2
Compatible with the octuple setting of CC-Link Ver.2, user defined cyclic
38
communication data selected
100, 112, 114, 118 Compatible with the octuple setting of CC-Link Ver.2
Compatible with the octuple setting of CC-Link Ver.2, PLC function*1
138
user defined cyclic communication data selected
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
29
• Relationship between the start command and sign (Pr.541 = "1")
Start Sign of the frequency Actual operation
command command command
Forward + Forward rotation
rotation - Reverse rotation
Reverse + Reverse rotation
rotation - Forward rotation
NOTE
• When Pr.541 = "1" (with sign)
• When EEPROM write is specified by turning ON of RYE, write mode error (error code H01) will occur.
• When both RYD and RYE are turned ON, RYD has precedence.
• When power is turned ON (inverter reset), the initial setting status of the sign bit is "positive" and the set frequency is 0 Hz.
(The motor does not operate at the frequency set before turning OFF the power (inverter reset).)
• When set frequency is written with the instruction code of HED or HEE, the sign of the frequency command is not changed.
30 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
*1 These signals are set in the initial setting. Using Pr.180 to Pr.183, input signals assigned to the device numbers can be changed.
For details of Pr.180 to Pr.183, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*2 The signals are fixed. They cannot be changed using parameters. 1
*3 These signals are set in the initial setting. Using Pr.190 to Pr.192, output signals assigned to the device numbers can be changed.
For details of Pr.190 to Pr.192, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*4 Output signals can be assigned using Pr.313 to Pr.315.
*5
For details, refer to the description of Pr.313 to Pr.315 (Output terminal function selection) in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
Input signals can be assigned using Pr.184 to Pr.189.
2
For details, refer to the description of Pr.184 to Pr.189 (Input terminal function selection) in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*6 Output signals can be assigned using Pr.193 to Pr.196.
*7
For details, refer to the description of Pr.193 to Pr.196 (Output terminal function selection) in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
"n" indicates a value determined by the station number.
3
• Remote registers
Description Refer to Description Refer to
4
Address*5 Address*5
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page
RWwn Monitor code 2 Monitor code 1 36 RWrn First monitor value*3 38
RWwn+1 Set frequency (0.01 Hz increments)*2 36 RWrn+1 Second monitor value*3 38 5
Link parameter
RWwn+2 Instruction code 36 RWrn+2 Reply code 2 Reply code 1 38
extended setting
RWwn+3
RWwn+4
Data to be written
Monitor code 3
36
36
RWrn+3
RWrn+4
Data to be read
Third monitor value*3
38
38
6
RWwn+5 Monitor code 4 36 RWrn+5 Fourth monitor value*3 38
RWwn+6 Monitor code 5 36 RWrn+6 Fifth monitor value*3 38
RWwn+7 Monitor code 6 36 RWrn+7 Sixth monitor value *3 38
7
Fault record (fault
RWwn+8 Fault history No. H00 37 RWrn+8 Fault history No. 38
data)
RWwn+9 PID set point (0.01% increments)*1 37 RWrn+9 Fault record (output frequency)*4 38 8
PID measured value (0.01%
RWwn+A 37 RWrn+A Fault record (output current) 38
increments)*1
RWwn+B PID deviation (0.01% increments)*1 37 RWrn+B Fault record (output voltage) 38
9
RWwn+C Torque command or torque limit 37, 48 RWrn+C Fault record (energization time) 38
RWwn+D RWrn+D
RWwn+E H00 (Free) — RWrn+E H00 (Free) —
RWwn+F RWrn+F 10
Link parameter
RWwn+10 Instruction code 37 RWrn+10 Reply code 38
extended setting
RWwn+11 Data to be written 37 RWrn+11 Data to be read 38
Link parameter
RWwn+12 Instruction code 37 RWrn+12 Reply code 38
extended setting
RWwn+13 Data to be written 37 RWrn+13 Data to be read 38
Link parameter
RWwn+14 Instruction code 37 RWrn+14 Reply code 38
extended setting
RWwn+15 Data to be written 37 RWrn+15 Data to be read 38
Link parameter
RWwn+16 Instruction code 37 RWrn+16 Reply code 38
extended setting
RWwn+17 Data to be written 37 RWrn+17 Data to be read 38
Link parameter
RWwn+18 Instruction code 37 RWrn+18 Reply code 38
extended setting
RWwn+19 Data to be written 37 RWrn+19 Data to be read 38
RWwn+1A RWrn+1A
RWwn+1B RWrn+1B
RWwn+1C RWrn+1C
H00 (Free) — H00 (Free) —
RWwn+1D RWrn+1D
RWwn+1E RWrn+1E
RWwn+1F RWrn+1F
*1 Validity depends on the Pr.128, Pr.609, and Pr.610 settings. For details, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function). If the data outside
the range is set, the previous setting is retained.
*2 The display can be changed to rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.37 and Pr.53.
*3 When the item displayed in frequency is selected, the Pr.37 and Pr.53 settings are invalid.
*4 The frequency is always displayed regardless of the settings in Pr.37 and Pr.53.
*5 "n" indicates a value determined by the station number.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
31
When Pr.544 = "38" (user defined cyclic communication data selection)
• Remote I/O signals
Refer to Refer to
Device No.*7 Signal Device No.*7 Signal
page page
RYn0 Forward rotation command*2 34 RXn0 Forward running 35
RYn1 Reverse rotation command*2 34 RXn1 Reverse running 35
High-speed operation command
RYn2 34 RXn2 Running (terminal RUN function)*3 35
(terminal RH function)*1
Middle-speed operation command
RYn3 34 RXn3 Up to frequency*2 35
(terminal RM function)*1
Low-speed operation command
RYn4 34 RXn4 Overload warning*2 35
(terminal RL function)*1
RYn5 JOG operation selection 2*2 34 RXn5 Pr.193 assignment function (NET Y1)*6 35
Frequency detection (terminal FU
RYn6 Second function selection*2 34 RXn6 35
function)*3
RYn7 Current input selection*2 34 RXn7 Fault (terminal ABC function)*3 35
RYn8 *5 34 RXn8 *6 35
Pr.185 assignment function (NET X1) Pr.194 assignment function (NET Y2)
RYn9 Output stop (terminal MRS function)*1 34 RXn9 Pr.313 assignment function (DO0)*4 35
RYnA Pr.186 assignment function (NET X2)*5 34 RXnA Pr.314 assignment function (DO1)*4 35
RYnB Pr.184 assignment function (RES)*5 34 RXnB Pr.315 assignment function (DO2)*4 35
RYnC Monitor command 34 RXnC Monitoring 36
RYnD Frequency setting command (RAM) 35 RXnD Frequency setting completion (RAM) 36
Frequency setting command (RAM, Frequency setting completion (RAM,
RYnE 35 RXnE 36
EEPROM) EEPROM)
RYnF Instruction code execution request 35 RXnF Instruction code execution completed 36
RX(n+1)0 to
Reserved —
RX(n+1)5
RY(n+1)0 to
Reserved —
RY(n+1)7 RX(n+1)6 Pr.195 assignment function (NET Y3)*6 36
RX(n+1)7 Pr.196 assignment function (NET Y4)*6 36
Not used (initial data process Not used (initial data process request
RY(n+1)8 — RX(n+1)8 —
completion flag) flag)
Not used (initial data process request Not used (initial data process
RY(n+1)9 — RX(n+1)9 —
flag) completion flag)
RY(n+1)A Error reset request flag 35 RX(n+1)A Error status flag 36
RY(n+1)B Pr.187 assignment function (NET X3)*5 35 RX(n+1)B Remote station ready 36
RY(n+1)C Pr.188 assignment function (NET X4)*5 35 RX(n+1)C In-position*2 36
RY(n+1)D Pr.189 assignment function (NET X5)*5 35 RX(n+1)D During position command operation*2 36
User defined cyclic communication
RY(n+1)E
input writing request
35 RX(n+1)E Home position return completed*2 36
• Remote registers
Description Refer to Description Refer to
Address*3 Address*3
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page
RWwn Monitor code 2 Monitor code 1 37 RWrn First monitor value*2 38
RWwn+1 *1 37 RWrn+1 *2 38
Set frequency (0.01 Hz increments) Second monitor value
32 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
Description Refer to Description Refer to
Address*3 Address*3
Upper 8 bits
Link parameter
Lower 8 bits page Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page
1
RWwn+2 Instruction code 37 RWrn+2 Reply code 2 Reply code 1 38
extended setting
RWwn+3 Data to be written 37 RWrn+3 Data to be read 39
RWwn+4
User Defined Cyclic Communication
38 RWrn+4
User Defined Cyclic Communication
Output 1 Mapping (Pr.1330), lower 16 39
2
Input 1 Mapping (Pr.1320), lower 16 bits
bits
User Defined Cyclic Communication User Defined Cyclic Communication
RWwn+5 Input 1 Mapping (Pr.1320), upper 16
bits
38 RWrn+5 Output 1 Mapping (Pr.1330), upper 16
bits
39 3
User Defined Cyclic Communication
User Defined Cyclic Communication
RWwn+6 38 RWrn+6 Output 2 Mapping (Pr.1331), lower 16 39
Input 2 Mapping (Pr.1321), lower 16 bits
bits 4
User Defined Cyclic Communication User Defined Cyclic Communication
RWwn+7 Input 2 Mapping (Pr.1321), upper 16 38 RWrn+7 Output 2 Mapping (Pr.1331), upper 16 39
bits bits
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
33
Description Refer to Description Refer to
Address*3 Address*3
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page
User Defined Cyclic Communication
RWwn+18 RWrn+18 Output 11 Mapping (Pr.1340), lower 16 39
bits
User Defined Cyclic Communication
RWwn+19 RWrn+19 Output 11 Mapping (Pr.1340), upper 16 39
bits
User Defined Cyclic Communication
RWwn+1A RWrn+1A Output 12 Mapping (Pr.1341), lower 16 39
bits
User Defined Cyclic Communication
RWwn+1B RWrn+1B Output 12 Mapping (Pr.1341), upper 16 39
bits
H00 (Free) —
User Defined Cyclic Communication
RWwn+1C RWrn+1C Output 13 Mapping (Pr.1342), lower 16 39
bits
User Defined Cyclic Communication
RWwn+1D RWrn+1D Output 13 Mapping (Pr.1342), upper 16 39
bits
User Defined Cyclic Communication
RWwn+1E RWrn+1E Output 14 Mapping (Pr.1343), lower 16 39
bits
User Defined Cyclic Communication
RWwn+1F RWrn+1F Output 14 Mapping (Pr.1343), upper 16 39
bits
*1 The display can be changed to rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.37 and Pr.53.
*2 When the item displayed in frequency is selected, the Pr.37 and Pr.53 settings are invalid.
*3 "n" indicates a value determined by the station number.
34 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
Device No. Signal Description
When "1" is set in RYD, the set frequency / torque command (RWw1) is
written to the RAM of the inverter.*4
1
After the writing completes, "1" is set in the frequency setting / torque
Frequency setting command / torque command completion (RXD). Under Real sensorless vector control, Vector
RYD
command (RAM) control, and PM sensorless vector control, the following value is also written
to RAM at the same time. 2
• During torque control*6
: Torque command value
• During speed control / position control: Torque limit value
When "1" is set in RYE, the set frequency / torque command (RWw1) is
written to the RAM and EEPROM of the inverter. After the writing completes,
3
"1" is set in the frequency setting / torque command completion (RXE).
Under Real sensorless vector control, vector control, and PM sensorless
RYE
Frequency setting command / torque
command (RAM, EEPROM)
vector control, the following value is also written to RAM and EEPROM at the
same time. 4
*6
• During torque control : Torque command value
• During speed control / position control: Torque limit value
To change the frequency consecutively, be sure to write data to the inverter
RAM. 5
At the ON edge of RYF, processing corresponding to the instruction codes set
to RWw2, 10, 12, 14, 16, and 18 are executed. "1" is set in the instruction
RYF Instruction code execution request code execution completed (RXF) after completion of instruction codes. When
an instruction code execution error occurs, a value other than "0" is set in the 6
reply code (RWr2, 10, 12, 14, 16, or 18).
When "1" is set in RY1A at an inverter fault, the inverter is reset, and then "0"
RY1A Error reset request flag
is set in the error status flag (RX1A).*5
RY1B — (terminal NET X3 function)*3
7
RY1C — (terminal NET X4 function)*3 Functions assigned to Pr.187 to Pr.189 are activated.
RY1D — (terminal NET X5 function)*3
When "1" is set in RY1E, data set in RWw4 to RWw17 are written to the
8
User defined cyclic communication input corresponding parameters that have the index numbers specified using
RY1E
writing request Pr.1320 to Pr.1329. While "1" is set in RY1E, the data is always updated. The
*1
response time to write data is 100 ms at the most.
These signals are set in the initial setting. Using Pr.180 to Pr.183, input signals assigned to the device numbers can be changed. Some signals
9
are not controllable via network depending on the settings of Pr.338 and Pr.339. For details of Pr.180 to Pr.183, Pr.338, and Pr.339, refer to the
FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*2
*3
The signals are fixed. They cannot be changed using parameters.
No signal is assigned in the initial setting. Use Pr.184 to Pr.189 to assign signals to RY8, RYA, RYB, and RY1B to RY1D.
10
For details, refer to the description of Pr.184 to Pr.189 (Input terminal function selection) in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*4 While "1" is set in the frequency setting command (RYD), the set frequency (RWw1) is always applied.
*5 Refer to page 281 for operation conditions of inverter reset.
*6 Torque control cannot be performed with a PM motor.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
35
Device No. Signal Description
After "1" is set in the monitor command (RYC), and the monitored value is set
RXC Monitoring in the remote register Rwr0, 1, 4 to 7, "1" is set for this signal. When "0" is set
in the monitor command (RYC), "0" is set for this signal.
After "1" is set in the frequency setting command / torque command (RYD),
Frequency setting / torque command and the frequency setting / torque command is written to the RAM of the
RXD
completed (RAM) inverter, "1" is set for this signal. When "0" is set in the frequency setting
command / torque command (RYD), "0" is set for this signal.
After "1" is set in the frequency setting command / torque command (RYE),
and the frequency setting / torque command is written to the RAM and
Frequency setting / torque command
RXE EEPROM of the inverter, "1" is set for this signal. When "0" is set in the
completed (RAM, EEPROM)
frequency setting command / torque command (RYE), "0" is set for this
signal.
After "1" is set in the instruction code execution request (RYF) and the
processes corresponding to the instruction codes (RWw2, 10, 12, 14, 16 and
RXF Instruction code execution completed
18) are executed, "1" is set for this signal. When "0" is set in the instruction
code execution request (RYF), "0" is set for this signal.
RX16 — (terminal NET Y3 function)*4
Functions assigned to Pr.195 and Pr.196 are activated.
RX17 — (terminal NET Y4 function)*4
When an inverter error occurs (protective function is activated), "1" is set for
RX1A Error status flag
this signal.
When the inverter is ready for communication upon completion of initial
setting after power-ON or a hardware reset, "1" is set for this signal.
RX1B Remote station ready
When an inverter error occurs (protective function is activated), "0" is set in
this signal.
RX1C In-position*2 Y36 signal
RX1D During position command operation*2 PBSY signal
RX1E Home position return completed*2 ZP signal
RX1F Home position return failure*2 ZA signal
*1 These signals are set in the initial setting. Using Pr.190 to Pr.192, output signals assigned to the device numbers can be changed.
For details of Pr.190 to Pr.192, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*2 The signals are fixed. They cannot be changed using parameters.
*3 No signal is assigned in the initial setting. Use Pr.313 to Pr.315 to assign signals to RX9 to RXB.
For details, refer to the description of Pr.313 to Pr.315 (Output terminal function selection) in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*4 No signal is assigned in the initial setting. Use Pr.193 to Pr.196 to assign signals to RX5, RX8, RX16, and RX17.
For details, refer to the description of Pr.193 to Pr.196 (Output terminal function selection) in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
36 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
Device No. Signal Description
Set the individual fault number of the fault history that you want to read. Fault records can be
read back to the tenth latest fault. (The value in the lower 8 bits is fixed to H00.)
1
RWw8 Fault history No.
Upper 8 bits: H00 (latest fault) to H09 (tenth latest fault)
When H0A to HFF is set to the lower 8 bits, "0" is returned.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
37
Device No. Signal Description
Data set in RWw4 to RWw17 are written to the corresponding parameters that have the index
numbers specified using Pr.1320 to Pr.1329. When "20488 or 20489" is set in any of Pr.1320
to Pr.1329, the input value set in the corresponding register is invalid. While "1" is set in
RY1E, the data is always updated.
User defined cyclic
RWw4 to If the same index number is specified in two or more of Pr.1320 to Pr.1329, the number set
communication input data
RWw17 in the parameter with the smallest parameter number is valid. The same number set in the
selection
other parameters is regarded as "9999".
When a nonexistent index number or "9999" is set in Pr.1320 to Pr.1329, the data will be
ignored. When the referenced index number is set for 16-bit data, the upper 16-bit data will
be ignored.
*1 The display can be changed to rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.37 and Pr.53. For details, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual
(Function).
*2 When Pr.541 Frequency command sign selection = "1", the set frequency is a signed value. When the setting value is negative, the command
is the inverse from the start command.
Setting range: -327.68 to 327.67 Hz (-32768 to 32767), 0.01 Hz increments.
For the details, refer to page 29.
Second monitor value When "0" is set to the upper 8 bits of the monitor code (RWw0), the current output frequency
RWr1 is set. When "1" is set in RYC while a value other than "0" is set to the upper 8 bits of the
(output frequency*1*2 ) monitor code (RWw0), the monitor value is set to the upper 8 bits of the monitor code (RWw0).
Lower 8 bits of RWr2.
Reply code 1 When "1" is set in RYD or RYE, the reply code for the frequency setting command (torque
command / torque limit) is set. (Refer to page 39.)
RWr2
Upper 8 bits of RWr2.
Reply code 2 When "1" is set in RYF, the reply code corresponding to the instruction code RWw2 is set.
(Refer to page 39.)
RWr3 Data to be read In a normal reply, a replay code for the instruction code is set.
RWr4 Third monitor value*1*2
RWr5 Fourth monitor value*1*2 When "1" is set in RYC, the monitor value specified to the corresponding monitor code (RWw4
RWr6 Fifth monitor value*1*2 to RWw7) is stored.
Second monitor value When "0" is set to the upper 8 bits of the monitor code (RWw0), the current output frequency
RWr1 *1*2 is set. When "1" is set in RYC while a value other than "0" is set to the upper 8 bits of the
(output frequency ) monitor code (RWw0), the monitor value is set to the upper 8 bits of the monitor code (RWw0).
Lower 8 bits of RWr2.
Reply code 1 When "1" is set in RYD or RYE, the reply code for the frequency setting command (torque
command / torque limit) is set. (Refer to page 39.)
RWr2
Upper 8 bits of RWr2.
Reply code 2 When "1" is set in RYF, the reply code corresponding to the instruction code RWw2 is set.
(Refer to page 39.)
38 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
Device No. Signal Description
RWr3 Data to be read In a normal reply, a replay code for the instruction code is set.
Data to which the index numbers are specified using Pr.1330 to Pr.1343 are always stored in
1
User defined cyclic the corresponding registers.
RWr4 to
communication output data When a nonexistent index number or "9999" is set in Pr.1330 to Pr.1343, "0" is always stored.
RWr1F
selection When the referenced index number is set for 16-bit data, "0" is always stored in the upper 16-
bit data. 2
*1 When the item displayed in frequency is selected, the Pr.37 and Pr.53 settings are invalid.
*2 Use Pr.290 to enable display of negative numbers during monitoring. For details, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
3
• Reply code description
The reply to the instruction execution command is set in RWr2, 10, 12, 14, 16, and 18. After the frequency setting (RYD
or RYE) or execution of instruction code (RYF), check the reply code (RWr2) in the remote register. 4
Item Data Item Fault description Remarks
No fault (Instruction codes are executed
H0000 Normal
without any fault.)
Parameter write is attempted when the
5
Reply code H0001 Write mode fault inverter is not in the stop status in the Reply code to RWw10, 12, 14, 16, 18
Network operation mode.
H0002
H0003
Parameter selection fault
Setting range fault
Unregistered code is set.
Set data exceeds the permissible range.
6
No fault (Instruction codes are executed
H00 Normal
without any fault.)
Parameter write is attempted when the 7
H01 Write mode fault inverter is not in the stop status in the
Reply code 1*1 Network operation mode.
Frequency command
H03 (torque command / torque
limit) setting range error
The value outside the range is set. 8
Reply code to RWr2
No fault (Instruction codes are executed
H00 Normal
without any fault.)
Parameter write is attempted when the 9
Reply code 2 H01 Write mode fault inverter is not in the stop status in the
Network operation mode.
H02 Parameter selection fault Unregistered code is set.
H03 Setting range fault Set data exceeds the permissible range. 10
*1 The contents of the reply code 1 are changed when torque commands are given or the torque is limited. The upper 4 bits of the reply code 1 are
used as the reply code to the torque command / torque limit, and the lower 4 bits are used as the reply code to the frequency command.
Bit15 Bit0
Reply code to
the torque command
Instruction code
Set instruction codes using the remote register (RWw). (Refer to page 36.)
The definition read by the instruction code is stored in the remote register (RWr). (Refer to page 38.)
Read/ Instruction
Item Data description
write code
H0000: Network operation
Read H7B H0001: External operation, External JOG operation
H0002: PU operation, External/PU combined operation 1 or 2, PUJOG operation
Operation mode
H0000: Network operation
Write HFB H0001: External operation
H0002: PU operation (when Pr.79 = "6")
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
39
Read/ Instruction
Item Data description
write code
H76 Sixth latest fault Fifth latest fault Second latest fault Latest fault
(H30) (HA0)
H77 Eighth latest fault Seventh latest fault
Second latest fault ...... THT
H78 Tenth latest fault Ninth latest fault Latest fault ...... OPT
Set frequency (RAM) H6D Read the set frequency or rotations per minute (machine speed) from the RAM or
EEPROM. H0000 to HE678: Set frequency in 0.01 Hz increments
Read
(The display can be changed to the rotations per minute (machine speed) using
Set frequency (EEPROM) H6E
Pr.37 and Pr.53. Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
Write the set frequency or rotations per minute (machine speed) into the RAM or
Set frequency (RAM)*4 HED EEPROM. H0000 to HE678 (0 to 590.00 Hz): Frequency in 0.01 Hz increments.
(The display can be changed to the rotations per minute (machine speed) using
Write
Set frequency (RAM and Pr.37 and Pr.53. Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
HEE To change the set frequency consecutively, write data to the RAM of the inverter.
EEPROM)*4
(Instruction code: HED)
Read H00 to H63 • Refer to the instruction codes in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function) and
write and/or read parameter values as required. Writing to Pr.77 and Pr.79 is
disabled. When setting Pr.100 and later, set the link parameter extended setting.
Parameter
• Set 65520 (HFFF0) as a parameter value "8888" and 65535 (HFFFF) as "9999".
• When changing the parameter values frequently, set "1" in Pr.342 to write them
Write H80 to HE3 to the RAM. (For the details, refer to page 276.)
40 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
*1 When "100" is set in Pr.52 Operation panel main monitor selection, the frequency setting value is monitored during a stop, and the output
frequency is monitored during running.
*2 Use Pr.290 to enable display of negative numbers during monitoring. For details, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function). 1
*3 Write data is in hexadecimal, and only two digits are valid. (The upper two digits are ignored.)
*4 Setting from the remote register (RWw1) is also available.
*5 Turning OFF the power supply while clearing parameters with H5A5A or H55AA returns the communication parameter settings to the initial
*6
settings.
Reading or writing is available when the link parameter extended setting = "1 or 9".
2
*7 The gain frequency can be also written using Pr.125 (instruction code: H99) or Pr.126 (instruction code: H9A).
NOTE
• When a 32-bit parameter setting or monitor item is read and the value to be read exceeds HFFFF, HFFFF is returned. 3
Monitor code
Various data of the inverter can be monitored by setting the special monitor selection No. of the instruction code and setting
4
the monitor code in the remote registers, RWw0 and RWw4 to 7.
• Use the monitor code (RWw0) to set the first monitor value (RWr0) in the lower 8 bits, and the second monitor value (RWr1)
in the upper 8 bits.
5
(Example) The monitor code (RWw0) will be H0602 to set the output current as the first monitor value (RWr0) and set the
running speed as the second monitor value (RWr1).
• The values for the monitor code 3 (RWw4) to the monitor code 6 (RWw7) can be selected.
6
First monitor and third–sixth monitor
Monitor code Second monitor (upper 8 bits) Unit
(lower 8 bits)
H00 Output frequency None (monitor value fixed to "0") 0.01 Hz 7
H01 Output frequency 0.01 Hz
H02 Output current 0.01 A
H03 Output voltage 0.1 V 8
. . .
. . .
. . .
9
NOTE
• The monitor codes from H01 onwards and their contents are the same as those of the RS-485 communication dedicated
monitor. For details of the monitor codes or monitor items, refer to the monitor display section in the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).
10
• When the item displayed in frequency is selected in the remote registers, RWw0 and RWw4 to RWw7, the Pr.37 and Pr.53
settings are invalid.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
41
IP filtering function (Ethernet) (Pr.1442 to Pr.1448)
• Set the IP address range for connectable network devices (Pr.1442 to Pr.1448) to limit the connectable devices. The
setting range for IP address of connectable network devices depends on the settings in Pr.1443 and Pr.1446, Pr.1444 and
Pr.1447, and Pr.1445 and Pr.1448. (Either of the settings can be larger than the other in Pr.1443 and Pr.1446, Pr.1444
and Pr.1447, and Pr.1445 and Pr.1448.)
[Setting example 1] Pr.1442 Pr.1443 Pr.1444 Pr.1445
IP filter address (Ethernet) 192 168 1 100
The range is between The range is between
the values set in both the values set in both
parameters. parameters.
Pr.1446 Pr.1447 Pr.1448
IP filter address range specification
(Ethernet) ― 9999 3 150
In this case, the IP address range in which Ethernet communication is permitted is "192.168.x (1 to 3).xxx (100 to 150)".
[Setting example 2]
Pr.1442 Pr.1443 Pr.1444 Pr.1445
IP filter address (Ethernet) 192 168 2 100
The range is between
the values set in both
parameters.
Pr.1446 Pr.1447 Pr.1448
IP filter address range specification
(Ethernet) ― 9999 9999 50
In this case, the IP address range in which Ethernet communication is permitted is "192.168.2.xxx (50 to 100)".
CAUTION
• The IP filtering function (Ethernet) (Pr.1442 to Pr.1448) is provided as a means to prevent unauthorized access, DoS
attacks, computer viruses, or other cyberattacks from external devices, but the function does not prevent such access
completely. In order to protect the inverter and the system against unauthorized access by external systems, take
additional security measures. We shall have no responsibility or liability for any problems involving inverter trouble and
system trouble by DoS attacks, unauthorized access, computer viruses, and other cyberattacks. The following are
examples of measures to prevent them.
- Install a firewall.
- Install a personal computer as a relay station, and control the relaying of transmission data using an application
program.
- Install an external device as a relay station to control access rights. (For the details of external devices used to control
access rights, contact the distributors of the external devices.)
42 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
• In Pr.1389 to Pr.1398, specify the subindices to which the index numbers are specified using Pr.1320 to Pr.1339.
Input data selection (from the master module to the
inverter)
Output data selection (from the inverter to the master
module)
1
Data No.
Index specification Sub index specification Index specification Sub index specification
1 Pr.1320 Pr.1389 (lower 8 bits) Pr.1330 Pr.1394 (lower 8 bits)
2 Pr.1321 Pr.1389 (upper 8 bits) Pr.1331 Pr.1394 (upper 8 bits) 2
3 Pr.1322 Pr.1390 (lower 8 bits) Pr.1332 Pr.1395 (lower 8 bits)
4 Pr.1323 Pr.1390 (upper 8 bits) Pr.1333 Pr.1395 (upper 8 bits)
5
6
Pr.1324
Pr.1325
Pr.1391 (lower 8 bits)
Pr.1391 (upper 8 bits)
Pr.1334
Pr.1335
Pr.1396 (lower 8 bits)
Pr.1396 (upper 8 bits)
3
7 Pr.1326 Pr.1392 (lower 8 bits) Pr.1336 Pr.1397 (lower 8 bits)
8 Pr.1327 Pr.1392 (upper 8 bits) Pr.1337 Pr.1397 (upper 8 bits)
9 Pr.1328 Pr.1393 (lower 8 bits) Pr.1338 Pr.1398 (lower 8 bits) 4
10 Pr.1329 Pr.1393 (upper 8 bits) Pr.1339 Pr.1398 (upper 8 bits)
11 — — Pr.1340
12
13
—
—
—
—
Pr.1341
Pr.1342
Fixed to "0" 5
14 — — Pr.1343
• The following tables describe the index numbers of inverter parameters (read/write), monitor data (read), inverter control 6
parameters (read), and CiA402 drive profile (read/write).
• Inverter parameters
Index Sub index Read/write Remarks
7
12288 to 13787
0, 1 Read/write The inverter parameter number + 12288 (H3000) is the index number.
(H3000 to H35DB)
• Calibration parameters
8
Index Sub index Name Description
13188 (H3384)
0
1
Data
Sub Data
C0 (Pr.900)
—
9
0 Data C1 (Pr.901)
13189 (H3385)
1 Sub Data —
13190 (H3386)
0 Data C2 (Pr.902) 10
1 Sub Data C3 (Pr.902)
0 Data 125 (Pr.903)
13191 (H3387)
1 Sub Data C4 (Pr.903)
0 Data C5 (Pr.904)
13192 (H3388)
1 Sub Data C6 (Pr.904)
0 Data 126 (Pr.905)
13193 (H3389)
1 Sub Data C7 (Pr.905)
0 Data C38 (Pr.932)
13220 (H33A4)
1 Sub Data C39 (Pr.932)
0 Data C40 (Pr.933)
13221 (H33A5)
1 Sub Data C41 (Pr.933)
0 Data C42 (Pr.934)
13222 (H33A6)
1 Sub Data C43 (Pr.934)
0 Data C44 (Pr.935)
13223 (H33A7)
1 Sub Data C45 (Pr.935)
For the numbers and names of inverter parameters, refer to the parameter list of the Instruction Manual (Function).
NOTE
• Set 65520 (HFFF0) as a parameter value "8888" and 65535 (HFFFF) as "9999".
• When parameter write is performed, data are written to RAM.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
43
• Monitor data
Index Sub index Read/write Remarks
16384 to 16483
0 Read The monitor code + 16384 (H4000) is the index number.
(H4000 to H4063)
For details of the monitor codes and monitor items, refer to the description of Pr.52 in the Instruction Manual (Function).
NOTE
• Display of negative numbers during monitoring set in Pr.290 Monitor negative output selection is disabled.
• The display can be changed from the frequency to rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.53. When the machine
speed is displayed, the value is incremented by one.
*1 When "20488 or 20489" is set in any of Pr.1320 to Pr.1329, the input value set in the corresponding register is invalid.
*2 Available for the Ethernet model only.
*1 The signal within parentheses ( ) is assigned in the initial status. The function changes depending on the setting of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output
terminal function selection).
For details, refer to the description of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output terminal function selection) in the Instruction Manual (Function).
44 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
• Safety input status
Bit Definition 1
0: Terminal S1 ON
0
1: Terminal S1 OFF (output shutoff)
0: Terminal S2 ON
1
1: Terminal S2 OFF (output shutoff) 2
2 to 15 0
24672
When Pr.81 = "9999", the number of motor poles is regarded as 4.
8
0 Modes of operation Control mode: -1 (vendor specific operation mode) (fixed) Read/write Integer8
(H6060)
24673 Modes of operation
0 Current control mode: -1 (vendor specific operation mode) (fixed) Read Integer8
(H6061)
24674
display
Position demand Position command (pulse)
9
0 Read Integer32
(H6062) value The position command before the electronic gear operation is read.
24675 Position actual Current position (pulse)
0 Read Integer32
(H6063) internal value The current position after the electronic gear operation is read. 10
24676 Position actual Current position (pulse)
0 Read Integer32
(H6064) value The current position before the electronic gear operation is read.
Target torque (%)
Set Pr.805 Torque command value (RAM).
Setting range: 600% to 1400%
24689
0 Target torque When the value is set in 0.1 increments, the first decimal place is Read/write Integer16
(H6071)
rounded off. However, when Pr.804 Torque command source
selection = "5 or 6", the data can be read/written in increments of
0.1.
24692 Torque demand value (%)
0 Torque demand Read Integer16
(H6074) The torque command is read.
24695 Torque actual value (%)
0 Torque actual value Read Integer16
(H6077) The motor torque is read.
Target position (pulse)
Set the target position in the direct command mode.
24698 Initial value: 0
0 Target position Read/write Integer32
(H607A) Setting range: -2147483647 to 2147483647
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
Maximum profile speed (r/min)
24703
0 Max profile velocity Set Pr.18 High speed maximum frequency in r/min. Read/write Unsigned32
(H607F)
Setting range: 0 to 590 Hz
Profile speed (r/min)
Set the maximum speed in the direct command mode.
24705 Initial value: 0
0 Profile velocity Read/write Unsigned32
(H6081) Setting range: 0 to (120 × 590 Hz / Pr.81)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
45
Sub
Index Name Description Read/write Data type
index
Acceleration time constant (ms)
<Position control>
Set the acceleration time in the direct command mode.
Initial value: 5000
Setting range: 10 to 360000
The last digit is rounded off. (For example, 1358 ms becomes 1350
ms.)
24707
0 Profile acceleration (For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Read/write Unsigned32
(H6083)
Manual (Function).)
<Other than position control>
Set Pr.7 Acceleration time in ms.
Setting range: 0 to 3600 s
The last two digits are rounded off when Pr.21 Acceleration/
deceleration time increments = "0", and the last digit is rounded
off when Pr.21 = "1".
Deceleration time constant (ms)
<Position control>
Set the deceleration time in the direct command mode.
Initial value: 5000
Setting range: 10 to 360000
The last digit is rounded off. (For example, 1358 ms becomes 1350
ms.)
24708
0 Profile deceleration (For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Read/write Unsigned32
(H6084)
Manual (Function).)
<Other than position control>
Set Pr.8 Deceleration time in ms.
Setting range: 0 to 3600 s
The last two digits are rounded off when Pr.21 Acceleration/
deceleration time increments = "0", and the last digit is rounded
off when Pr.21 = "1".
Position encoder
— Encoder resolution (machine side / motor side) — —
resolution
Highest sub-index
0 Maximum value of subindex: H02 (fixed) Read Unsigned8
24719 supported
(H608F) Encoder resolution
Encoder
1 Set Pr.369 Number of encoder pulses. Read/write Unsigned32
increments
Setting range: 2 to 4096
2 Motor revolutions Motor speed (rev): H00000001 (fixed) Read/write Unsigned32
— Gear ratio Gear ratio — —
Highest sub-index
0 Maximum value of subindex: H02 (fixed) Read Unsigned8
supported
Motor shaft revolutions*2
1 Motor revolutions Set Pr.420 Command pulse scaling factor numerator Read/write Unsigned32
24721
(electronic gear numerator).
(H6091)
Setting range: 1 to 32767
Drive shaft revolutions*2
2 Shaft revolutions Set Pr.421 Command pulse multiplication denominator Read/write Unsigned32
(electronic gear denominator).
Setting range: 1 to 32767
Home position return method
Set the home position return method in the direct command
24728
(H6098)
0 Homing method mode.*3 Read/write Integer8
(For the direct command mode and the home position return
method, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
— Homing speeds Home position return speed — —
Highest sub-index
0 Maximum value of subindex: H01 (fixed) Read Unsigned8
supported
24729 Motor speed during home position returning (r/min)
(H6099) Set the home position return speed in the direct command mode.
Speed during Initial value: 120 × 2 Hz / Pr.81
1 Read/write Unsigned32
search for switch Setting range: 0 to (120 × 400 Hz / Pr.81)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
46 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
Sub
Index Name Description Read/write Data type
index
Home position return acceleration/deceleration time (ms)
1
Set the home position return acceleration/deceleration time in the
direct command mode.
Initial value: 5000
24730
(H609A)
0
Homing
acceleration
Setting range: 10 to 360000 Read/write Unsigned32 2
The last digit is rounded off. (For example, 1358 ms becomes 1350
ms.)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).) 3
24820 Following error Droop pulse (pulse)
0 Read Integer32
(H60F4) actual value The droop pulse before the electronic gear operation is read.
24826 Speed command after position loop*1
(H60FA)
0 Control effort
The ideal speed command is read.
Read Integer32 4
24828 Position demand Position command (pulse)
0 Read Integer32
(H60FC) internal value The position command after the electronic gear operation is read.
25858
(H6502)
0
Supported drive
modes
Supported control mode: H00010000 (vendor specific operation
mode)
Read Unsigned32 5
*1 The value is displayed and set in r/min regardless of the settings in Pr.53.
The frequency is converted to the rotation speed for reading, and the setting value is converted to the frequency for writing.
*2
*3
When parameter write is performed, data are written to RAM.
The following table shows home position return methods corresponding to the Index H6098 setting values.
6
H6098 setting Home position return method
-3 Data set type
-4 Stopper type (home position return direction: position pulse increasing direction)
7
-5 (initial value) Ignoring the home position (servo ON position as the home position)
-7 Count type with front end reference (home position return direction: position pulse increasing direction)
-36 Stopper type (home position return direction: position pulse decreasing direction) 8
-39 Count type with front end reference (home position return direction: position pulse decreasing direction)
-65 Stopper type (home position return direction: start command direction)
-66 Count type with front end reference (home position return direction: start command direction)
9
NOTE
• The command interface in the Network operation mode is determined by the Pr.550 NET mode operation command source
selection setting. (Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
• When the data is read, the value is displayed with a sign regardless of the Pr.290 Monitor negative output selection setting.
10
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
47
Setting example
• The following table shows example settings when user defined cyclic communication data are selected (when Pr.544 =
"38"). When "1" is set in RY(n+1)E (writing request for user defined cyclic communication input data), data in RWwn+4 and
RWwn+6 are written to the specified inverter parameters in the RAM. (The response time to write the data is 100 ms at the
most.)
Applicable device
Pr. Name Setting example Description
No.
User Defined Cyclic
P.7 Acceleration time
1320 Communication Input 1 12295 (H3007) RWwn+4
7 (H0007) + 12288 (H3000)
Mapping
User Defined Cyclic
Pr.8 Deceleration time
1321 Communication Input 2 12296 (H3008) RWwn+6
8 (H0008) + 12288 (H3000)
Mapping
User Defined Cyclic
P.7 Acceleration time
1330 Communication Output 1 12295 (H3007) RWrn+4
7 (H0007) + 12288 (H3000)
Mapping
User Defined Cyclic
Pr.8 Deceleration time
1331 Communication Output 2 12296 (H3008) RWrn+6
8 (H0008) + 12288 (H3000)
Mapping
User Defined Cyclic
Monitored output current
1332 Communication Output 3 16386 (H4002) RWrn+8
2 (H0002) + 16384 (H4000)
Mapping
User Defined Cyclic
Pr.255 Life alarm status display
1333 Communication Output 4 12543 (H30FF) RWrn+A
255 (H00FF) + 12288 (H3000)
Mapping
User Defined Cyclic
1334 Communication Output 5 20981 (H51F5) Fault record 1 RWrn+C
Mapping
48 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
List of I/O devices whose function is changed according to the control method
Relationship between the Pr.804 setting, the setting range, and the actual torque command / 10
torque limit (when setting is made from CC-Link IE TSN communication)
Pr.804 setting Setting range Actual torque command Actual torque limit
1, 3 600 to 1400 (1% increments)*1 -400 to 400% 0 to 400%
-32768 to 32767 (two's
5, 6 -327.68 to 327.67% 0 to 327.67%
complement)*1
Programming examples
The following explains the programming examples for controlling the inverter with sequence programs.
Refer to
Item Sample program
page
Reading the inverter status Reading the inverter status from the buffer memory of the master station 52
Setting the operation mode Selecting the Network operation mode 52
Setting the operation commands Commanding the forward rotation and middle speed signals 53
Setting the monitoring function Monitoring the output frequency 53
Reading a parameter value Reading the value of Pr.7 Acceleration time 53
Writing a parameter value Setting 3.0 seconds in Pr.7 Acceleration time 54
Frequency setting (speed setting) Setting to 50.00 Hz 54
Reading the fault records Reading the inverter faults 55
Inverter reset Resetting the inverter when an inverter error occurs 56
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
49
• System configuration for programming example
PLC
Power Master station Input unit Output unit
CPU
supply RJ71GN11-T2 RX10 RY10R2
R04CPU
R61P (X/Y00 to 1F) (X20 to X2F) (Y30 to Y3F)
X20 Y30
Station 1 Station 2
Inverter Inverter
50 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
Schematic diagrams of remote I/O and remote register devices
• Remote I/O (RX and RY) transmitted between the programmable controller CPU and remote stations
1
Remote station
Programmable controller CPU (Station 1)
2
X101F to X1000 RX1F to RX00
X103F to X1020
3
RY1F to RY00
Remote station
4
Y101F to Y1000 (Station 2)
Y103F to Y1020
RX1F to RX00 5
RY1F to RY00 6
• Remote register areas (RWw and RWr) transmitted between the programmable controller CPU and the remote stations 7
Programmable controller CPU Remote station
(Station 1)
For writing
W100 RWw0 8
W101 RWw1
W11E RWw1E
W11F RWw1F
W120 RWr0 9
W121 RWr1
W13E RWr1E
W13F RWr1F
10
Remote station
For reading (Station 2)
W000
W001 RWw0
RWw1
W01E
W01F RWw1E
W020 RWw1F
W021 RWr0
RWr1
W03E
W03F RWr1E
RWr1F
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
51
Programming example for reading the inverter status
The following program turns ON the signal Y00 of the output unit when the station 1 inverter starts running.
SB49 SW0B0.0
0 M0 Check the data link status of the station 1
M0 X1002
3 Y30 Turn on the output unit (Y00)
Inverter running (RX02)
6 END
X101F X1000
Remote input
b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
One
RX1F to RX00 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
station
[Inverter status]
b31 b30 b29 b28 b27 b26 b25 b24 b23 b22 b21 b20 b19 b18 b17 b16
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
[Inverter status]
Inverter status
b0 : Forward running b7 : Fault (ABC)*1
b1 : Reverse running b8 : (NET Y2)*1
b2 : Running (RUN)*1 b9 : (DO0)*1
b3 : Up to frequency b10 : (DO1)*1
b4 : Overload warning b11 : (DO2)*1
b5 : (NET Y1)*1 b22 : (NET Y3)*1
b6 : Frequency detection (FU)*1 b23 : (NET Y4)*1
*1 These signals are assigned in the initial status. Use Pr.190 to Pr.196 and Pr.313 to Pr.315 (Output terminal function selection) to change the
output signals.
SB49 SW0B0.0
0 M0 Check the data link status of the station 1
M0 X20
3 PLS M300
M300
7 SET M301
M301 X100F
9 MOV H0FB W110
Write operation mode write code (HFB)
to RWw10 and set data (H0000) to RWw11.
MOV H0 W111
SET M302
M302 X100F Read reply code (RWr10) to D2 when the instruction
18 MOV W10 D2 code execution completion (RX0F) turns on.
24 END
52 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
Programming example for setting the operation commands
The following program gives a forward rotation command and middle-speed operation command to the station 1 inverter.
1
SB49 SW0B0.0
0 M0 Check the data link status of the station 1
3
M0 X20
Y1000 Forward rotation command (RY00)
2
Y1003 Middle speed operation command (RY03)
7 END 3
Y101F Y1000
b15
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
b7
0 0 0 0 1 0 0
b0
1 RY1F to RY00 One station
4
[Run command] 1: ON
b31 b23
Middle speed Forward rotation
b16
0: OFF
5
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
[Run command]
6
Run command
b0 : Forward rotation command b8 : (NET X1)*1
b1 : Reverse rotation command b9 : Output stop (MRS)*1
b2 : High-speed operation command (RH)*1
b3 : Middle-speed operation command (RM)*1
b10 : (NET X2)*1
b11 : (RES)*1 7
b4 : Low-speed operation command (RL)*1 b27 : (NET X3)*1
b5 : JOG operation selection 2 b28 : (NET X4)*1
b6 : Second function selection b29 : (NET X5)*1
b7 : Current input selection
8
*1 These signals are assigned in the initial status. Use Pr.180 to Pr.189 (Input terminal function selection) to change the input signals. Some
signals are not controllable by a command from the programmable controller depending on the setting. (For details, refer to the Instruction Manual
(Function).) 9
Programming example for monitoring the output frequency
The following explains a program to read monitor functions of the inverter.
10
The following program reads the output frequency of the station 1 inverter to output to D1.
Output frequency read code: H0001 (hexadecimal)
For the monitor codes, refer to page 41.
Example) The output frequency of 60 Hz is indicated as "H1770 (6000)".
SB49 SW0B0.0
0 M0 Check the data link status of the station 1
M0 X20
3 Set monitor code (H01) of output frequency
MOV H1 W100
to RWw0.
11 END
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
53
• The reply code to the instruction code execution is set in D2. (Refer to page 39 for the reply code (RWr10).)
SB49 SW0B0.0
0 M0 Check the data link status of the station 1
M0 X20
3 PLS M300
M300
7 SET M301
M301 X100F
9 MOV H7 W110 Write Pr.7 read code (H07) to RWw10.
RST M301
SET M302
M302 X100F
16 MOV W11 D1 Read acceleration time (RWr11) and reply code
(RWr10) to D1 and D2 when the instruction code
MOV W10 D2 execution completion (RX0F) turns on.
RST Y100F Turn off the instruction code execution request (RY0F)
RST M302
24 END
NOTE
• For the parameter assigned the number of 100 or higher, change the link parameter extended setting (set it to the one other
than H00). For the setting values, refer to the instruction code list of the Instruction Manual (Function).
SB49 SW0B0.0
0 M0 Check the data link status of the station 1
M0 X20
3 PLS M300
M300
7 SET M301
M301 X100F
9 MOV H87 W110
Write Pr.7 write code (H87) to RWw10 and
acceleration time setting data (K30) to RWw11.
MOV K30 W111
RST M301
SET M302
M302 X100F Read reply code (RWr10) to D2 when the instruction
18 MOV W10 D2 code execution completion (RX0F) turns on.
RST Y100F Turn off the instruction code execution request (RY0F)
RST M302
24 END
NOTE
• For the parameter assigned the number of 100 or higher, change the link parameter extended setting (set it to the one other
than H00). For the setting values, refer to the instruction code list of the Instruction Manual (Function).
• For other functions, refer to the instruction codes (refer to page 39).
54 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
• The reply code to the instruction code execution is set in D2. (Refer to page 39 for the reply code (RWr2).)
1
SB49 SW0B0.0
0 M0 Check the data link status of the station 1
M0 X20
3
M300
PLS M300
2
7 SET M301
M301 X100D
9 MOV K5000 W101 Write set frequency to RWw1.
3
SET Y100D Turn off the frequency setting
command RAM (RY0D)
RST M301
SET M302 4
M302 X100D Read reply code (RWr2) to D2 when the
16 MOV W2 D2 frequency setting completion (RX0D) turns on.
22 END
6
NOTE
• To change the set frequency continuously from a programmable controller, check that the frequency setting complete (for 7
example, X100D) turns ON, and the reply code from the remote register is H0000. Then change the setting data (for example,
W101) continuously.
• To write the set frequency to the EEPROM, change the following points in the program shown above.
- Frequency setting command (from Y100D to Y100E) 8
- Frequency setting completion (from X100D to X100E)
9
<Timing chart when writing to RAM> <Timing chart when writing to EEPROM>
Y100D Y100E
*2
W101 W101
Inverter Inverter
*1 10
running running
frequency frequency Reflect to the inverter when Y100E turns on
*1 To the EEPROM, a writing is performed only once after the command Y100E turns ON.
*2 If the set data is changed at the command Y100E ON, the change is not applied to the inverter.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
55
The reply code to the instruction code execution is set in D2. (Refer to page 39 for the reply code (RWr10).)
SB49 SW0B0.0
0 M0 Check the data link status of the station 1
M0 X20
3 PLS M300
M300
7 SET M301
M301 X100F
9 MOV H74 W110 Write fault history No.1 and No.2 read
code (H74) to RWw10.
SET Y100F Turn on the instruction code execution request
(RY0F)
RST M301
SET M302
M302 X100F
16 MOV W11 D1 Read fault record (RWr11) and reply code
(RWr10) to D1 and D2 when the instruction
MOV W10 D2 code execution completion (RX0F) turns on.
24 END
SB49 SW0B0.0
0 M0 Check the data link status of the station 1
M0 X101A X20
3 Y101A Turn on the error reset request flag (RY1A)
Turn off the error reset request flag (RY1A)
Error status flag
when the error status flag (RX1A) is off.
7 END
NOTE
• The inverter reset with the flag RY1A shown above is enabled at an inverter fault only.
• When Pr.349 Communication reset selection = "0", inverter reset is available independently of the operation mode.
• When using the instruction code execution request (RY0F) with the instruction code (HFD) and data (H9696) to reset the
inverter, set a value other than "0" in Pr.340 Communication startup mode selection or change the operation mode to the
Network operation mode. (For the program example, refer to page 52.)
• Refer to page 281 for operation conditions of inverter reset.
Instructions
Programming instructions
• Since the buffer memory data of the master station is kept transferred (refreshed) to/from the inverters, the TO instruction
need not be executed every scan in response to data write or read requests. The execution of the TO instruction every
scan does not pose any problem.
• If the FROM/TO instruction is executed frequently, data may not be written reliably. When transferring data between the
inverter and sequence program via the buffer memory, perform the handshake to confirm that data has been written
without error.
TO instruction TO instruction
Correct Incorrect
Write completion Write completion
56 2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
• If multiple inverters have the same station number, the communication cannot be performed properly.
• If the programmable controller (master station) is reset during operation through the CC-Link IE TSN or if the
programmable controller is powered off, data communication stops and the inverter protective function (E.EHR) is
1
activated. To reset the programmable controller (master station), switch the operation mode to the External operation once,
then reset the programmable controller.
• When Pr.340 = "0", any inverter whose main power is restored is reset to return to the External operation mode. To resume
2
the Network operation, therefore, set the operation mode to the Network operation using the sequence program. Set a
value other than "0" in Pr.340 to start in the Network operation mode after inverter reset. (For details of Pr.340, refer to the
FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
3
Troubleshooting
Description Point to be checked 4
Communication is not established. Check that the communication speed is not set to 10 Mbps.
Check that the Ethernet cable is installed correctly. (Check for contact fault, break in the cable, etc.)
Operation mode does not switch to the
Network operation mode.
Check that the inverter is in the External operation mode.
Check that the operation mode switching program is running.
5
Check that the operation mode switching program has been written correctly.
Check that the inverter starting program is running.
Inverter does not start in the Network
operation mode.
Check that the inverter starting program has been written correctly. 6
Check that Pr.338 Communication operation command source is not set to External.
NOTE
• When the power supply of one of the inverters connected in line topology is turned OFF then ON during communication, E.EHR
7
may be activated in the preceding inverter on the same communication. In such a case, stop the communication and turn OFF
then ON the power supply of the inverter in which E.EHR is activated.
8
10
2. Ethernet Communication
2.5 CC-Link IE TSN
57
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
2.6.1 Outline
The CC-Link IE Field Network Basic enables CC-Link IE communication using the general-purpose Ethernet-based
technology. The CC-Link IE Field Network Basic is suited to small-scale equipment for which high-speed control is not
necessary, and can coexist with the standard Ethernet TCP/IP (HTTP, FTP, etc.).
Communication specifications
The communication specification varies depending on the specification of the master.
Item Description
Communication speed 100 Mbps (10 Mbps is not supported.)
Communication method UDP
Master: 1
Number of connectable units
Remote: up to 64 stations (16 stations × 4 groups)*2
Ethernet cable (IEEE 802.3 100BASE-TX compliant cable and ANSI/TIA/EIA-568-B (Category
Connection cable
5) compliant shielded 4-pair branched cable)
Topology Line, star, or a combination of line and star
Number of occupied stations One station occupied
RX 64 (8 bytes)
Maximum number of links per RY 64 (8 bytes)
station RWr 32 (64 bytes)
RWw 32 (64 bytes)
Reference response time*1 Within 15 ms
*1 The reference response time is the period from when the inverter receives a command from the master until the inverter returns the response to
the master.
*2 The specification differs depending on the date of manufacture of the inverter. Refer to page 284 and check the SERIAL number.
NOTE
• To use the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic, do not install the FR-A8NC E kit to the inverter. (Doing so disables communication
through the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic.)
Before communication
1. Connect each unit with an Ethernet cable. (Refer to page 15.)
3. Set "61450" (CC-Link IE Field Network Basic) in any of Pr.1427 to Pr.1430 Ethernet function selection 1 to 4.
(Refer to page 61.)
(Example: Pr.1429 = "45238" (CC-Link IE TSN) (initial value) → "61450" (CC-Link IE Field Network Basic))
When Pr.1429 = "45238 (initial value)" (CC-Link IE TSN), change the value to "61450" (CC-Link IE Filed Network
Basic). When "45238" is set in any of Pr.1427 to Pr.1430, the priority is given to CC-Link IE TSN, disabling CC-Link
IE Field Network Basic.
58 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
Registering a profile
1. Start the engineering software (GX Works3). 1
2. On the menu bar, select [Tool] > [Profile Management] > [Register...].
3. Select a CSP+ file to be registered on the "Register Profile" screen, and click the [Register] button. 2
NOTE
• A profile is a compressed file (such as *.zip, *.ipar, and *.cspp). Register a profile without decompressing the file.
• Profile registration is not required for the next time onwards. 3
• To use GX Works2, refer to "6.1.4 Setting the station information in the CC-Link IEF Basic configuration window" in GX Works2
Version 1 Operating Manual (Common) (SH-080779ENG).
4
Creating a project file
1. For information on creating and opening a project, go to [Help] > [GX Works3 Help].
Detecting an Inverter
5
Detection is not possible when the data link is not established with the master module. For details, refer to the Master Module
User's Manual.
6
1. In the "Navigation" window, select [Parameter] > [Module Parameter].
10
3. In the "CC-Link IEF Basic Configuration" window, go to [Network Configuration Settings] then click next to the
[Detailed Setting] field.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
59
4. In the "CC-Link IEF Basic Configuration" window, click [Detect Now].
Yes No
6. The FR-E800-E or the FR-E800-SCE will appear on the screen when it is detected. (FR-E800-E inverters are
displayed in the following example.) Click [Close with Reflecting the Setting] to close the window.
FR-E800-E
FR-E800-E
FR-E800-E
Host Station
Checking communication
The following table shows the status of the LEDs when communication is established between the programmable controller
and the inverter. Check the "CC-Link IEF Basic Diagnostics" window to confirm that the communication is established between
them.
NS MS LINK1 LINK2
OFF Solid green Blinking green*1
60 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
*1 The LED on either LINK1 or LINK2 will blink depending on the port (port 1 or 2) the Ethernet cable is connected to.
NOTE 1
• If the FR-E800-(SC)E cannot be detected, on the menu bar select [Diagnostics (D)] > [CC-Link IEF Basic Diagnostics]. The
"CC-Link IEF Basic Diagnostics" window will be displayed. The network status or fault records can be checked.
9
2.6.3 Initial setting for CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
Use the following parameters to perform required settings for Ethernet communication between the inverter and other devices.
10
To make communication between other devices and the inverter, perform the initial settings of the inverter parameters to match
the communication specifications of the devices. Data communication cannot be made if the initial settings are not made or if
there is any setting error.
Initial
Pr. Name Setting range Description
value
1427 Ethernet function
5001
N630*1 selection 1
1428 502, 5000 to 5002, 5006
Ethernet function
*1 45237 to 5008, 5010 to 5013,
N631 selection 2
9999, 34962*3, 44818*2, Set the application, protocol, etc.
1429 Ethernet function
45238 45237, 45238, 47808*2,
N632*1 selection 3
61450
1430 Ethernet function
9999
N633*1 selection 4
Ethernet communication is available, but the inverter output is
0
shut off in the NET operation mode.
Set the interval of the communication check (signal loss
detection) time for all devices with IP addresses in the range
1432 Ethernet communication
1.5 s specified for Ethernet command source selection (Pr.1449 to
N644 check time interval 0.1 to 999.8 s
Pr.1454).
If a no-communication state persists for longer than the
permissible time, the inverter output will be shut off.
9999 No communication check (signal loss detection)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
61
Initial
Pr. Name Setting range Description
value
1449 Ethernet command source
0
N670*1 selection IP address 1
1450 Ethernet command source
0
N671*1 selection IP address 2
0 to 255
1451 Ethernet command source To limit the network devices that send the operation or speed
0
N672*1 selection IP address 3 command through the Ethernet network, set the range of IP
1452 addresses of the devices.
Ethernet command source
0 When Pr.1449 to Pr.1452 = "0 (initial value)", no IP address is
N673*1 selection IP address 4
specified for command source selection via Ethernet. In this
1453 Ethernet command source case, operation commands cannot be sent via Ethernet.
*1 selection IP address 3 9999
N674 range specification
0 to 255, 9999
1454 Ethernet command source
selection IP address 4 9999
N675*1 range specification
*1 The setting is applied after an inverter reset or next power-ON.
*2 The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPA and the FR-E800-SCEPA.
*3 The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPB and the FR-E800-SCEPB.
NOTE
• The monitor items and parameter settings can be read during communication with the Pr.1432 Ethernet communication
check time interval = "0 (initial value)" setting, but such operation will become faulty once the operation mode is changed to
the NET operation mode. When the NET operation mode is selected as the start-up operation mode, communication is
performed once, then an Ethernet communication fault (E.EHR) occurs.
To perform operation or parameter writing via communication, set Pr.1432 to "9999" or a value larger than the communication
cycle or retry time setting. (Refer to page 63.)
• When the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic is used, a communication error (E.EHR) occurs regardless of the Pr.1432 Ethernet
communication check time interval setting in the following cases: the data addressed to the own station is not received for
the predetermined timeout period or longer, or the status bit of the cyclic transmission addressed to the own station turns OFF
(when the master inverter gives a command to stop the cyclic transmission). (For the details of the timeout period, status bit
of the cyclic transmission, and command to stop the cyclic transmission, refer to the User's Manual of the master device which
supports the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic.)
NOTE
• Change the setting if selected communication protocols cannot be used together. (Refer to page 7 and page 223.)
62 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
• The setting range for command source selection depends on the settings in Pr.1451 and Pr.1453, and Pr.1452 and
Pr.1454. (Either of the settings can be larger than the other in Pr.1451 and Pr.1453, and Pr.1452 and Pr.1454.)
1
[Setting example 1]
Configuration
2
3
Master station Remote station 1 Remote station 2
iQ-R R08CPU FR-E800 FR-E800
192.168.50.100 192.168.50.1 192.168.50.2
To allow the master station to control the remote stations, set the parameters in remote stations 1 and 2 as follows to specify the IP 4
address range for Ethernet command source selection.
Set the IP address of the master station in the engineering software (GX Works3) within the range from 192.168.50.100 to
192.168.50.110.
Ethernet IP address
Pr.1449 Pr.1450 Pr.1451 Pr.1452 5
for command source selection 192 168 50 100
8
Ethernet IP address
192 168 1 100
for command source selection
The range is between The range is between
the values set in both the values set in both
parameters. parameters.
Pr.1453 Pr.1454
9
Command source selection range setting
for the Ethernet IP address ― ― 3 150
In this case, the IP address range for command source selection via Ethernet communication is
"192.168.x (1 to 3).xxx (100 to 150)".
10
• When "9999 (initial value)" is set in Pr.1453 or Pr.1454, the range is invalid.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
63
• Communication check is started at the first communication when the inverter operates in the Network operation mode and
the command source is specified as communication via the Ethernet connector.
Example) When Pr.1432 = 0.1 to 999.8 s
Connected device
Inverter
Inverter
Connected device Fault (E.EHR)
Check starts
Pr.1432
Communication
check counter Time
E.EHR OFF ON
LF OFF ON
1426 Link speed and duplex Set the communication speed and the communication mode (full-
0 0 to 4
N641*1 mode selection duplex/half-duplex).
1442 IP filter address 1
0
N660*1 (Ethernet)
1443 IP filter address 2
0
N661*1 (Ethernet)
0 to 255
1444 IP filter address 3
0
N662*1 (Ethernet)
1445 Set the range of connectable IP addresses for the network devices.
IP filter address 4
0 (When Pr.1442 to Pr.1445 = "0 (initial value)", the function is
N663*1 (Ethernet)
invalid.)
1446 IP filter address 2 range
9999
N664*1 specification (Ethernet)
1447 IP filter address 3 range
9999 0 to 255, 9999
N665*1 specification (Ethernet)
1448 IP filter address 4 range
9999
N666*1 specification (Ethernet)
804 Torque command source In the torque control mode, the torque command source can be
0 0, 1, 3 to 6
D400 selection selected.
810 Torque limit input method
0 0 to 2 The torque limit input method can be selected.
H700 selection
*1 The setting is applied after an inverter reset or next power-ON.
64 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
Pr.544 setting Description Refer to page
100
112
Compatible with CC-Link Ver.1
Compatible with the double setting of CC-Link Ver.2
1
PLC function —*1
114 Compatible with the quadruple setting of CC-Link Ver.2
118, 138 Compatible with the octuple setting of CC-Link Ver.2
*1 Refer to the PLC Function Programming Manual. 2
Frequency command with sign (Pr.541)
• The start command (forward/reverse rotation) can be inverted by adding a plus or minus sign to the value of the frequency
command sent through the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic.
3
• The Pr.541 Frequency command sign selection setting is applied to the frequency command from RWw1. (Refer to
page 71.)
4
Rotations per minute
Pr.541
(machine speed) setting Sign Setting range Actual frequency command
setting
using Pr.37 and Pr.53
Disabled
0 Without 0 to 59000 0 to 590.00 Hz 5
1 With -32768 to 32767 (two's complement) -327.68 to 327.67 Hz
0 Without 0 to 65535 The rotation speed command or the machine
Enabled speed command is selected depending on the
1 With -32768 to 32767 (two's complement)
Pr.37 and Pr.53 settings. (1 increments) 6
• Relationship between the start command and sign (Pr.541 = "1")
Start
command
Sign of the frequency
command
Actual operation
command
7
Forward + Forward rotation
rotation - Reverse rotation
Reverse + Reverse rotation 8
rotation - Forward rotation
NOTE 9
• When Pr.541 = "1" (with sign)
• When EEPROM write is specified by turning ON of RYE, write mode error (error code H01) will occur.
• When both RYD and RYE are turned ON while both of them are enabled (Pr.544 ≠ "0"), RYD has precedence.
• When power is turned ON (inverter reset), the initial setting status of the sign bit is "positive" and the set frequency is 0 Hz.
10
(The motor does not operate at the frequency set before turning OFF the power (inverter reset).)
• When set frequency is written with the instruction code of HED or HEE, the sign of the frequency command is not changed.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
65
Refer to Refer to
Device No.*7 Signal Device No.*7 Signal
page page
RYnA Pr.186 assignment function (NET X2)*5 69 RXnA Pr.314 assignment function (DO1)*4 70
RYnB Pr.184 assignment function (RES)*5 69 RXnB Pr.315 assignment function (DO2)*4 70
RYnC Monitor command 69 RXnC Monitoring 70
RYnD Frequency setting command (RAM) 69 RXnD Frequency setting completion (RAM) 70
Frequency setting command (RAM, Frequency setting completion (RAM,
RYnE 69 RXnE 70
EEPROM) EEPROM)
RYnF Instruction code execution request 69 RXnF Instruction code execution completed 70
RX(n+1)0 to
Reserved —
RX(n+1)5
RY(n+1)0 to
Reserved —
RY(n+1)7 RX(n+1)6 Pr.195 assignment function (NET Y3)*6 70
RX(n+1)7 *6 70
Pr.196 assignment function (NET Y4)
Not used Not used
RY(n+1)8 — RX(n+1)8 —
(initial data process completion flag) (initial data process request flag)
Not used Not used
RY(n+1)9 — RX(n+1)9 —
(initial data process request flag) (initial data process completion flag)
RY(n+1)A Error reset request flag 69 RX(n+1)A Error status flag 70
RY(n+1)B Pr.187 assignment function (NET X3)*5 69 RX(n+1)B Remote station ready 70
RY(n+1)C Pr.188 assignment function (NET X4)*5 69 RX(n+1)C In-position*2 70
RY(n+1)D Pr.189 assignment function (NET X5)*5 69 RX(n+1)D During position command operation*2 70
RY(n+1)E RX(n+1)E Home position return completed*2 70
Reserved —
RY(n+1)F RX(n+1)F Home position return failure*2 70
*1 These signals are set in the initial setting. Using Pr.180 to Pr.183, input signals assigned to the device numbers can be changed.
For details of Pr.180 to Pr.183, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*2 The signals are fixed. They cannot be changed using parameters.
*3 These signals are set in the initial setting. Using Pr.190 to Pr.192, output signals assigned to the device numbers can be changed.
For details of Pr.190 to Pr.192, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*4 Output signal can be assigned using Pr.313 to Pr.315.
For details, refer to the description of Pr.313 to Pr.315 (Output terminal function selection) in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*5 Input signals can be assigned using Pr.184 to Pr.189.
For details, refer to the description of Pr.184 to Pr.189 (Input terminal function selection) in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*6 Output signals can be assigned using Pr.193 to Pr.196.
For details, refer to the description of Pr.193 to Pr.196 (Output terminal function selection) in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*7 "n" indicates a value determined by the station number.
• Remote registers
Description Refer to Refer to
Address*5 Address*5 Description
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page page
RWwn Monitor code 2 Monitor code 1 70 RWrn First monitor value*4 72
Set frequency (0.01 Hz increments) /
RWwn+1 71 RWrn+1 Second monitor value*4 72
torque command*2*3
RWwn+2 H00 (arbitrary)*1 Instruction code 71 RWrn+2 Reply code 72
RWwn+3 Data to be written 71 RWrn+3 Data to be read 72
*1 The upper 8 bits always contains H00 even a different value is set.
*2 When Pr.804 = "3 or 5" during torque control under Real sensorless vector control or Vector control, a torque command value is set in RWwn+1.
*3 The display can be changed to rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.37 and Pr.53.
*4 When the item displayed in frequency is selected, the Pr.37 and Pr.53 settings are invalid.
*5 "n" indicates a value determined by the station number.
66 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
Description Refer to Description Refer to
Address*4 Address*4
Upper 8 bits
Link parameter
Lower 8 bits page Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page
1
RWwn+2 Instruction code 71 RWrn+2 Reply code 2 Reply code 1 72
extended setting
RWwn+3 Data to be written 71 RWrn+3 Data to be read 72
*1 When Pr.804 = "3 or 5" during torque control under Real sensorless vector control or Vector control, a torque command value is set in RWwn+1. 2
*2 The display can be changed to rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.37 and Pr.53.
*3 When the item displayed in frequency is selected, the Pr.37 and Pr.53 settings are invalid.
*4 "n" indicates a value determined by the station number.
When Pr.544 = "12" (Compatible with the double setting of CC-Link Ver.2) 3
• Remote I/O signals
Settings are the same as those when Pr.544 = "0". (Refer to page 65.)
• Remote registers 4
Description Refer to Description Refer to
Address*4 Address*4
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page
RWwn Monitor code 2 Monitor code 1 70 RWrn First monitor value*3 72 5
Set frequency (0.01 Hz increments) /
RWwn+1 71 RWrn+1 Second monitor value*3 72
torque command*1*2
RWwn+2
Link parameter
extended setting
Instruction code 71 RWrn+2 Reply code 2 Reply code 1 72 6
RWwn+3 Data to be written 71 RWrn+3 Data to be read 72
RWwn+4 Monitor code 3 71 RWrn+4 Third monitor value*3 72
RWwn+5 Monitor code 4 71 RWrn+5 Fourth monitor value*3 72
7
RWwn+6 Monitor code 5 71 RWrn+6 Fifth monitor value*3 72
RWwn+7 Monitor code 6 71 RWrn+7 *3 72
Sixth monitor value
*1 When Pr.804 = "3 or 5" during torque control under Real sensorless vector control or Vector control, a torque command value is set in RWwn+1.
8
*2 The display can be changed to rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.37 and Pr.53.
*3 When the item displayed in frequency is selected, the Pr.37 and Pr.53 settings are invalid.
*4 "n" indicates a value determined by the station number.
9
When Pr.544 = "14" (Compatible with the quadruple setting of CC-Link Ver.2)
• Remote I/O signals
Settings are the same as those when Pr.544 = "0". (Refer to page 65.)
10
• Remote registers
Description Refer to Description Refer to
Address*5 Address*5
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page
RWwn Monitor code 2 Monitor code 1 70 RWrn First monitor value*3 72
RWwn+1 Set frequency (0.01 Hz increments)*2 71 RWrn+1 Second monitor value*3 72
Link parameter
RWwn+2 Instruction code 71 RWrn+2 Reply code 2 Reply code 1 72
extended setting
RWwn+3 Data to be written 71 RWrn+3 Data to be read 72
RWwn+4 Monitor code 3 71 RWrn+4 Third monitor value*3 72
RWwn+5 Monitor code 4 71 RWrn+5 Fourth monitor value*3 72
RWwn+6 Monitor code 5 71 RWrn+6 Fifth monitor value*3 72
RWwn+7 Monitor code 6 71 RWrn+7 Sixth monitor value*3 72
Fault record (fault
RWwn+8 Fault record No. H00 71 RWrn+8 Fault record No. 72
data)
RWwn+9 PID set point (0.01% increments)*1 71 RWrn+9 Fault record (output frequency)*4 72
RWwn+A *1 71 RWrn+A Fault record (output current) 72
PID measured value (0.01% increments)
RWwn+B PID deviation (0.01% increments)*1 71 RWrn+B Fault record (output voltage) 72
RWwn+C Torque command or torque limit 71, 77 RWrn+C Fault record (energization time) 72
RWwn+D RWrn+D
RWwn+E H00 (Free) — RWrn+E H00 (Free) —
RWwn+F RWrn+F
*1 Validity depends on the Pr.128, Pr.609, and Pr.610 settings. For details, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function). If the data outside
the range is set, the previous setting is retained.
*2 The display can be changed to rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.37 and Pr.53.
*3 When the item displayed in frequency is selected, the Pr.37 and Pr.53 settings are invalid.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
67
*4 The frequency is always displayed regardless of the settings in Pr.37 and Pr.53.
*5 "n" indicates a value determined by the station number.
When Pr.544 = "18 or 38" (Compatible with the octuple setting of CC-Link Ver.2)
• Remote I/O signals
Settings are the same as those when Pr.544 = "0". (Refer to page 65.)
• Remote registers
Description Refer to Description Refer to
Address*5 Address*5
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits page
RWwn Monitor code 2 Monitor code 1 70 RWrn First monitor value*3 72
RWwn+1 Set frequency (0.01 Hz increments)*2 71 RWrn+1 Second monitor value*3 72
Link parameter
RWwn+2 Instruction code 71 RWrn+2 Reply code 2 Reply code 1 72
extended setting
RWwn+3 Data to be written 71 RWrn+3 Data to be read 72
RWwn+4 Monitor code 3 71 RWrn+4 Third monitor value*3 72
RWwn+5 Monitor code 4 71 RWrn+5 Fourth monitor value*3 72
RWwn+6 Monitor code 5 71 RWrn+6 *3 72
Fifth monitor value
RWwn+7 Monitor code 6 71 RWrn+7 Sixth monitor value*3 72
Fault record (fault
RWwn+8 Fault record No. H00 71 RWrn+8 Fault record No. 72
data)
RWwn+9 PID set point (0.01% increments)*1 71 RWrn+9 Fault record (output frequency)*4 72
RWwn+A PID measured value (0.01% increments)*1 71 RWrn+A Fault record (output current) 72
RWwn+B PID deviation (0.01% increments)*1 71 RWrn+B Fault record (output voltage) 72
RWwn+C Torque command or torque limit 71, 77 RWrn+C Fault record (energization time) 72
RWwn+D H00 (Free) RWrn+D
RWwn+E H00 (Free) — RWrn+E H00 (Free) —
RWwn+F H00 (Free) RWrn+F
Link parameter
RWwn+10 Instruction code 71 RWrn+10 Reply code 72
extended setting
RWwn+11 Data to be written 71 RWrn+11 Data to be read 72
Link parameter
RWwn+12 Instruction code 71 RWrn+12 Reply code 72
extended setting
RWwn+13 Data to be written 71 RWrn+13 Data to be read 72
Link parameter
RWwn+14 Instruction code 71 RWrn+14 Reply code 72
extended setting
RWwn+15 Data to be written 71 RWrn+15 Data to be read 72
Link parameter
RWwn+16 Instruction code 71 RWrn+16 Reply code 72
extended setting
RWwn+17 Data to be written 71 RWrn+17 Data to be read 72
Link parameter
RWwn+18 Instruction code 71 RWrn+18 Reply code 72
extended setting
RWwn+19 Data to be written 71 RWrn+19 Data to be read 72
RWwn+1A RWrn+1A
RWwn+1B RWrn+1B
RWwn+1C RWrn+1C
H00 (Free) — H00 (Free) —
RWwn+1D RWrn+1D
RWwn+1E RWrn+1E
RWwn+1F RWrn+1F
*1 Validity depends on the Pr.128, Pr.609, and Pr.610 settings. For details, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function). If the data outside
the range is set, the previous setting is retained.
*2 The display can be changed to rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.37 and Pr.53.
*3 When the item displayed in frequency is selected, the Pr.37 and Pr.53 settings are invalid.
*4 The frequency is always displayed regardless of the settings in Pr.37 and Pr.53.
*5 "n" indicates a value determined by the station number.
68 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
Output signals (from the master module to the inverter)
Output signals from the master module are as follows. (Input signals to the inverter)
1
Device No. Signal Description
0: Stop
command
RY0 Forward rotation command*2 1: Forward 2
rotation start When "1" is set, a start command is input to the inverter.
0: Stop When "1" is set in RY0 and RY1, a stop command is input.
command
RY1 Reverse rotation command*2 1: Reverse 3
rotation start
High-speed operation command (terminal
RY2
RH function)*1
Middle-speed operation command
4
RY3 Functions assigned to Pr.180 to Pr.182 are activated.
(terminal RM function)*1
Low-speed operation command (terminal
RY4
RL function)*1 5
RY5 JOG operation selection 2*2 JOG2 signal
RY6 Second function selection*2 RT signal
RY7 Current input selection *2 AU signal 6
RY8 — (terminal NET X1 function)*3 The function assigned to Pr.185 is activated.
RY9 Output stop (terminal MRS function)*1 The function assigned to Pr.183 is activated.
RYA — (terminal NET X2 function)*3 The function assigned to Pr.186 is activated. 7
RYB — (Function of terminal RES)*3 The function assigned to Pr.184 is activated.
When "1" is set in RYC, the monitored value is set in the remote register RWr0,
RYC Monitor command 1, 4 to 7, and "1" is set in RXC (device for the Monitoring signal). While "1" is
set in RYC, the monitored data is always updated. 8
When "1" is set in RYD, the set frequency / torque command (RWw1) is written
to the RAM of the inverter.*4
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
69
*6 Refer to page 281 for operation conditions of inverter reset.
*7 Torque control cannot be performed with a PM motor.
70 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
Device No. Signal Description
Specify the set frequency or rotations per minute (machine speed). At this time, whether to
write to the RAM or EEPROM is decided with the RYD and RYE settings. After setting the set
1
Set frequency*1*2 frequency in this register, set "1" in RYD or RYE to write the frequency. After writing of
frequency is completed, "1" is set in RXD or RXE in response to the input command. The
setting range is 0 to 590.00 Hz (0.01 Hz increments). Write "59000" when setting 590.00 Hz.
RWw1 When Pr.544 CC-Link extended setting = "0, 1, or 12" and Pr.804 Torque command 2
source selection = "3 or 5" during torque control under Real sensorless vector control or
Vector control, torque command values are specified. The value is written to the inverter
Torque command value
either by RYD or RYE. Pr.805 Torque command value (RAM) and Pr.806 Torque
command value (RAM, EEPROM) are updated as well. The setting range and the setting 3
increment depend on the Pr.804 setting. (Refer to page 77.)
Set an instruction code (refer to page 73) for an operation such as operation mode switching,
parameter read/write, error reference, and error clear. Set "1" in RYF to execute the
RWw2
Link parameter extended corresponding instruction after completing the register setting. "1" is set in RXF after 4
setting / instruction code completing the execution of the instruction. When a value other than "0" is set to Pr.544,
upper 8 bits are used for the link parameter extended setting.
Example) When reading Pr.160, instruction code is H0200.
Set the data specified by the instruction code of RWw2 (when required). 5
RWw3 Data to be written Set "1" in RYF after setting RWw2 and this register.
Set "0" when the write code is not required.
RWw4 Monitor code 3
RWw5 Monitor code 4 Set the monitor code to be monitored. By setting "1" in RYC after setting, the specified monitor 6
RWw6 Monitor code 5 data is stored in RWr4 to RWr7.
RWw7 Monitor code 6
Set the individual fault number of the fault history that you want to read. Fault records can be
read back to the tenth latest fault. (The value in the lower 8 bits is fixed to H00.)
7
RWw8 Fault record No.
Upper 8 bits: H00 (latest fault) to H09 (tenth latest fault)
When H0A to HFF is set to the lower 8 bits, "0" is returned.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
71
Remote register (from the inverter to the master module)
• Remote register description
Device No. Signal Description
RWr0 First monitor value*1*2 When "1" is set in RYC, the monitor value is set to the lower 8 bits of the monitor code (RWw0).
Second monitor value When "0" is set to the upper 8 bits of the monitor code (RWw0), the current output frequency is
RWr1 *1*2 set. When "1" is set in RYC while a value other than "0" is set to the upper 8 bits of the monitor
(output frequency ) code (RWw0), the monitor value is set to the upper 8 bits of the monitor code (RWw0).
When "1" is set in RYD or RYE, the reply code for the frequency setting command is set. When
Reply code "1" is set in RYF, the reply code corresponding to the instruction code RWw2 is set. The value
(Pr.544 ≠ 0) "0" is set for a normal reply, and a value other than "0" is set for errors with data, mode, and
other. (Refer to page 72.)
Lower 8 bits of RWr2.
RWr2 Reply code 1
When "1" is set in RYD or RYE, the reply code for the frequency setting command (torque
(Pr.544 ≠ 0)
command / torque limit) is set. (Refer to page 72.)
Upper 8 bits of RWr2.
Reply code 2
When "1" is set in RYF, the reply code corresponding to the instruction code RWw2 is set. (Refer
(Pr.544 ≠ 0)
to page 72.)
RWr3 Data to be read In a normal reply, a replay code for the instruction code is set.
RWr4 Third monitor value*1*2
RWr5 Fourth monitor value*1*2 When "1" is set in RYC, the monitor value specified to the corresponding monitor code (RWw4
RWr6 Fifth monitor value*1*2 to RWw7) is stored.
*1 When the item displayed in frequency is selected, the Pr.37 and Pr.53 settings are invalid.
*2 Use Pr.290 to enable display of negative numbers during monitoring. For details, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*3 The frequency is always displayed regardless of the settings in Pr.37 and Pr.53.
72 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
Item Data Item Fault record Remarks
H00 Normal
No fault (Instruction codes are executed
without any fault.)
1
Parameter write is attempted when the
*1 H01 Write mode fault inverter is not in the stop status in the
Reply code 1
Frequency command (torque
Network operation mode.
2
H03 command / torque limit) The value outside the range is set.
setting range error Reply code to RWr2 when
Pr.544 ≠ "0".
H00 Normal
No fault (Instruction codes are executed
without any fault.)
3
Parameter write is attempted when the
Reply code 2 H01 Write mode fault inverter is not in the stop status in the
Reply code to
the torque command
8
Instruction code
Set instruction codes using the remote register (RWw). (Refer to page 70.) 9
The definition read by the instruction code is stored in the remote register (RWr). (Refer to page 72.)
Read/ Instruction
Item Data description
write code
H0000: Network operation
10
Read H7B H0001: External operation, External JOG operation
H0002: PU operation, External/PU combined operation 1 or 2, PUJOG operation
Operation mode
H0000: Network operation
Write HFB H0001: External operation
H0002: PU operation (when Pr.79 = "6")
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
73
Read/ Instruction
Item Data description
write code
H76 Sixth latest fault Fifth latest fault Second latest fault Latest fault
(H30) (HA0)
H77 Eighth latest fault Seventh latest fault
Second latest fault ...... THT
H78 Tenth latest fault Ninth latest fault Latest fault ...... OPT
Read the set frequency or rotations per minute (machine speed) from the RAM or
Set frequency (RAM) H6D EEPROM.
H0000 to HE678: Set frequency in 0.01 Hz increments
(The display can be changed to the rotations per minute (machine speed) using
Read
Pr.37 and Pr.53. Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
Set frequency (EEPROM) H6E • When Pr.544 = "0, 1, or 12" and Pr.804 = "3 or 5" during torque control under Real
sensorless vector control or Vector control, torque command values are read.
The setting range depends on the Pr.804 setting.
Write the set frequency or rotations per minute (machine speed) into the RAM or
EEPROM.
Set frequency (RAM)*4 HED H0000 to HE678 (0 to 590.00 Hz): frequency in 0.01 Hz increments
(The display can be changed to the rotations per minute (machine speed) using
Pr.37 and Pr.53. Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
Write
• To change the set frequency consecutively, write data to the inverter RAM.
Set frequency (RAM and (Instruction code: HED)
HEE • When Pr.544 = "0, 1, or 12" and Pr.804 = "3 or 5" during torque control under Real
EEPROM)*4
sensorless vector control or Vector control, torque commands are given. The
setting range depends on the Pr.804 setting.
• Refer to the instruction codes in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function) and
Read H00 to H6B write and/or read parameter values as required.
Writing to Pr.77 and Pr.79 is disabled.
Parameter When setting Pr.100 and later, set the link parameter extended setting.
• Set 65520 (HFFF0) as a parameter value "8888" and 65535 (HFFFF) as "9999".
Write H80 to HEB • When changing the parameter values frequently, set "1" in Pr.342 to write them
to the RAM. (For details, refer to page 276.)
74 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
Read/ Instruction
Item Data description
write code
Read H7F Parameter settings are changed according to the instruction code settings. For
1
Link parameter extended
details of the settings, refer to the instruction code list in the FR-E800 Instruction
setting*6 Write HFF Manual (Function).
Read H6C
Read or write of bias and gain parameters (instruction codes H5E to H61 and HDE
to HE1 with the link parameter extended setting = "1", H11 to H23 and H91 to HA3 2
with the link parameter extended setting = "9").
Second parameter changing*7
H00: Frequency*8
Write HEC H01: Parameter-set analog value
H02: Analog value input from terminal 3
*1 When "100" is set in Pr.52 Operation panel main monitor selection, the frequency setting value is monitored during a stop, and the output
frequency is monitored during running.
*2
*3
Use Pr.290 to enable display of negative numbers during monitoring. For details, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
Write data is in hexadecimal, and only two digits are valid. (The upper two digits are ignored.)
4
*4 Setting from the remote register (RWw1) is also available.
*5 Turning OFF the power supply while clearing parameters with H5A5A or H55AA returns the communication parameter settings to the initial
*6
settings.
Setting is available only when Pr.544 = "0". Use RWw2 or RWw10, 12, 14, 16, and 18 for setting when Pr.544 ≠ "0". (Refer to page 71.) 5
*7 Reading or writing is available when the link parameter extended setting = "1 or 9".
*8 The gain frequency can be also written using Pr.125 (instruction code: H99) or Pr.126 (instruction code: H9A).
NOTE 6
• When a 32-bit parameter setting or monitor item is read and the value to be read exceeds HFFFF, HFFFF is returned.
Monitor code 7
Various data of the inverter can be monitored by setting the special monitor selection No. of the instruction code and setting
the monitor code in the remote registers, RWw0 and RWw4 to 7.
• Use the monitor code (RWw0) to set the first monitor value (RWr0) in the lower 8 bits, and the second monitor value (RWr1) 8
in the upper 8 bits.
(Example) The monitor code (RWw0) will be H0602 to set the output current as the first monitor value (RWr0) and set the
running speed as the second monitor value (RWr1). 9
• When Pr.544 = "12, 14, 18, or 38", the values for the monitor code 3 (RWw4) to the monitor code 6 (RWw7) can be
selected.
NOTE
• The monitor codes from H01 onwards and their contents are the same as those of the RS-485 communication dedicated
monitor. For details of the monitor codes or monitor items, refer to the monitor display section in the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).
• When the item displayed in frequency is selected in the remote registers, RWw0 and RWw4 to RWw7, the Pr.37 and Pr.53
settings are invalid.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
75
Communication speed and full-duplex/half-duplex selection (Pr.1426)
Use Pr.1426 Link speed and duplex mode selection to set the communication speed and the full-duplex or half-duplex
system. If the operation is not performed properly in the initial setting (Pr.1426 = "0"), set Pr.1426 according to the
specifications of the connected device.
Communication Full-duplex/half-
Pr.1426 setting Remarks
speed duplex system
The communication speed and the communication mode (half-duplex/full-
Automatic Automatic duplex) are automatically negotiated to ensure the optimum setting. To set
0 (initial value)
negotiation negotiation automatic negotiation, auto negotiation setting is required also in the master
station.
1 100 Mbps Full duplex —
2 100 Mbps Half duplex —
3 10 Mbps Full duplex
The communication speed is fixed at 100 Mbps. Do not set 10 Mbps.
4 10 Mbps Half duplex
[Setting example 2]
Pr.1442 Pr.1443 Pr.1444 Pr.1445
IP filter address (Ethernet) 192 168 2 100
The range is between
the values set in both
parameters.
Pr.1446 Pr.1447 Pr.1448
IP filter address range specification
(Ethernet) ― 9999 9999 50
In this case, the IP address range in which Ethernet communication is permitted is "192.168.2.xxx (50 to 100)".
CAUTION
• The IP filtering function (Ethernet) (Pr.1442 to Pr.1448) is provided as a means to prevent unauthorized access, DoS
attacks, computer viruses, or other cyberattacks from external devices, but the function does not prevent such access
completely. In order to protect the inverter and the system against unauthorized access by external systems, take
additional security measures. We shall have no responsibility or liability for any problems involving inverter trouble and
system trouble by DoS attacks, unauthorized access, computer viruses, and other cyberattacks. The following are
examples of measures to prevent them.
- Install a firewall.
- Install a personal computer as a relay station, and control the relaying of transmission data using an application
program.
- Install an external device as a relay station to control access rights. (For the details of external devices used to control
access rights, contact the distributors of the external devices.)
76 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
Torque command / torque limit using the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
Torque commands can be given or the torque can be limited on the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic under Real sensorless 1
vector control, Vector control, or PM sensorless vector control. The value is used to limit the torque during speed control or
position control, and to give a torque command during torque control. To limit the torque, set Pr.810 Torque limit input method
selection = "2". The torque command / torque limit setting method can be selected using Pr.804 Torque command source 2
selection. (Torque control cannot be performed with a PM motor.)
Initial Setting
Pr. Name Description
value range 3
0 Torque command given by analog input via terminal 4
Torque command / torque limit using the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
1 • Torque command / torque limit (-400% to 400%) by the parameter setting
(Pr.805 or Pr.806)*1*2 4
Torque command / torque limit using the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
• Torque command / torque limit (-400% to 400%) by the parameter setting
3 (Pr.805 or Pr.806)*1*2
• Setting is available using the remote register RWw1 or RWwC (-400% to 5
*2
400%).
Torque command source
804 0 4 Torque command given by 16-bit digital input (FR-A8AX)
selection
Torque command / torque limit using the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
• Torque command / torque limit (-327.68% to 327.67%) by the parameter
6
setting (Pr.805 or Pr.806)
5
(-327.68% to 327.67%)*1*2
• Setting is available using the remote register RWw1 or RWwC (-327.68% to
327.67%).*2
7
Torque command / torque limit using the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
6 • Torque command / torque limit (-327.68% to 327.67%) by the parameter
setting (Pr.805 or Pr.806)*1*2 8
0 Internal torque limit (torque limited by parameter settings)
Torque limit input method
810 0 1 External torque limit (torque limited by terminal 4)
selection
*1
2
The value can also be set using the operation panel.
Internal torque limit 2 (torque limited by CC-Link IE Field Network Basic)
9
*2 When a negative value is set as the torque limit, the torque is limited by the absolute value.
List of I/O devices whose function is changed according to the parameter settings and the
control method 10
Real sensorless vector control / Vector control / PM
V/F control / Advanced magnetic sensorless vector control
Pr.544 setting I/O device
flux vector control Speed control / position
Torque control*3
control
Frequency setting / torque limit
— RYD Frequency setting command (RAM) Torque command (RAM)
command (RAM)
Frequency setting command (RAM, Frequency setting / torque limit Torque command (RAM,
— RYE
EEPROM) command (RAM, EEPROM) EEPROM)
Frequency setting / torque limit Torque command completion
— RXD Frequency setting completion (RAM)
completion (RAM) (RAM)
Frequency setting completion (RAM, Frequency setting / torque limit Torque command completion
— RXE
EEPROM) completion (RAM, EEPROM) (RAM, EEPROM)
0, 1, 12 Torque command*1
RWw1 Set frequency Set frequency
14, 18, 38 —
0, 1, 12 — —
RWwC —
14, 18, 38 Torque limit*1*2 Torque command*1
*1 Set Pr.804 = "3 or 5".
*2 Set Pr.810 = "2".
*3 Torque control cannot be performed with a PM motor.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
77
Torque command setting method and the parameter for speed limit
Parameter
Pr.804 setting Pr.544 setting Torque command setting method (any one of the following) for speed
limit
• Set the torque command value in RWwn+1, and "1" in RYD or RYE.
• Set the instruction code HED or HEE in RWwn+2, the torque command value in
RWwn+3, and "1" in RYF. (The torque command value can be read using the
Pr.808,
0, 1, 12 instruction code H6D or H6E.)
Pr.809
• Set H08 in the link parameter extended setting, the instruction code H85 and H86 in
3, 5 RWwn+2, the torque command value in RWwn+3, and "1" in RYF. (Writing in Pr.805 or
Pr.806)
• Set the torque command value in RWwn+C, and "1" in RYD or RYE.
• Set H08 in the link parameter extended setting, the instruction code H85 and H86 in
14, 18, 38
RWwn+2, the torque command value in RWwn+3, and "1" in RYF. (Writing in Pr.805 or
Pr.806)
Pr.807
Set H08 in the link parameter extended setting, the instruction code H85 and H86 in
0, 1, 12, 14, 18,
1, 6 RWwn+2, the torque command value in RWwn+3, and "1" in RYF. (Writing in Pr.805 or
38
Pr.806)
0, 4 — Torque command using the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic is not available.
Relationship between the Pr.804 setting, the setting range, and the actual torque command /
torque limit (when setting is made from CC-Link IE Field Network Basic communication)
Pr.804 setting Setting range Actual torque command Actual torque limit
1, 3 600 to 1400 (1% increments)*1 -400 to 400% 0 to 400%
-32768 to 32767 (two's
5, 6 -327.68 to 327.67% 0 to 327.67%
complement)*1
Programming examples
The following explains the programming examples for controlling the inverter with sequence programs.
Refer to
Item Program example
page
Reading the inverter status Reading the inverter status from the buffer memory of the master station 80
Setting the operation mode Selecting the Network operation mode 80
Setting the operation commands Commanding the forward rotation and middle speed signals 81
Setting the monitoring function Monitoring the output frequency 81
Reading a parameter value Reading the value of Pr.7 Acceleration time 82
Writing a parameter value Setting 3.0 seconds in Pr.7 Acceleration time 82
Frequency setting (speed setting) Setting to 50.00 Hz 83
Reading the fault records Reading the inverter faults 84
Inverter reset Resetting the inverter when an inverter error occurs 84
78 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
• System configuration example (when the MELSEC iQ-R series programmable controller is used)
Programmable
Power
CPU
Input module Output module 1
supply RX40C7 RY40PT5P
controller R04CPU
R61P (X20 to X2F) (Y30 to Y3F)
Hub
2
Inverter
Pr.544=0
Inverter
Pr.544=0
3
(station (station
No.1) No.2)
Remote station
Y100F to Y1000 (station 2)
Y101F to Y1010
Y102F to Y1020 RX0F to RX00
Y103F to Y1030 RX1F to RX10
Y104F to Y1040
Y105F to Y1050
RY0F to RY00
RY1F to RY10
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
79
• The following diagram shows the remote register areas (RWw and RWr) transmitted between the programmable controller
CPU and remote stations. Shaded areas show the devices actually used.
Remote station
Programmable controller CPU (station 1)
For writing
W100 RWw0
W101 RWw1
W102 RWw2
W103 RWw3
:
W11F RWr0
W120 RWr1
W121 RWr2
W122 RWr3
W123
:
W13F
Remote station
For reading (station 2)
W000
W001
W002 RWw0
W003 RWw1
: RWw2
W01F RWw3
W020
W021 RWr0
W022 RWr1
W023 RWr2
: RWr3
W03F
M0 X1002 Y30
(4) Turn on the output unit (Y00)
(7) END
X101F X1000
Remote input
b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
One RXF to RX0
station RX1F to RX10 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
[Inverter status]
b31 b30 b29 b28 b27 b26 b25 b24 b23 b22 b21 b20 b19 b18 b17 b16
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
[Inverter status]
Inverter status
b0 : Forward running b7 : Fault (ABC)*1
b1 : Reverse running b8 : (NET Y2)*1
b2 : Running (RUN)*1 b9 : (DO0)*1
b3 : Up to frequency b10 : (DO1)*1
b4 : Overload warning b11 : (DO2)*1
b5 : (NET Y1)*1 b22 : (NET Y3)*1
b6 : Frequency detection (FU)*1 b23 : (NET Y4)*1
*1 These signals are assigned in the initial status. Use Pr.190 to Pr.196 and Pr.313 to Pr.315 (Output terminal function selection) to change the
output signals.
80 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
• The reply code to the instruction code execution is set in D2. (Refer to page 72.)
(8)
M300
SET M301
2
M301 X100F
(10) MOV H0FB W102
Write operation mode write code (HFB)
MOV H0 W103
to RWw2 and set data (H0000) to RWw3.
3
SET Y100F Turn on the instruction code execution
request (RY0F)
4
RST M301
SET M302
RST Y100F
turns on.
Turn off the instruction code execution 5
request (RY0F)
RST M302
(25) END
6
Programming example for setting the operation commands
The following program gives a forward rotation command and middle-speed operation command to the station 1 inverter. 7
SM1536 SD1536.0 SD1540.0 M0
(0) Check the data link status of the station 1
(4)
M0 X20 Y1000
Forward rotation command (RY00)
8
Y1003
Middle speed operation command (RY03)
(8) END 9
10
Y101F Y1000
b15 b7 b0
RY0F to RY00
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 One station
RY1F to RY10
[Run command] 1: ON
Middle speed Forward rotation 0: OFF
b31 b23 b16
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
[Run command]
Run command
b0 : Forward rotation command b8 : (NET X1)*1
b1 : Reverse rotation command b9 : Output stop (MRS)*1
b2 : High-speed operation command (RH)*1 b10 : (NET X2)*1
b3 : Middle-speed operation command (RM)*1 b11 : (RES)*1
b4 : Low-speed operation command (RL)*1 b27 : (NET X3)*1
b5 : JOG operation selection 2 b28 : (NET X4)*1
b6 : Second function selection b29 : (NET X5)*1
b7 : Current input selection
*1 These signals are assigned in the initial status. Use Pr.180 to Pr.189 (Input terminal function selection) to change the input signals. Some
signals are not controllable by a command from the programmable controller depending on the setting. (For details, refer to the Instruction Manual
(Function).)
The following program reads the output frequency of the station 1 inverter to output to D1.
Output frequency read code: H0001 (hexadecimal)
For the monitor codes, refer to page 75.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
81
Example) The output frequency of 60 Hz is indicated as "H1770 (6000)".
Y1003
(16) END
M300
(8) SET M301
M301 X100F
(10) MOV H7 W102 Write Pr.7 read code (H07) to RWw2.
SET M302
M302 X100F
(17) MOV W3 D1 Read acceleration time (RWr3) and reply code
(RWr2) to D1 and D2 when the instruction code
MOV W2 D2 execution completion (RX0F) turns on.
(25) END
NOTE
• For the parameter assigned the number of 100 or higher, change the link parameter extended setting (set it to the one other
than H00). For the setting values, refer to the instruction code list of the Instruction Manual (Function).
82 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
The reply code to the instruction code execution is set in D2. (Refer to page 72.)
(8)
M300
SET M301
2
M301 X100F
(10) MOV H87 W102
Write Pr.7 write (H87) to RWw2 and
3
acceleration time setting data (K30) to RWw3.
MOV K30 W103
4
RST M301
SET M302
M302 X100F
Read reply code (RWr2) to D2 when the instruction
(19) MOV W2 D2
code execution completion (RX0F) turns on.
RST Y100F Turn off the instruction code execution request (RY0F) 5
RST M302
(25) END
6
NOTE
• For the parameter assigned the number of 100 or higher, change the link parameter extended setting (set it to the one other 7
than H00). For the setting values, refer to the instruction code list of the Instruction Manual (Function).
• For other functions, refer to the instruction codes (refer to page 73).
8
Programming example for frequency setting
The following program changes the frequency setting of the station 1 inverter to 50.00 Hz.
• Set frequency: K5000 (decimal) 9
• The reply code to the instruction code execution is set in D2. (Refer to page 72.)
(0)
SM1536 SD1536.0 SD1540.0 M0
Check the data link status of the station 1 10
M0 X20
(4) PLS M300
M300
(8) SET M301
M301 X100D
(10) MOV K5000 W101 Write set frequency to RWw1.
SET
Turn off the frequency setting
Y100D
command RAM (RY0D)
RST M301
SET M302
M302 X100D
MOV
Read reply code (RWr2) to D2 when the
(17) W2 D2
frequency setting completion (RX0D) turns on.
RST
Turn off the frequency setting command RAM
Y100D
(RY0D)
RST M302
(23) END
NOTE
• To change the set frequency continuously from a programmable controller, check that the frequency setting complete (for
example, X100D) turns ON, and the reply code from the remote register is H0000. Then change the setting data (for example,
W101) continuously.
• To write the set frequency to the EEPROM, change the following points in the program shown above.
- Frequency setting command (from Y100D to Y100E)
- Frequency setting completion (from X100D to X100E)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
83
<Timing chart when writing to RAM> <Timing chart when writing to EEPROM>
Y100D Y100E
*2
W101 W101
*1
Inverter Inverter
running running
frequency frequency Reflect to the inverter when Y100E turns on
*1 To the EEPROM, a writing is performed only once after the command Y100E turns ON.
*2 If the set data is changed at the command Y100E ON, the change is not applied to the inverter.
M300
(8) SET M301
SET M302
M302 X100F
(17) MOV W3 D1 Read alarm data (RWr3) and reply code
(RWr2) to D1 and D2 when the instruction
MOV W2 D2 code execution completion (RX0F) turns on.
Turn off the instruction code execution request
RST Y100F
(RY0F)
RST M302
(25) END
NOTE
• The inverter reset with the flag RY1A shown above is enabled at an inverter fault only.
• When Pr.349 Communication reset selection = "0", inverter reset is available independently of the operation mode.
• When using the instruction code execution request (RY0F) with the instruction code (HFD) and data (H9696) to reset the
inverter, set a value other than "0" in Pr.340 Communication startup mode selection or change the operation mode to the
Network operation mode. (For the program example, refer to page 80.)
• Refer to page 281 for operation conditions of inverter reset.
84 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
Instructions
Operating and handling instructions 1
• The inverter only accepts the commands from the programmable controller during operation using the CC-Link IE Field
Network Basic. Operation commands input from external devices are ignored.
• If multiple inverters have the same station number, the communication cannot be performed properly. 2
• The inverter protective function (E.EHR) is activated if data communication stops for more than the time set in Pr.1432
Ethernet communication check time interval due to a programmable controller fault, an open Ethernet cable etc. during
CC-Link IE Field Network Basic operation. 3
• If the programmable controller (master station) is reset during operation through the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic or if
the programmable controller is powered off, data communication stops and the inverter protective function (E.EHR) is
activated. To reset the programmable controller (master station), switch the operation mode to the External operation once, 4
then reset the programmable controller.
• When Pr.340 = "0", any inverter whose main power is restored is reset to return to the External operation mode. To resume
the Network operation, therefore, set the operation mode to the Network operation using the sequence program. 5
Set a value other than "0" in Pr.340 to start in the Network operation mode after inverter reset. (For details of Pr.340, refer
to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
Troubleshooting 6
Description Point to be checked
Communication is not established. Check that the communication speed is not set to 10 Mbps.
Check that the Ethernet cable is installed correctly. (Check for contact fault, break in the cable, etc.)
7
Operation mode does not switch to the Check that the inverter is in the External operation mode.
Network operation mode. Check that the operation mode switching program is running.
Check that the operation mode switching program has been written correctly. 8
Check that the inverter starting program is running.
Inverter does not start in the Network
Check that the inverter starting program has been written correctly.
operation mode.
Check that Pr.338 Communication operation command source is not set to External.
9
2.6.5 Group number setting
Set a group number to each remote station to divide remote stations into groups and perform cyclic transmission by the group.
By grouping the remote stations by their reference response times, cyclic transmission can be performed smoothly regardless
10
of the differences of the reference response times. (Refer to the CC-Link IE Field Network Basic Reference Manual (SH-
081684ENG) for the details.)
• Star topology
Group No.1∗1
Group No.2∗2
2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
85
• Line topology
86 2. Ethernet Communication
2.6 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic
2.7 MODBUS/TCP 1
2.7.1 Outline 2
The MODBUS/TCP protocol allows transmission of MODBUS messages via Ethernet communication.
Some functions are not supported depending on the date of manufacture of the inverter. For details of specification changes, 3
refer to page 284.
Communication specifications
The communication specifications are shown in the following table.
4
Item Description
Communication protocol MODBUS/TCP protocol
Conforming standard OPEN MODBUS/TCP SPECIFICATION 5
Time delay setting Not available
Maximum number of connections 3
Topology Line, star, or a combination of line and star 6
Number of simultaneously
Client function (server) 1 to 3
acceptable request messages
Pr. Name
Initial
Setting range Description
9
value
1427 Ethernet function selection
5001
N630*1 1
1428 Ethernet function selection
502, 5000 to 5002,
5006 to 5008, 5010 to 10
45237
N631*1 2 5013, 9999, 34962*3
,
Set the application, protocol, etc.
1429 Ethernet function selection 44818*2, 45237,
45238
N632*1 3 45238, 47808*2,
1430 Ethernet function selection 61450
9999
N633*1 4
Ethernet communication is available, but the inverter output
0
is shut off in the NET operation mode.
Set the interval of the communication check (signal loss
detection) time for all devices with IP addresses in the range
1432 Ethernet communication
1.5 s specified for Ethernet command source selection (Pr.1449
N644 check time interval 0.1 to 999.8 s
to Pr.1454).
If a no-communication state persists for longer than the
permissible time, the inverter output will be shut off.
9999 No communication check (signal loss detection)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
87
Initial
Pr. Name Setting range Description
value
1449 Ethernet command source
0
N670*1 selection IP address 1
1450 Ethernet command source
0
N671*1 selection IP address 2
0 to 255
1451 Ethernet command source To limit the network devices that send the operation or
0
N672*1 selection IP address 3 speed command through the Ethernet network, set the
1452 range of IP addresses of the devices.
Ethernet command source
0 When Pr.1449 to Pr.1452 = "0 (initial value)", no IP address
N673*1 selection IP address 4
is specified for command source selection via Ethernet. In
1453 Ethernet command source this case, operation commands cannot be sent via Ethernet.
*1 selection IP address 3 range 9999
N674 specification
0 to 255, 9999
1454 Ethernet command source
selection IP address 4 range 9999
N675*1 specification
*1 The setting is applied after an inverter reset or next power-ON.
*2 The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPA and the FR-E800-SCEPA.
*3 The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPB and the FR-E800-SCEPB.
NOTE
• The monitor items and parameter settings can be read during communication with the Pr.1432 Ethernet communication
check time interval = "0 (initial value)" setting, but such operation will become faulty once the operation mode is changed to
the NET operation mode. When the NET operation mode is selected as the start-up operation mode, communication is
performed once, then an Ethernet communication fault (E.EHR) occurs.
To perform operation or parameter writing via communication, set Pr.1432 to "9999" or a value larger than the communication
cycle or retry time setting. (Refer to page 89.)
88 2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
• The setting range for command source selection depends on the settings in Pr.1451 and Pr.1453, and Pr.1452 and
Pr.1454. (Either of the settings can be larger than the other in Pr.1451 and Pr.1453, and Pr.1452 and Pr.1454.)
1
[Setting example 1]
Configuration
2
3
Master Client 1 Client 2
iQ-R R08CPU FR-E800 FR-E800
192.168.50.100 192.168.50.1 192.168.50.2
To allow the master to control the clients, set the parameters in clients 1 and 2 as follows to specify the IP address range for 4
Ethernet command source selection.
Set the IP address of the master in the engineering software (GX Works3) within the range from 192.168.50.100 to
192.168.50.110.
Ethernet IP address
Pr.1449 Pr.1450 Pr.1451 Pr.1452 5
for command source selection 192 168 50 100
8
Ethernet IP address
192 168 1 100
for command source selection
The range is between The range is between
the values set in both the values set in both
parameters. parameters.
Pr.1453 Pr.1454
9
Command source selection range setting
for the Ethernet IP address ― ― 3 150
In this case, the IP address range for command source selection via Ethernet communication is
"192.168.x (1 to 3).xxx (100 to 150)".
10
• When "9999 (initial value)" is set in Pr.1453 or Pr.1454, the range is invalid.
NOTE
• When four or more clients attempt a connection to the inverter, the connection attempted from outside of the IP address range
set for Ethernet command source selection will be forced to be closed in order from the oldest.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
89
• Communication check is started at the first communication when the inverter operates in the Network operation mode and
the command source is specified as communication via the Ethernet connector.
Example) When Pr.1432 = 0.1 to 999.8 s
Connected device
Inverter
Inverter
Connected device Fault (E.EHR)
Check starts
Pr.1432
Communication
check counter Time
E.EHR OFF ON
LF OFF ON
90 2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
IP filtering function (Ethernet) (Pr.1442 to Pr.1448)
• Set the IP address range for connectable network devices (Pr.1442 to Pr.1448) to limit the connectable devices. The 1
setting range for IP address of connectable network devices depends on the settings in Pr.1443 and Pr.1446, Pr.1444 and
Pr.1447, and Pr.1445 and Pr.1448. (Either of the settings can be larger than the other in Pr.1443 and Pr.1446, Pr.1444
and Pr.1447, and Pr.1445 and Pr.1448.) 2
[Setting example 1] Pr.1442 Pr.1443 Pr.1444 Pr.1445
IP filter address (Ethernet) 192 168 1 100
The range is between The range is between 3
the values set in both the values set in both
parameters. parameters.
4
Pr.1446 Pr.1447 Pr.1448
IP filter address range specification
(Ethernet) ― 9999 3 150
In this case, the IP address range in which Ethernet communication is permitted is "192.168.x (1 to 3).xxx (100 to 150)".
[Setting example 2]
Pr.1442 Pr.1443 Pr.1444 Pr.1445
5
IP filter address (Ethernet) 192 168 2 100
6
The range is between
the values set in both
parameters.
Pr.1446 Pr.1447 Pr.1448
IP filter address range specification
(Ethernet) ― 9999 9999 50 7
In this case, the IP address range in which Ethernet communication is permitted is "192.168.2.xxx (50 to 100)".
Message format
Request
Response
Within 10 ms∗1
*1 The chart shows the performance when the inverter is connected to a master on a 1:1 basis. (It takes 10 ms or more for Parameter clear, All
parameter clear, or accessing multiple registers.)
• Query
A message is sent to the client (inverter) having the address specified by the master.
• Normal Response
After the query from the master is received, the client executes the request function, and returns the corresponding normal
response to the master.
• Error Response
When an invalid function code, address or data is received by the client, the error response is returned to the master.
This response is appended with an error code that indicates the reason why the request from the master could not be
executed.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
91
Message frame (protocol)
• Communication method
Basically, the master sends a query message (inquiry), and clients return a response message (response). At normal
communication, the transaction identifier, protocol identifier, unit identifier, and function code are copied as they are, and
at erroneous communication (illegal function code or data code), bit 7 (= H80) of the function code is turned ON, and the
error code is set at data bytes.
Query message from Master
Transaction Identifier Transaction Identifier
Protocol Identifier Protocol Identifier
Length Field Length Field
Unit Identifier Unit Identifier
Function Code Function Code
Eight-Bit Eight-Bit
Data Bytes Data Bytes
Message frames have the six message fields shown in the figures above.
• Details of protocol
The following table explains the six message fields.
Transaction identifier Protocol identifier Length field Unit identifier Function Data
2 × 8 bits 2 × 8 bits 2 × 8 bits 8 bits 8 bits n × 8 bits
92 2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
Message
Function name Read/write Code Outline format
reference page 1
Data is written to multiple consecutive holding registers.
Data can be written to consecutive multiple MODBUS registers to
output instructions to the inverter or set parameters.
Write Multiple Registers Write H10
System environmental variable (Refer to page 99.)
page 95 2
Inverter parameters (Refer to page 100.)
CiA402 drive profile (Refer to page 101.)
The number of registers that were successfully accessed by the
previous communication is read. 3
Queries by function codes H03, H06, and H10 are supported.
Read holding register The number and start address of holding registers successfully
Read H46 page 96
access log accessed by the previous communication are returned.
"0" is returned for both the number and start address for queries 4
other than function code H03, H06, and H10.
When the connection is closed, the data in the log is cleared.
a Transaction identifier
The master adds the data for the purpose of transaction control. 9
The same data is returned in the response from the client.
Fixed to 0. (When the client receives data other than 0, it does not send the response message.)
b Protocol identifier
"0" is returned in the response from the client.
c Length field The data length from the unit identifier to the data is stored in byte. 10
d Unit identifier 0, 255
e Function code Set H03.
Set the holding register address from which to start reading the data.
f Starting address Starting address = start register address (decimal) - 40001 (Except for the CiA402 drive profile)
For example, when starting address 0001 is set, the data of holding register address 40002 is read.
g Quantity of registers Set the number of holding registers for reading data. Data can be read from up to 125 registers.
• Content of normal response
Message Description
The setting range is H02 to HFA (2 to 250).
h Byte count
Twice the number of reads specified by (g) is set.
The amount of data specified by (g) is set. Read data is output Hi bytes first followed by Lo bytes,
i Register value and is arranged as follows: data of start address, data of start address+1, data of start address+2,
and so forth.
Example) Read the register values of 41004 (Pr.4) to 41006 (Pr.6) from the inverter.
Query message
Transaction Quantity of
Protocol identifier Length field Unit identifier Function code Starting address
identifier registers
*1 *1 H00 H00 H00 H06 HFF H03 H03 HEB H00 H03
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
*1 A given value is set.
Normal response (Response message)
Transaction Protocol Unit Function Byte
Length field Register value
identifier identifier identifier code count
*1 *1 H00 H00 H00 H09 HFF H03 H06 H17 H70 H0B HB8 H03 HE8
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
93
*1 The values are the same as those in the query message.
Read value
Register 41004 (Pr.4): H1770 (60.00 Hz)
Register 41005 (Pr.5): H0BB8 (30.00 Hz)
Register 41006 (Pr.6): H03E8 (10.00 Hz)
Example) Write 60 Hz (H1770) to register 40014 (running frequency RAM) in the inverter.
Query message
Transaction Function
Protocol identifier Length field Unit identifier Register address Register value
identifier code
*1 *1 H00 H00 H00 H06 HFF H06 H00 H0D H17 H70
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
*1 A given value is set.
Normal response (Response message)
The same data as those in the query message
94 2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
• Normal response (Response message)
a. Transaction
identifier
b. Protocol
identifier
c. Length field
d. Unit
identifier
e. Function
code
f. Sub-function g. Data 1
H L H L H L H08 H00 H00 H L
(8 bits)
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
• Query message setting 2
Message Description
The master adds the data for the purpose of transaction control.
a Transaction identifier
The same data is returned in the response from the client. 3
Fixed to 0. (When the client receives data other than 0, it does not send the response message.)
b Protocol identifier
"0" is returned in the response from the client.
c Length field The data length from the unit identifier to the data is stored in byte.
d Unit identifier 0, 255 4
e Function code Set H08.
f Sub-function Set H0000.
g Data Any 2-byte long data can be set. The setting range is H0000 to HFFFF. 5
• Content of normal response
With a normal response, the contents in the response are the same as those in (a) to (g) of the query message.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
95
Example) Write 0.5 s (H05) to register 41007 (Pr.7) and 1 s (H0A) to register 41008 (Pr.8) in the
inverter.
Query message
Transaction Protocol Unit Function Starting Quantity of Byte
Length field Register value
identifier identifier identifier code address registers count
H00 H00 H00 H0B H03 HEE H00 H02 H00 H05 H00 H0A
*1 *1 HFF H10 H04
(8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits)
*1 A given value is set.
Normal response (Response message)
Transaction Protocol Unit Function Starting Quantity of
Length field
identifier identifier identifier code address registers
H00 H00 H00 H06 H03 HEE H00 H02
*1 *1 HFF H10
(8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8
(8 bits) (8 bits)
bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits)
Example) Read the successful register start address and the number of successful accesses
from the inverter.
Query message
Transaction Protocol
Length field Unit identifier Function code
identifier identifier
*1 *1 H00 H00 H00 H02 HFF H46
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
96 2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
Normal response (Response message)
Transaction
identifier
Protocol
identifier
Length field Unit identifier Function code
Starting
address
No. of points 1
*1 *1 H00 H00 H00 H06 HFF H10 H03 HEE H00 H02
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
Example) Read the register values of vl velocity acceleration (index 24648, sub index 0 to 2) 4
Query message
Transaction Protocol Unit Function Starting Quantity of
identifier identifier
Length field
identifier code address registers 5
H00 H00 H00 H06 H60 H48 H00 H04
*1 *1 HFF H03
(8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8
(8 bits) (8 bits)
bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits)
6
*1 A given value is set.
Normal response (Response message)
Transaction
identifier
Protocol
identifier
Length field
Unit
identifier
Function
code
Byte
count
Register value 7
H00 H00 H00 H0A H00 H02 H07 H08 H00 H00 H00 H05
*1 *1 HFF H03 H08
(8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits)
8
*1 The values are the same as those in the query message.
Read value
Sub index 0 (Highest sub-index supported): H0002 (2) 9
Sub index 1 (Delta speed): H07080000 (1800 r/min)
Sub index 2 (Delta time): H0005 (0.5 s)
Example) Write the register values to vl velocity acceleration (index 24648, sub index 0 to 2) 10
Query message
Transaction Protocol Unit Function Starting Quantity of Byte
Length field
identifier identifier identifier code address registers count
H00 H00 H00 H0F H60 H48 H00 H04
*1 *1 HFF H10 H08
(8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits)
Register Value
H00 H02 H07 H08 H00 H00 H00 H05
(8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8 (8
bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits) bits)
Error response
• An error response is returned if the query message received from the master contains an illegal function, address or data.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
97
• Error response (Response message)
a. Transaction b. Protocol d. Unit
c. Length field e. Function code f. Exception code
identifier identifier identifier
H L H L H L H80 + Function
(8 bits) (8 bits)
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
Message Description
The master adds the data for the purpose of transaction control.
a Transaction identifier
The same data is returned in the response from the client.
Fixed to 0. (When the client receives data other than 0, it does not send the response
b Protocol identifier message.)
"0" is returned in the response from the client.
c Length field The data length from the unit identifier to the data is stored in byte.
d Unit identifier 0, 255
e Function code The function code requested by the master and H80 is set.
f Exception code The codes in the following table are set.
• Error code list
Code Error item Error description
01 ILLEGAL FUNCTION The query message from the master has a function code that cannot be handled by the client.
• The query message from the master has a register address that cannot be handled by the
client. (No parameter, parameter cannot be read, parameter cannot be written) (Except for
02 ILLEGAL DATA ADDRESS the CiA402 drive profile)*1
• A nonexistent holding register is accessed using the CiA402 drive profile. More than one
holding register with more than one subindex is accessed.*2*3
The query message from the master has data that cannot be handled by the client.
03 ILLEGAL DATA VALUE
(Out of parameter write range, a mode is specified, or other error)*1
06 CLIENT DEVICE BUSY The request message cannot be processed because the client is executing another operation.
*1 An error response is not returned in the following cases:
In other words, when function code H03 or H10 is used and multiple holding registers are accessed, an error response is not returned even if a
nonexistent holding register or holding register that cannot be read or written from/to is accessed.
An error response is returned if none of the accessed holding registers exist. When an accessed holding register does not exist, the read value
is 0 and the written data is invalid.
(a) Function code H03 (reading data of holding registers)
When the quantity of registers is specified as one or more and there are one or more holding registers from which data can be read.
(b) Function code H10 (writing data to multiple holding registers)
When the quantity of registers is specified as one or more and there are one or more holding registers to which data can be written.
Function code
Example Index Sub index
H03 H10
Access is attempted to index 24644 (H6044) 0
24644 to index 24646 (index Error code H02 Error code H02
24646 (H6046) 0
24645 does not exist).
0
24648 (H6048) 1
Error code H02
Access is attempted to index 2
Error code H02 The written data will be valid as far
24648 and index 24649. 0 as subindex 2 of index 24648.
24649 (H6049) 1
2
24728 (H6098) 0
Error code H02
Access is attempted to index 0
Error code H02 The written data will be valid as far
24728 and index 24729. 24729 (H6099) 1 as subindex 0 of index 24728.
2
0
Error code H02
Access is attempted to index 24729 (H6099) 1
Error code H02 The written data will be valid as far
24729 and index 24730. 2 as subindex 2 of index 24729.
24730 (H609A) 0
98 2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
MODBUS register
• The following shows the MODBUS registers for system environment variables (read/write), monitor codes (read), 1
parameters (read/write), fault history data (read/write), model information monitor items (read), and CiA402 drive profile
data (read/write).
• System environment variables 2
Register Definition Read/write Remarks
40002 Inverter reset Write Any value
40003 Parameter clear Write Set H965A. 3
40004 All parameter clear Write Set H99AA.
40006 Parameter clear*1 Write Set H5A96.
40007 All parameter clear*1
Inverter status / control input command
Write Set HAA99.
4
40008 Read/write Refer to the following.
(extended)*2
40009 Inverter status / control input command*2 Read/write Refer to the following.
40010 Operation mode / inverter setting *3 Read/write Refer to the following. 5
40014 Running frequency (RAM value) Read/write (The display can be changed to the rotations per minute
(machine speed) using Pr.37 and Pr.53. Refer to the FR-
40015 Running frequency (EEPROM value) Write
E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
6
*1 Settings in the communication parameters are not cleared.
*2 The data is written as a control input command for writing.
The data is read as the inverter status for reading.
*3 The data is written as an operation mode setting for writing.
The data is read as the operation mode status for reading.
7
• Inverter status / control input command, and inverter status / control input command (extended)
Definition Definition
Bit
Control input command Inverter status
Bit
Control input command Inverter status
8
0 Stop command RUN (Inverter running)*2 0 NET X1 (—)*1 NET Y1 (0)*2
1 Forward rotation command Forward running 1 NET X2 (—)*1 NET Y2 (0)*2
2 Reverse rotation command Reverse running 2 NET X3 (—)*1 NET Y3 (0)*2
9
RH (High-speed operation
3 Up to frequency 3 NET X4 (—)*1 NET Y4 (0)*2
command)*1
4
RM (Middle-speed operation
Overload warning 4 NET X5 (—)*1 0 10
command)*1
RL (Low-speed operation
5 0 5 — 0
command)*1
FU (Output frequency
6 JOG operation selection 2 6 — 0
detection)*2
7 Second function selection ABC (Fault)*2 7 — 0
8 Terminal 4 input selection ABC2 (0) 8 — 0
9 — Safety monitor output 2 9 — 0
10 *1 0 10 — 0
MRS (Output stop)
11 — 0 11 — 0
12 RES (—)*1 0 12 — 0
13 — 0 13 — 0
14 — 0 14 — 0
15 — Fault occurrence 15 — 0
*1 The signal within parentheses ( ) is the initial status. The description changes depending on the setting of Pr.180 to Pr.189 (Input terminal
function selection).
For details, refer to the description of Pr.180 to Pr.189 (Input terminal function selection) in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
The signals assigned to the input terminals may be valid or invalid in the NET operation mode. (Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual
(Function).)
*2 The signal within parentheses ( ) is the initial status. The description changes depending on the setting of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output terminal
function selection).
For details, refer to the description of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output terminal function selection) in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
• Operation mode / inverter setting
Mode Read value Write value
EXT H0000 H0010*1
PU H0001 H0011*1
2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
99
Mode Read value Write value
EXT
H0002 —
JOG
PU
H0003 —
JOG
NET H0004 H0014
PU + EXT H0005 —
*1 Writing is available depending on the Pr.79 and Pr.340 settings. For details, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
Restrictions in each operation mode conform with the computer link specification.
• Monitor code
For details of the register numbers and the monitor items, refer to the description of Pr.52 in the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).
• Parameter
Pr. Register Name Read/write Remarks
For details on parameter names,
41000 to refer to the parameter list in the FR-
0 to 999 Read/write The parameter number + 41000 is the register number.
41999 E800 Instruction Manual
(Function).
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias
C2 (902) 41902 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias
42092 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C3 (902)
(analog value)
C3 (902)
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias Analog value (%) of the voltage (current) applied to terminal
43902 Read
(terminal analog value) 2
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain
125 (903) 41903 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain
42093 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C4 (903)
(analog value)
C4 (903)
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain Analog value (%) of the voltage (current) applied to terminal
43903 Read
(terminal analog value) 2
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias
C5 (904) 41904 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias
42094 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C6 (904)
(analog value)
C6 (904)
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
43904 Read
(terminal analog value) 4
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain
126 (905) 41905 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain
42095 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C7 (905)
(analog value)
C7 (905)
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
43905 Read
(terminal analog value) 4
Terminal 4 bias command (torque/
C38 (932) 41932 Read/write
magnetic flux)
Terminal 4 bias (torque/magnetic
42122 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C39 (932)
flux)
C39 (932)
Terminal 4 bias (torque/magnetic Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
43932 Read
flux) (terminal analog value) 4
Terminal 4 gain command (torque/
C40 (933) 41933 Read/write
magnetic flux)
Terminal 4 gain (torque/magnetic
42123 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C41 (933)
flux)
C41 (933)
Terminal 4 gain (torque/magnetic Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
43933 Read
flux) (terminal analog value) 4
C42 (934) 41934 PID display bias coefficient Read/write
42124 PID display bias analog value Read/write Analog value (%) set in C43 (934)
C43 (934) PID display bias analog value Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
43934 Read
(terminal analog value) 4
C44 (935) 41935 PID display gain coefficient Read/write
42125 PID display gain analog value Read/write Analog value (%) set in C45 (935)
C45 (935) PID display gain analog value Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
43935 Read
(terminal analog value) 4
1000 to 45000 to
For details on parameter names,
refer to the parameter list in the FR-
1
Read/write The parameter number + 44000 is the register number.
1999 45999 E800 Instruction Manual
(Function).
• Fault history 2
Register Definition Read/write Remarks
40501 Fault record 1 Read/write
40502 Fault record 2 Read 3
40503 Fault record 3 Read
Being 2 bytes in length, the data is stored as H00○○.
40504 Fault record 4 Read Refer to the lowest 1 byte for the error code. (For details on error codes,
40505 Fault record 5 Read refer to the list of fault displays in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual
40506 Fault record 6 Read (Maintenance).) 4
40507 Fault record 7 Read The fault history is batch-cleared by writing to register 40501.
Set any value as data.
40508 Fault record 8 Read
40509
40510
Fault record 9
Fault record 10
Read
Read
5
• Product profile
Register Definition Read/write Remarks 6
44001 Model (1st and 2nd characters) Read
44002 Model (3rd and 4th characters) Read
44003 Model (5th and 6th characters) Read
44004 Model (7th and 8th characters) Read The model name can be read in ASCII code.
7
44005 Model (9th and 10th characters) Read "H20" (blank code) is set for blank area.
44006 Model (11th and 12th characters) Read Example) FR-E820-EPA:
44007 Model (13th and 14th characters) Read H46, H52, H2D, H45, H38, H32, H30, H2D, H45, H50, H41, H20...H20
8
44008 Model (15th and 16th characters) Read
44009 Model (17th and 18th characters) Read
44010 Model (19th and 20th characters) Read
44011 Capacity (1st and 2nd characters) Read The capacity in the inverter model can be read in ASCII code. 9
Data read is displayed in increments of 0.1 kW (rounded down to one
44012 Capacity (3rd and 4th characters) Read
decimal place).
"H20" (blank code) is set for blank area.
44013 Capacity (5th and 6th characters) Read
Example) 0.75K: " 7" (H20, H20, H20, H20, H20, H37) 10
NOTE
• When a 32-bit parameter setting or monitor item is read and the value to be read exceeds HFFFF, HFFFF is returned.
• The display can be changed from the frequency to rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.53. When the machine
speed is displayed, the value is incremented by one.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
101
Register
Sub Name Description Read/write Data type
Index
index
Output frequency (r/min)*1
24643 vl velocity The output frequency is read in r/min.
0 Read Integer16
(H6043) demand Monitoring range: -32768 (H8000) to 32767 (H7FFF)
When Pr.81 = "9999", the number of motor poles is regarded as 4.
Operation speed (r/min)*1
24644 vl velocity actual The operation speed is read in r/min.
0 Read Integer16
(H6044) value Monitoring range: -32768 (H8000) to 32767 (H7FFF)
When Pr.81 = "9999", the number of motor poles is regarded as 4.
vl velocity min
— Minimum/maximum speed (r/min) — —
max amount
Highest sub-
0 Maximum value of subindex: H02 (fixed) Read Unsigned8
index supported
Index
Sub
index
Name Description Read/write Data type
1
Target torque (%)
Set Pr.805 Torque command value (RAM).
24689
(H6071)
0 Target torque Setting range: 600% to 1400%
When the value is set in 0.1 increments, the first decimal place is
Read/write Integer16
2
rounded off.
24692 Torque demand value (%)
0 Torque demand Read Integer16
(H6074)
24695 Torque actual
The torque command is read.
Torque actual value (%)
3
0 Read Integer16
(H6077) value The motor torque is read.
Target position (pulse)
24698
Set the target position in the direct command mode.
Initial value: 0
4
0 Target position Read/write Integer32
(H607A) Setting range: -2147483647 to 2147483647
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
Maximum profile speed (r/min)*1*2
5
24703 Max profile Set Pr.18 High speed maximum frequency in r/min.
0 Setting range: 0 to 590 Hz Read/write Unsigned32
(H607F) velocity
Do not change the settings of this index and index 24646 (H6046), sub
index 2 at the same time. 6
Profile speed (r/min)
Set the maximum speed in the direct command mode.
24705
(H6081)
0 Profile velocity
Initial value: 0
Setting range: 0 to (120 × 590 Hz / Pr.81)
Read/write Unsigned32 7
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
Acceleration time constant (ms)
<Position control> 8
Set the acceleration time in the direct command mode.
Initial value: 5000
Setting range: 10 to 360000
The last digit is rounded off. (For example, 1358 ms becomes 1350 9
ms.)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
24707 Profile
0 Manual (Function).) Read/write Unsigned32
(H6083) acceleration
<Other than position control>
Set Pr.7 Acceleration time in ms.
10
Setting range: 0 to 3600 s
The last two digits are rounded off when Pr.21 Acceleration/
deceleration time increments = "0", and the last digit is rounded off
when Pr.21 = "1".
Do not change the settings of this index and index 24648 (H6048), sub
index 2 at the same time.
Deceleration time constant (ms)
<Position control>
Set the deceleration time in the direct command mode.
Initial value: 5000
Setting range: 10 to 360000
The last digit is rounded off. (For example, 1358 ms becomes 1350
ms.)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
24708 Profile
0 Manual (Function).) Read/write Unsigned32
(H6084) deceleration
<Other than position control>
Set Pr.8 Deceleration time in ms.
Setting range: 0 to 3600 s
The last two digits are rounded off when Pr.21 Acceleration/
deceleration time increments = "0", and the last digit is rounded off
when Pr.21 = "1".
Do not change the settings of this index and index 24649 (H6049), sub
index 2 at the same time.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
103
Register
Sub Name Description Read/write Data type
Index
index
Position encoder
— Encoder resolution (machine side / motor side) — —
resolution
Highest sub-
0 Maximum value of subindex: H02 (fixed) Read Unsigned8
index supported
24719
Encoder resolution
(H608F) Encoder
1 Set Pr.369 Number of encoder pulses. Read/write Unsigned32
increments
Setting range: 2 to 4096
Motor
2 Motor speed (rev): H00000001 (fixed) Read/write Unsigned32
revolutions
— Gear ratio Gear ratio — —
Highest sub-
0 Maximum value of subindex: H02 (fixed) Read Unsigned8
index supported
Motor shaft revolutions*2
Motor Set Pr.420 Command pulse scaling factor numerator (electronic
24721 1 Read/write Unsigned32
revolutions gear numerator).
(H6091)
Setting range: 1 to 32767
Drive shaft revolutions*2
2 Shaft revolutions Set Pr.421 Command pulse multiplication denominator Read/write Unsigned32
(electronic gear denominator).
Setting range: 1 to 32767
Home position return method
24728
0 Homing method Set the home position return method in the direct command mode.*4 Read/write Integer8
(H6098) (For the direct command mode and the home position return method,
refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
— Homing speeds Home position return speed — —
Highest sub-
0 Maximum value of subindex: H01 (fixed) Read Unsigned8
index supported
24729 Motor speed during home position returning (r/min)
(H6099) Set the home position return speed in the direct command mode.
Speed during Initial value: 120 × 2 Hz / Pr.81
1 Read/write Unsigned32
search for switch Setting range: 0 to (120 × 400 Hz / Pr.81)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
Home position return acceleration/deceleration time (ms)
Set the home position return acceleration/deceleration time in the
direct command mode.
Initial value: 5000
24730 Homing
0 Setting range: 10 to 360000 Read/write Unsigned32
(H609A) acceleration
The last digit is rounded off. (For example, 1358 ms becomes 1350
ms.)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
24820 Following error Droop pulse (pulse)
0 Read Integer32
(H60F4) actual value The droop pulse before the electronic gear operation is read.
24826
0 Control effort Speed command after position loop*1 Read Integer32
(H60FA) The ideal speed command is read.
24828 Position demand Position command (pulse)
0 Read Integer32
(H60FC) internal value The position command after the electronic gear operation is read.
Set speed (r/min)*1*3
Set the set frequency in r/min.
Monitoring range: -32768 (H8000) to 32767 (H7FFF)
24831 When Pr.81 = "9999", the number of motor poles is regarded as 4.
0 Target velocity Read/write Integer32
(H60FF) For writing the value after the unit switchover using Pr.53, the lower
24 bits of the data are valid and the upper 8 bits are ignored.
Do not change the settings of this index and index 24642 (H6042) at
the same time.
25858 Supported drive Supported control mode: H00010000 (vendor specific operation
0 Read Unsigned32
(H6502) modes mode)
Device type
Bit 0 to 15 Device Profile Number: H0192
26623 Single device (402: Drive Profile)
0 Read Unsigned32
(H67FF) type Bit 16 to 23 Additional Information (Type): H01 (Frequency Converter:
inverter)
Bit 24 to 31 Additional Information (mode bits): H00
10
2. Ethernet Communication
2.7 MODBUS/TCP
105
2.8 BACnet/IP
2.8.1 Outline
BACnet/IP is available only for the FR-E800-EPA and the FR-E800-SCEPA.
Operation or parameter setting via communication is possible using the BACnet/IP through the Ethernet connector on the
inverter.
Communication specifications
The specifications conform to the BACnet standard of the Ethernet physical medium.
Item Description
Physical medium Ethernet (ISO 8802-3)
Supported property of BACnet standard object type Refer to page 111.
Supported BIBBs (Annex K) Refer to page 119.
BACnet standardized device profile (Annex L) Refer to page 119.
Segmentation Not supported
Device address binding Not supported
Topology Line, star, or a combination of line and star
NOTE
• This product is classified as a BACnet Application Specific Controller (B-ASC).
NOTE 9
• Change the setting if selected communication protocols cannot be used together. (Refer to page 7 and page 223.)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.8 BACnet/IP
107
• The setting range for command source selection depends on the settings in Pr.1451 and Pr.1453, and Pr.1452 and
Pr.1454. (Either of the settings can be larger than the other in Pr.1451 and Pr.1453, and Pr.1452 and Pr.1454.)
[Setting example 1]
Configuration
In this case, the IP address range in which Ethernet communication is permitted is "192.168.50.xxx (100 to 110)".
[Setting example 2]
Pr.1449 Pr.1450 Pr.1451 Pr.1452
Ethernet IP address
192 168 1 100
for command source selection
The range is between The range is between
the values set in both the values set in both
parameters. parameters.
Pr.1453 Pr.1454
Command source selection range setting
for the Ethernet IP address ― ― 3 150
In this case, the IP address range for command source selection via Ethernet communication is
"192.168.x (1 to 3).xxx (100 to 150)".
• When "9999 (initial value)" is set in Pr.1453 or Pr.1454, the range is invalid.
NOTE
• When BACnet/IP is used, do not include IP addresses of other inverters in the Ethernet IP address range set for command
source selection. If an IP address of any other inverter falls within the range, the protective function (E.EHR) will be activated
after the time period set in Pr.1432 after power is supplied to the inverter.
Connected device 2
Inverter
Inverter
Connected device
Check starts Fault (E.EHR) 3
Pr.1432
Communication
check counter Time 4
E.EHR OFF ON
LF OFF ON 5
NOTE
• For the description of other settings, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
2. Ethernet Communication
2.8 BACnet/IP
109
% setting reference frequency (Pr.390)
• Set a reference frequency of the set frequency. The setting value of Pr.390 % setting reference frequency is 100%
reference. The reference to the frequency command is converted to the set frequency in the following formula.
Set frequency = % setting reference frequency × Speed scale (Refer to page 113.)
0.00 Hz
0% 100.00%
NOTE
• The % setting reference frequency cannot be set at less than the minimum frequency resolution of the inverter.
• The set frequency is written to RAM.
• The set frequency is applied at the writing of Speed scale. (The set frequency is not applied at the setting of Pr.390.)
[Setting example 2]
Pr.1442 Pr.1443 Pr.1444 Pr.1445
IP filter address (Ethernet) 192 168 2 100
The range is between
the values set in both
parameters.
Pr.1446 Pr.1447 Pr.1448
IP filter address range specification
(Ethernet) ― 9999 9999 50
In this case, the IP address range in which Ethernet communication is permitted is "192.168.2.xxx (50 to 100)".
2. Ethernet Communication
2.8 BACnet/IP
111
Object support condition
Property Analog Analog Binary Binary Binary Network
Device
Input Value Input Output Value Port
Segmentation Supported R
Status Flags R R R R R R
System Status R
Unit R R
Vendor Identifier R
Vendor Name R
Property List R R R R R R R
Current Command Priority R
*1 This property is commandable for some instances of this object. Otherwise it is read/write.
*2 This property is supported only for instances of this object where the Present Value property is commandable.
Out Of Service
If the Present Value property is not changed or if the change is not applied, TRUE (1) is returned.
FALSE (0) is returned in other cases.
1
REVERSE (1) is returned when the binary output is negative logic. Fixed to NORMAL (0) for the
Polarity
binary input.
Present Value Shows the present value of each object identifier.
Values to be written to the objects supporting the commandable values are stored. Values are
2
Priority Array
initialized at the power-ON or inverter reset.
Shows the protocol level.
Protocol Level
Fixed to BACNET_APPLICATION (2) for the FR-E800. 3
Protocol Object Types Supported The bit is 1 for the supported objects or 0 for the other objects.
Protocol Revision Shows the revision of the compliant BACnet standard.
Protocol Services Supported The bit is 1 for the supported services or 0 for the other services.
Protocol Version Shows the version of the compliant BACnet standard. 4
Shows the reliability of the network port.
Reliability
Fixed to no-fault-detected (0) for the FR-E800.
Relinquish Default Shows the default value to be applied when no data is stored in the Priority Array property.
Shows whether to support segmentation of messages at sending/receiving.
5
Segmentation Supported
Fixed to NO_SEGMENTATION (3) for the FR-E800.
Status Flags Always 0.
System Status Shows the current physical and logical status of the device. 6
Unit Uses engineering units as the measurement unit.
Vendor Identifier Shows 16-bit vendor identification code assigned by ASHRAE.
Vendor Name Mitsubishi Electric Corporation
Property List Shows the property identifier list. 7
Current Command Priority Shows the currently active priority.
• ANALOG VALUE
Present value
Object identifier Object name Description Unit
access type*1
hertz
1 Output frequency*2 R Represents the output frequency value.
(27)
amperes
2 Output current R Represents the output current value.
(3)
volts
3 Output voltage R Represents the output voltage value.
(5)
revolution-
6 Running speed*2 R Represents the running speed value. per-minute
(104)
Converter output volts
8 R Represents the converter output voltage value.
voltage (5)
kilowatts
14 Output power R Represents the output power value.
(48)
percent
17 Load meter R Represents the load meter value.
(98)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.8 BACnet/IP
113
Present value
Object identifier Object name Description Unit
access type*1
Cumulative hours
20 R Represents the cumulative energization time value.
energization time (71)
hours
23 Actual operation time R Represents the actual operation time value.
(71)
kilowatt-
25 Cumulative power R Represents the cumulative power value. hours
(19)
no-units
52 PID set point R Represents the PID set point.
(95)
Represents the PID deviation.
no-units
54 PID deviation R (Minus display is available with reference to 0%, in
(95)
0.1% increment.)
no-units
67 PID measured value2 R Represents the PID measurement 2.
(95)
no-units
200 Alarm history 1 R Represents the latest fault record (fault record 1).
(95)
no-units
201 Alarm history 2 R Represents the second latest fault (fault record 2).
(95)
no-units
202 Alarm history 3 R Represents the third latest fault (fault record 3).
(95)
no-units
203 Alarm history 4 R Represents the fourth latest fault (fault record 4).
(95)
Controls the ratio of the frequency command. (Setting percent
300 Speed scale*3 C
range: 0.00 to 100.00) (Refer to page 110.) (98)
Set the PID action set point.
• This object is the set point during dancer control if
Pr.128 = "40 to 43" and Pr.609 = "4". (Setting range:
0.00 to 100.00)*5
• This object is the set point during PID operation if
Pr.128 = "60 or 61". (Setting range: 0.00 to 100.00)*4
no-units
310 PID set point CMD*3 C • This object is the set point during PID operation if
(95)
Pr.128 = "1000 or 1001" and Pr.609 = "4". (Setting
range: 0.00 to 100.00)*4*5
• This object is the set point during PID operation if
Pr.128 = "2000 or 2001" (not applied to the
frequency) and Pr.609 = "4". (Setting range: 0.00 to
100.00)*4*5
Set the PID measured value.
• This object is the measured value during dancer
control if Pr.128 = "40 to 43" and Pr.610 = "4".
(Setting range: 0.00 to 100.00)
• This object is the measured value during PID
operation if Pr.128 = "60 or 61". (Setting range: 0.00
PID measured value to 100.00)*4 no-units
311 C • This object is the measured value during PID
CMD*3 (95)
operation if Pr.128 = "1000 or 1001" and Pr.610 = "4".
(Setting range: 0.00 to 100.00)*4
• This object is the measured value during PID
operation if Pr.128 = "2000 or 2001" (not applied to
the frequency) and Pr.610 = "4". (Setting range: 0.00
to 100.00)*4
Set the PID deviation. (0.01 increments)
• This object is the deviation during PID operation if
Pr.128 = "50 or 51". (Setting range: -100.00 to
100.00)
• This object is the deviation during PID operation if
percent
312 PID deviation CMD*3 C Pr.128 = "1010 or 1011" and Pr.609 = "4". (Setting
(98)
range: -100.00 to 100.00)
• This object is the deviation during PID operation if
Pr.128 = "2010 or 2011" (not applied to the
frequency) and Pr.609 = "4". (Setting range: -100.00
to 100.00)
• BINARY VALUE
Present value
Object identifier Object name Description
access type*1
0 Inverter running R Represents inverter running (RUN signal) status.
11 Inverter operation ready R Represents inverter operation ready (RY signal) status.
98 Alarm output R Represents alarm output (LF signal) status.
99 Fault output R Represents fault output (ALM signal) status.
200 Inverter running reverse R Represents inverter reverse running status.
Always set to the STF signal regardless of the Pr.178
300*2 Control input instruction DI0 C setting.
Setting "1" in this object turns ON the STF signal.
Always set to the STR signal regardless of the Pr.179
301*2 Control input instruction DI1 C setting.
Setting "1" in this object turns ON the STR signal.
Controls the start/stop command. The start command is
2. Ethernet Communication
2.8 BACnet/IP
115
Present value
Object identifier Object name Description
access type*1
Controls the forward/reverse rotation.*3
401 Forward/Reverse C 1: Reverse rotation
0: Forward rotation
Clears fault output status.
402 Fault reset C (Release of an inverter fault without inverter reset is
available.)
*1 R: Read only, W: Read/Write (Commandable values not supported), C: Read/Write (Commandable values supported)
Values written to the objects that support the commandable values are stored in the Priority Array, even when "Write Access Denied" is returned
due to inconsistency of the writing requirements such as the operating mode, on condition that the values are written within the setting range.
*2 For the FR-E800-SCE inverters, no function is assigned.
*3 If communication operation command source is other than NET, the setting value can be written, but not to be applied.
• DEVICE
Object identifier Object name Description
0 to 4194302 Reads the device status or changes the setting.
Model information # device instance number
4194303*1 Device instance number: Pr.728 × 10000 + Pr.729
• NETWORK PORT
Object identifier Object name Description
Reads the status of the Ethernet connector (PORT1) or changes
0 BACnetIP on ISO8802-3(PORT1)
the setting.
Reads the status of the Ethernet connector (PORT2) or changes
1 BACnetIP on ISO8802-3(PORT2)
the setting.
4194303*1 Access is attempted as the object identifier of the port which receives the request.
*1 Available only for Read Property Service.
*1 Writing is available depending on the Pr.79 and Pr.340 settings. For details, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
Restrictions in each operation mode conform with the computer link specification.
• Monitor code
For details of the register numbers and the monitor items, refer to the description of Pr.52 in the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).
• Parameter
Pr. Register Name Read/write Remarks
41000 to
0 to 999 — Read/write The parameter number + 41000 is the register number.
41999
C2 (902) 41902
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias
(frequency)
Read/write 1
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias
42092 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C3 (902)
(analog value)
C3 (902)
43902
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias
(terminal analog value)
Read
Analog value (%) of the voltage (current) applied to
terminal 2
2
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain
125 (903) 41903 Read/write
(frequency)
42093
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain
(analog value)
Read/write Analog value (%) set in C4 (903) 3
C4 (903)
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain Analog value (%) of the voltage (current) applied to
43903 Read
(terminal analog value) terminal 2
C5 (904) 41904
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias
Read/write 4
(frequency)
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias
42094 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C6 (904)
(analog value)
C6 (904)
43904
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias
Read
Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to 5
(terminal analog value) terminal 4
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain
126 (905) 41905 Read/write
(frequency)
42095
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain
Read/write Analog value (%) set in C7 (905)
6
(analog value)
C7 (905)
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to
43905 Read
(terminal analog value) terminal 4
C38 (932) 41932 Terminal 4 bias command (torque) Read/write 7
42122 Terminal 4 bias (torque) Read/write Analog value (%) set in C39 (932)
C39 (932) Terminal 4 bias (torque) (terminal analog Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to
43932 Read
2. Ethernet Communication
2.8 BACnet/IP
117
• Product profile
Register Definition Read/write Remarks
44001 Model (1st and 2nd characters) Read
44002 Model (3rd and 4th characters) Read
44003 Model (5th and 6th characters) Read
44004 Model (7th and 8th characters) Read The model name can be read in ASCII code.
44005 Model (9th and 10th characters) Read "H20" (blank code) is set for blank area.
Example) FR-E820-EPA:
44006 Model (11th and 12th characters) Read
H46, H52, H2D, H45, H38, H32, H30, H2D, H45, H50, H41,
44007 Model (13th and 14th characters) Read H20...H20
44008 Model (15th and 16th characters) Read
44009 Model (17th and 18th characters) Read
44010 Model (19th and 20th characters) Read
44011 Capacity (1st and 2nd characters) Read The inverter rated capacity can be read in ASCII code.
44012 Capacity (3rd and 4th characters) Read Data read is displayed in increments of 0.1 kW (rounded down to
one decimal place).
44013 Capacity (5th and 6th characters) Read "H20" (blank code) is set for blank area.
Example) 0.75K: " 7" (H20, H20, H20, H20, H20, H37)
NOTE
• When a 32-bit parameter setting or monitor item is read and the value to be read exceeds HFFFF, HFFFF is returned.
2
BACnet Protocol Implementation Conformance Statement
Date: 9th December 2019
Vendor Name: Mitsubishi Electric Corporation
Product Name: Inverter
3
Product Model Number: (FR-E800 series)
Application Software Version: 8650*
Firmware Revision: 1.00
4
BACnet Protocol Revision: 19
Product Description:
5
6
BACnet Standardized Device Profile (Annex L):
BACnet Cross-Domain Advanced Operator Workstation (B-XAWS) 7
BACnet Advanced Operator Workstation (B-AWS)
BACnet Operator Workstation (B-OWS)
BACnet Operator Display (B-OD) 8
BACnet Advanced Life Safety Workstation (B-ALSWS)
BACnet Life Safety Workstation (B-LSWS)
BACnet Life Safety Annunciator Panel (B-LSAP) 9
BACnet Advanced Access Control Workstation (B-AACWS)
BACnet Access Control Workstation (B-ACWS)
BACnet Access Control Security Display (B-ACSD)
10
BACnet Building Controller (B-BC)
BACnet Advanced Application Controller (B-AAC)
BACnet Application Specific Controller (B-ASC)
BACnet Smart Sensor (B-SS)
BACnet Smart Actuator (B-SA)
BACnet Advanced Life Safety Controller (B-ALSC)
BACnet Life Safety Controller (B-LSC)
BACnet Advanced Access Control Controller (B-AACC)
BACnet Access Control Controller (B-ACC)
BACnet Router (B-RTR)
BACnet Gateway (B-GW)
BACnet Broadcast Management Device (B-BBMD)
BACnet Access Control Door Controller (B-ACDC)
BACnet Access Control Credential Reader (B-ACCR)
BACnet General (B-GENERAL)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.8 BACnet/IP
119
Segmentation Capability:
1. Whether objects of this type are dynamically creatable using the CreateObject service
2. Whether objects of this type are dynamically deletable using the DeleteObject service
4. List of all properties that are writable where not otherwise required by this standard
5. List of all properties that are conditionally writable where not otherwise required by this standard
6. List of proprietary properties and for each its property identifier, datatype, and meaning
Networking Options:
Router, Clause 6 - List all routing configurations, e.g., ARCNET-Ethernet, Ethernet-MS/TP, etc.
Annex H, BACnet Tunneling Router over IP
2
If this product is a communication gateway which presents a network of virtual BACnet devices, a separate PICS shall be
provided that describes the functionality of the virtual BACnet devices. That PICS shall describe a superset of the functionality 3
of all types of virtual BACnet devices that can be presented by the gateway.
10
2. Ethernet Communication
2.8 BACnet/IP
121
2.9 MELSOFT / FA product connection
2.9.1 Outline
A computer (FR Configurator2), GOT, or a relay station (programmable controller) can be connected via Ethernet.
System configuration
• Direct connection with a computer (FR Configurator2)
Ethernet cable
Ethernet cable
GOT
Inverter
Ethernet cable
Relay station
(programmable controller) Inverter
2
Ethernet function selection (Pr.1427 to Pr.1430)
To select MELSOFT / FA product connection for the application, set any value from "5000 to 5002" or "5006 to 5008"
(MELSOFT / FA product connection) in any of Pr.1427 to Pr.1430 Ethernet function selection 1 to 4. (For how to set the 3
application value, refer to the Instruction Manual of the device connected via Ethernet.) (Refer to page 223.)
Pr. Name
Initial
Setting range Description
7
value
1426 Link speed and duplex Set the communication speed and the communication mode (full-
0 0 to 4
N641*1 mode selection duplex/half-duplex).
1442
8
*1 IP filter address 1 (Ethernet) 0
N660
1443
N661*1
IP filter address 2 (Ethernet) 0
0 to 255
9
1444
IP filter address 3 (Ethernet) 0
N662*1
1445 Set the range of connectable IP addresses for the network devices.
N663*1
IP filter address 4 (Ethernet) 0 (When Pr.1442 to Pr.1445 = "0 (initial value)", the function is 10
invalid.)
1446 IP filter address 2 range
9999
N664*1 specification (Ethernet)
1447 IP filter address 3 range
9999 0 to 255, 9999
N665*1 specification (Ethernet)
1448 IP filter address 4 range
9999
N666*1 specification (Ethernet)
*1 The setting is applied after an inverter reset or next power-ON.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.9 MELSOFT / FA product connection
123
IP filtering function (Ethernet) (Pr.1442 to Pr.1448)
• Set the IP address range for connectable network devices (Pr.1442 to Pr.1448) to limit the connectable devices. The
setting range for IP address of connectable network devices depends on the settings in Pr.1443 and Pr.1446, Pr.1444 and
Pr.1447, and Pr.1445 and Pr.1448. (Either of the settings can be larger than the other in Pr.1443 and Pr.1446, Pr.1444
and Pr.1447, and Pr.1445 and Pr.1448.)
[Setting example 1] Pr.1442 Pr.1443 Pr.1444 Pr.1445
IP filter address (Ethernet) 192 168 1 100
The range is between The range is between
the values set in both the values set in both
parameters. parameters.
Pr.1446 Pr.1447 Pr.1448
IP filter address range specification
(Ethernet) ― 9999 3 150
In this case, the IP address range in which Ethernet communication is permitted is "192.168.x (1 to 3).xxx (100 to 150)".
[Setting example 2]
Pr.1442 Pr.1443 Pr.1444 Pr.1445
IP filter address (Ethernet) 192 168 2 100
The range is between
the values set in both
parameters.
Pr.1446 Pr.1447 Pr.1448
IP filter address range specification
(Ethernet) ― 9999 9999 50
In this case, the IP address range in which Ethernet communication is permitted is "192.168.2.xxx (50 to 100)".
CAUTION
• The IP filtering function (Ethernet) (Pr.1442 to Pr.1448) is provided as a means to prevent unauthorized access, DoS
attacks, computer viruses, or other cyberattacks from external devices, but the function does not prevent such access
completely. In order to protect the inverter and the system against unauthorized access by external systems, take
additional security measures. We shall have no responsibility or liability for any problems involving inverter trouble and
system trouble by DoS attacks, unauthorized access, computer viruses, and other cyberattacks. The following are
examples of measures to prevent them.
- Install a firewall.
- Install a personal computer as a relay station, and control the relaying of transmission data using an application
program.
- Install an external device as a relay station to control access rights. (For the details of external devices used to control
access rights, contact the distributors of the external devices.)
2.10.1 Outline 2
SLMP is a common protocol for seamless communication between applications. Users do not have to be concerned with
network layers or boundaries. SLMP communications are available among devices that can transfer messages by SLMP 3
(programmable controllers, personal computers, HMIs and others). (For the details of the SLMP compatibility of external
devices, refer to the Instruction Manual of external devices.)
4
2.10.2 Initial setting for SLMP
Use the following parameters to perform required settings for Ethernet communication between the inverter and other devices.
To make communication between other devices and the inverter, perform the initial settings of the inverter parameters to match 5
the communication specifications of the devices. Data communication cannot be made if the initial settings are not made or if
there is any setting error.
SLMP can be used only when the PLC function is enabled. Set Pr.414 PLC function operation selection ≠ "0 (initial value)". 6
(For details of Pr.414, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
Initial
Pr. Name
value
Setting range Setting range
7
1427 Ethernet function selection
5001
N630*1 1 502, 5000 to 5002,
1428
N631*1
Ethernet function selection
2
45237
5006 to 5008, 5010 to
5013, 9999, 34962*3,
8
Set the application, protocol, etc.
1429 Ethernet function selection 44818*2, 45237,
*1 45238
N632 3 45238, 47808*2,
1430 Ethernet function selection
9999
61450 9
N633*1 4
1424 Ethernet communication
1 1 to 239 Enter the network number.
N650*1 network number
1425 Ethernet communication
10
1 1 to 120 Enter the station number.
N651*1 station number
*1 The setting is applied after an inverter reset or next power-ON.
*2 The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPA and the FR-E800-SCEPA.
*3 The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPB and the FR-E800-SCEPB.
NOTE
• The FR-E800-(SC)E only supports binary code. (ASCII code is not supported.)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.10 SLMP
125
Initial
Pr. Name Setting range Setting range
value
1442
IP filter address 1 (Ethernet) 0
N660*1
1443
IP filter address 2 (Ethernet) 0
N661*1
0 to 255
1444
IP filter address 3 (Ethernet) 0
N662*1
1445 Set the range of connectable IP addresses for the network devices.
*1 IP filter address 4 (Ethernet) 0 (When Pr.1442 to Pr.1445 = "0 (initial value)", the function is
N663 invalid.)
1446 IP filter address 2 range
9999
N664*1 specification (Ethernet)
1447 IP filter address 3 range
9999 0 to 255, 9999
N665*1 specification (Ethernet)
1448 IP filter address 4 range
9999
N666*1 specification (Ethernet)
*1 The setting is applied after an inverter reset or next power-ON.
[Setting example 2]
Pr.1442 Pr.1443 Pr.1444 Pr.1445
IP filter address (Ethernet) 192 168 2 100
The range is between
the values set in both
parameters.
Pr.1446 Pr.1447 Pr.1448
IP filter address range specification
(Ethernet) ― 9999 9999 50
In this case, the IP address range in which Ethernet communication is permitted is "192.168.2.xxx (50 to 100)".
CAUTION 1
• The IP filtering function (Ethernet) (Pr.1442 to Pr.1448) is provided as a means to prevent unauthorized access, DoS
attacks, computer viruses, or other cyberattacks from external devices, but the function does not prevent such access
completely. In order to protect the inverter and the system against unauthorized access by external systems, take 2
additional security measures. We shall have no responsibility or liability for any problems involving inverter trouble and
system trouble by DoS attacks, unauthorized access, computer viruses, and other cyberattacks. The following are
examples of measures to prevent them. 3
- Install a firewall.
- Install a personal computer as a relay station, and control the relaying of transmission data using an application
program. 4
- Install an external device as a relay station to control access rights. (For the details of external devices used to control
access rights, contact the distributors of the external devices.)
5
10
2. Ethernet Communication
2.10 SLMP
127
Communication procedure
• Using TCP/IP
The following is the communication procedure when executing SLMP communication with TCP/IP.
With TCP/IP, connections are established when communication is executed, and whether data is received normally or not
is checked to ensure reliability of data. However, the line load is higher as compared to UDP.
Inverter
External device
The external device issues a connection request The inverter accepts the connection request from
to the inverter. (Active open) the external device. (Passive open)
Upon establishment of the connection, the external According to the request message sent from
device sends a request message to the inverter. the external device, the inverter executes
a reading, writing, or other operation.
The external device receives the response message Upon completion of the operation, the inverter sends
from the inverter and confirms the operation result. a response message to the external device.
The external device issues a close request The inverter accepts the close request from
to the inverter and closes the communication. the external device and closes the communication.
2
Inverter
External device
Message format
• Request message format
The following is the format of a request message sent from the external device to the inverter. The request message data
length is 2047 bytes at the maximum.
Header Subheader Destination Destination Destination unit Destination Request data Monitoring timer Request data Footer
network station I/O No. multidrop length
station No.
No. No.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.10 SLMP
129
• Response message format
The following is the format of a response message sent from the inverter to the external device. The response message
data length is 2048 bytes at the maximum.
• Normal completion
Header Subheader Destination Destination Destination unit Destination Response data End code Response data Footer
network station No. I/O No. multidrop length
No. station No.
• Failed completion
End code Network Station Destination unit Destination Command Subcommand Footer
No. No. I/O No. multidrop
station No.
(responding (responding
station) station)
Error information
Command 5
• The following table lists the commands and subcommands. (When the inverter receives a command other than listed in
the following table, it returns an error code (HC059).)
6
Refer
Category Operation Command Subcommand Description
to page
The inverter reads the value in bit devices (with
In bit units H0401 H0001
consecutive device numbers) in 1-bit units. 7
The inverter reads the value in bit devices (with
Read 136
consecutive device numbers) in 16-bit units.
In word units H0401 H0000
The inverter reads the value in word devices (with
consecutive device numbers) in 1-word units. 8
The inverter writes the value to bit devices (with
In bit units H1401 H0001
consecutive device numbers) in 1-bit units.
The inverter writes the value to bit devices (with
Write
consecutive device numbers) in 16-bit units.
137 9
In word units H1401 H0000
The inverter writes the value to word devices (with
consecutive device numbers) in 1-word units.
Device
The inverter reads the value in the devices with the
specified numbers. The devices with non-consecutive 10
Read Random In word units H0403 H0000 137
numbers can be specified. The value is read from the
word devices in 1-word or 2-word units.
The inverter writes the value to the bit devices with the
specified device numbers (each bit has a device
In bit units H1402 H0001
number). The devices with non-consecutive numbers
can be specified.
The inverter writes the value to the bit devices with the
specified device numbers (each set of 16 bits has a
Write Random 138
device number). The devices with non-consecutive
numbers can be specified.
In word units H1402 H0000
The inverter writes the value to the word devices with
the specified device numbers (each word or each set of
two words has a device number). The devices with non-
consecutive numbers can be specified.
Remote Run H1001 H0000 Remote Run is performed to the inverter. 138
Remote Remote Stop H1002 H0000 Remote Stop is performed to the inverter. 139
Control The model name and model code of the inverter are
Read Type name H0101 H0000 139
read.
Device
• The following table lists the device codes and the range available for each command.
Device Category Device code Range*1
Special relay (SM) Bit H91
Refer to the PLC Function Programming Manual.*2
Special register (SD) Word HA9
Input (X) Bit H9C H0 to H7F (hexadecimal)
Output (Y) Bit H9D H0 to H7F (hexadecimal)
Internal relay (M) Bit H90 0 to 127 (decimal)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.10 SLMP
131
Device Category Device code Range*1
Data register (D) Word HA8 0 to 255 (decimal)
Link register (W) Word HB4 8192
Contact (TS) HC1
Bit
Timer (T) Coil (TC) HC0 0 to 15 (decimal)
Current value (TN) Word HC2
Contact (SS) HC7
Bit 0 (Initial value. Up to 16 retentive timers can be used by PLC
Retentive timer (S) Coil (SC) HC6
parameter assignment.)
Current value (SN) Word HC8
Contact (CS) HC4
Bit
Counter (C) Coil (CC) HC3 0 to 15 (decimal)
Current value (CN) Word HC5
*1 If write/read is requested from/to any devices outside the range, the error code H4031 is returned. (Refer to page 139.)
*2 When setting the word unit of the special relay device, specify the device No. in the list of special relay as the first device No. For details of the
special relay, refer to the PLC function programming manual. Otherwise, the data is not read/written correctly.
Link register
The following shows the link registers for parameters (read/write), inverter status monitor items (read), preventive maintenance
data (read), model information monitor items (read), and serial numbers (read).
• Parameter
Pr. Register Name Read/write Remarks
For details on parameter names,
W0 to refer to the parameter list in the FR-
0 to 999 Read/write
W999 E800 Instruction Manual
(Function).
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias
C2 (902) W902 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias
W4802 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C3 (902)
(analog value)
C3 (902)
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias Analog value (%) of the voltage (current) applied to terminal
W4902 Read
(terminal analog value) 2
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain
125 (903) W903 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain
W4803 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C4 (903)
(analog value)
C4 (903)
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain Analog value (%) of the voltage (current) applied to terminal
W4903 Read
(terminal analog value) 2
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias
C5 (904) W904 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias
W4804 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C6 (904)
(analog value)
C6 (904)
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
W4904 Read
(terminal analog value) 4
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain
126 (905) W905 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain
W4805 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C7 (905)
(analog value)
C7 (905)
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
W4905 Read
(terminal analog value) 4
Terminal 4 bias (torque/magnetic
W4832 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C39 (932)
flux)
C39 (932)
Terminal 4 bias (torque/magnetic Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
W4932 Read
flux) (terminal analog value) 4
Terminal 4 gain (torque/magnetic
W4833 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C41 (933)
flux)
C41 (933)
Terminal 4 gain (torque/magnetic Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
W4933 Read
flux) (terminal analog value) 4
W4834 PID display bias analog value Read/write Analog value (%) set in C43 (934)
C43 (934) PID display bias analog value Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
W4934 Read
(terminal analog value) 4
W4835 PID display gain analog value Read/write Analog value (%) set in C45 (935)
C45 (935) PID display gain analog value Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
W4935 Read
(terminal analog value) 4
1000 to W1000 to
For details on parameter names,
refer to the parameter list in the FR-
1
Read/write
1499 W1499 E800 Instruction Manual
(Function).
• Inverter status 2
Read/ Read/
Register Monitor item Register Monitor item
write write
W5001
W5002
Output frequency/speed
Output current
Read
Read
W5033
W5035
Torque current command
Feedback pulse
Read
Read
3
W5003 Output voltage Read W5038 Trace status Read
W5005 Set frequency / motor speed setting Read W5040 PLC function user monitor 1 Read
W5006 Operation speed Read W5041 PLC function user monitor 2 Read 4
W5007 Motor torque Read W5042 PLC function user monitor 3 Read
W5008 Converter output voltage Read W5045 Station number (CC-Link) Read
W5009
W5010
Regenerative brake duty
Electronic thermal O/L relay load factor
Read
Read
W5050
W5051
Energy saving effect
Cumulative energy saving
Read
Read
5
W5011 Output current peak value Read W5052 PID set point Read
W5012 Converter output voltage peak value Read W5053 PID measured value Read
W5013 Input power Read W5054 PID deviation Read 6
Option input terminal status 1 (for
W5014 Output power Read W5058 Read
communication)
Option input terminal status 2 (for
W5015 Input terminal status Read W5059
communication)
Read
7
Option output terminal status (for
W5016 Output terminal status Read W5060 Read
communication)
W5017 Load meter Read W5061 Motor thermal load factor Read
W5018 Motor excitation current Read W5062 Inverter thermal load factor Read 8
W5019 Position pulse Read W5064 PTC thermistor resistance Read
W5020 Cumulative energization time Read W5065 Ideal speed command Read
W5022 Orientation status Read W5067 PID measured value 2 Read 9
W5023 Actual operation time Read W5068 Emergency drive status Read
W5024 Motor load factor Read W5071 Cumulative pulse Read
W5025 Cumulative power Read W5072 Cumulative pulse overflow times Read
W5026 Position command (lower) Read W5077 32-bit cumulative energy (lower 16 bits) Read 10
W5027 Position command (upper) Read W5078 32-bit cumulative energy (upper 16 bits) Read
W5028 Current position (lower) Read W5079 32-bit cumulative energy (lower 16 bits) Read
W5029 Current position (upper) Read W5080 32-bit cumulative energy (upper 16 bits) Read
W5030 Droop pulse (lower) Read W5083 BACnet valid APDU counter Read
W5031 Droop pulse (upper) Read W5091 PID manipulated amount Read
W5032 Torque command Read W5097 Dancer main speed setting Read
• Preventive maintenance data
Register Definition Read/write Remarks
H02: V/F control
H04: Advanced magnetic flux vector control
W6000 Control method Read H08: Real sensorless vector control
H09: Vector control
H18: PM sensorless vector control
2. Ethernet Communication
2.10 SLMP
133
• Model information monitor
Register Definition Read/write Remarks
W8001 Model (1st and 2nd characters) Read
W8002 Model (3rd and 4th characters) Read
W8003 Model (5th and 6th characters) Read
W8004 Model (7th and 8th characters) Read The inverter model can be read in ASCII code.
W8005 Model (9th and 10th characters) Read "H20" (blank code) is set for blank area.
W8006 Model (11th and 12th characters) Read Example) FR-E820-EPA:
W8007 Model (13th and 14th characters) Read H46, H52, H2D, H45, H38, H32, H30, H2D, H45, H50, H41, H20...H20
W8008 Model (15th and 16th characters) Read
W8009 Model (17th and 18th characters) Read
W8010 Model (19th and 20th characters) Read
W8011 Capacity (1st and 2nd characters) Read The capacity in the inverter model can be read in ASCII code.
Data is read in increments of 0.1 kW, and rounds down to 0.01 kW
W8012 Capacity (3rd and 4th characters) Read
increments.
"H20" (blank code) is set for blank area.
W8013 Capacity (5th and 6th characters) Read
Example) 0.75K: " 7" (H20, H20, H20, H20, H20, H37)
• Serial number
Register Definition Read/write Remarks
W8101 Serial number (1st and 2nd characters) Read
W8102 Serial number (3rd and 4th characters) Read
W8103 Serial number (5th and 6th characters) Read
W8104 Serial number (7th and 8th characters) Read
The serial number can be read in ASCII code.
W8105 Serial number (9th and 10th characters) Read
W8106 Serial number (11th and 12th characters) Read
W8107 Serial number (13th and 14th characters) Read
W8108 Serial number (15th and 16th characters) Read
NOTE
• When a 32-bit parameter setting or monitor item is read and the value to be read exceeds HFFFF, HFFFF is returned.
Internal relay M63 has a decimal device No. Convert the decimal value to a hexadecimal value H00003F. The value is sent
in the order 3F, 00, and 00. The device No. of Input X20 is regarded as H000020 and sent in the order 20, 00, and 00.
3
• Specification of the number of devices for bit access
The number of devices is specified for reading/writing data in bit units. The number is used in the Write Random command
(refer to page 138). 4
(Example) Number of devices: 5 / 20
5 devices 20 devices
5
H05 H14
2. Ethernet Communication
2.10 SLMP
135
"02" is shown for the number of devices because the
word device is specified in 16-bit units.
Number
First Device of
device code devices Data Data
H10 H00 H00 H90 H02 H00 H12 HAB HCD H34
1 2 A B C D 3 4
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8 0 OFF
1 ON
0 0 0 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 0
M23 to M16 M31 to M24 M39 to M32 M47 to M40
When word devices are used, one word is specified in 16 bits as follows. The data is stored from the lower byte (bit 0 to
bit 7) to the upper byte (bit 8 to bit 15).
The user should switch the values in the upper and lower bytes in the response data for reading.
The user should switch the write values in the upper and lower bytes to store them in the request data for writing.
(Example) Data stored in D50/D51
Number
First Device of
device code devices Data Data
H32 H00 H00 HA8 H02 H00 HAB H56 H0F H17
Values to be read
5 6 A B 1 7 0 F
or written
Details of commands
• Read
The inverter reads the value in the specified devices.
• Request data
Item Description
Subcommand Specify the unit (bit/word) for reading.
First device No. Specify the number of the first device. (Refer to page 134.)
Device code Specify the type of target devices. (Refer to page 131.)
Number of devices Specify the number of target devices.
Item Description
Subcommand Specify the unit (bit/word) for writing.
First device No.
Device code
Specify the number of the first device. (Refer to page 134.)
Specify the type of the target devices. (Refer to page 131.)
4
Number of devices Specify the number of target devices.
Specify the value to be written to all the devices specified by the Number of
Data to be written
devices in the request data. 5
• Response data
None
• Read Random 6
The inverter reads the value in the devices with the specified numbers. The devices with non-consecutive numbers can be
specified.
• Request data
7
Specify the devices for the specified number of devices.
Number Number
Subcommand of devices of devices
for
Word access Double-word access
9
for word Device No. Device Device No. Device Device No. Device Device No. Device
access double-word code code code code
H03 H04 access
1 1 1 1
10
Item Description
Subcommand Specify the unit (bit/word) for reading.
Number of devices for word Specify the number of devices for one-word access.
access (bit device: 16 bits, word device: one word)
Number of devices for Specify the number of devices for two-word access.
double-word access (bit device: 32 bits, word device: two words)
Specify the devices according to the number set in the request data for word access. It is not necessary to
Word access
specify the devices when "0" is set.
Specify the devices according to the number set in the request data for double word access. It is not necessary
Double-word access
to specify the devices when "0" is set.
Device No. Specify the device number of target devices. (Refer to page 134.)
Device code Specify the type of target devices. (Refer to page 131.)
• Response data
The value read from the device is stored in hexadecimal.
Data in the devices specified Data in the devices specified
for word access for double-word access
2. Ethernet Communication
2.10 SLMP
137
• Write Random
The inverter writes the value in the devices with the specified numbers. The devices with non-consecutive numbers can
be specified.
• Request data
Number
Subcommand of devices Device No.
Device
Set/reset Device No.
Device
Set/reset
for code code
bit access
H02 H14
1 1
Item Description
Subcommand Specify the unit (bit/word) for writing.
Number of devices for bit access
Number of devices for word
access Specify the number of target devices.
Number of devices for double-
word access
Specify the devices according to the number set in the request data for word access. It is not necessary to
Word access
specify the devices when "0" is set.
Specify the devices according to the number set in the request data for double word access. It is not
Double-word access
necessary to specify the devices when "0" is set.
Device No. Specify the device number of target devices. (Refer to page 134.)
Device code Specify the type of the target devices. (Refer to page 131.)
Specify ON/OFF of the bit devices.
Set/reset • ON: H01
• OFF: H00
• Response data
None
• Remote Run
Remote Run is performed to the inverter.
• Request data
Clear
Mode mode
H01 H10 H00 H00 H00
Item Description
Forced execution of the remote RUN is not
H0100
Mode allowed.
Forced execution of the remote RUN is allowed. H0300
Devices are not cleared (initialized). H00
Clear mode
Devices are cleared. H01, H02
• Response data
3
None
• Read Type Name
4
The model name and model code of the inverter are read.
• Request data
5
H01 H01 H00 H00
• Response data
6
Model
Model code
Item Description 7
The inverter model is stored. Up to 16 characters can be stored. If the model name is shorter than 16 characters,
Model a space (H20) is stored instead of a character.
Model code
(Example) FR-E800-E inverter: FR-E800-E
Fixed to H054F
8
Error code
When the end code is other than "0" (failed completion), one of the error codes shown in the following table will be stored. 9
Error code Error description
H4031 The device outside of the range is specified.
H4080 Request data fault 10
The network with the No. set in the routing parameter does not exist.
H4A01
(The destination network No., destination station No., or destination unit I/O No. is different from that of the target inverter.)
HC059 The command or subcommand is specified incorrectly. Or, an unspecified command is received.
HC05B The inverter cannot read/write data from/to the specified device.
HC05C The request message has an error.
The requested operation has an error.
HC060
Example) Data is specified incorrectly for the bit device.
HC061 The request data length is inconsistent with the number of data.
HCEE1 The request message size exceeds the allowable range.
HCEE2 The response message size exceeds the allowable range.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.10 SLMP
139
2.11 EtherNet/IP
2.11.1 Outline
Communication specifications
Item Description
Maximum number of branches No upper limit on the same Ethernet network
Ethernet cable (IEEE 802.3 100BASE-TX/10BASE-T compliant cable and
Connection cable
ANSI/TIA/EIA-568-B (Category 5e) compliant shielded 4-pair branched cable)
Topology Line, star, or a combination of line and star
Communication method Cyclic communication
Number of connections 4
Communication data size For details, refer to description of Assembly Object (page 149).
Connection type (inverter to
Unicast or multicast
master)
Connection type (master to
Class 1 Unicast
inverter)
communication (I/O Connection point (inverter to master): Assembly input instance
Message Exclusive Owner connection
Connection point (master to inverter): Assembly output instance
communication)
Connection point (inverter to master): Assembly input instance
Input Only connection
Connection point (master to inverter): Assembly heartbeat instance (C5h)
Connection point (inverter to master): Assembly input instance
Listen Only connection
Connection point (master to inverter): Assembly heartbeat instance (C6h)
RPI (cycle time) 4 to 100 ms
Supported trigger type Cyclic (repeated)
Communication method Message communication
Class 3 Number of connections 2
communication Connection type (inverter to
(Explicit Message Unicast
master)
communication) Connection type (master to
Unicast
inverter)
Communication method Message communication
UCMM Number of connections 2
communication Connection type (inverter to
Unicast
(Explicit Message master)
communication) Connection type (master to
Unicast
inverter)
Conformity test CT16
EDS file
An EDS file is available for download.
7
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
141
2.11.2 EtherNet/IP configuration
Procedure
The procedure differs depending on the master device and the engineering software used. For details, refer to the Instruction
Manual of the master device and the engineering software.
Before communication
1. Connect each unit with an Ethernet cable. (Refer to page 15.)
2. Set "44818" (EtherNet/IP) in any of Pr.1427 to Pr.1430 Ethernet function selection 1 to 4. (Refer to page 142.)
(Example: Pr.1429 = "45238" (CC-Link IE TSN) (initial value) → "44818" (EtherNet/IP))
When Pr.1429 = "45238 (initial value)" (CC-Link IE TSN), change the value to "44818" (EtherNet/IP). When "45238"
is set in any of Pr.1427 to Pr.1430, the priority is given to CC-Link IE TSN, disabling EtherNet/IP.
Network configuration
1. Add the downloaded EDS file to the engineering software.
Checking communication
The following table shows the status of the LEDs when communication is established between the programmable controller
and the inverter.
NS MS LINK1 LINK2
Solid green Solid green Blinking green*1
*1 The LED on either LINK1 or LINK2 will blink depending on the port (port 1 or 2) the Ethernet cable is connected to.
*1
specification
The setting is applied after an inverter reset or next power-ON.
7
NOTE
• The monitor items and parameter settings can be read during communication with the Pr.1432 Ethernet communication
check time interval = "0 (initial value)" setting, but such operation will become faulty once the operation mode is changed to
8
the NET operation mode. When the NET operation mode is selected as the start-up operation mode, communication is
performed once, then an Ethernet communication fault (E.EHR) occurs.
• To perform operation or parameter writing via communication, set Pr.1432 to "9999" or a value larger than the communication 9
cycle or retry time setting. (Refer to page 144.)
NOTE
• Change the setting if selected communication protocols cannot be used together. (Refer to page 7 and page 223.)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
143
• The setting range for command source selection depends on the settings in Pr.1451 and Pr.1453, and Pr.1452 and
Pr.1454. (Either of the settings can be larger than the other in Pr.1451 and Pr.1453, and Pr.1452 and Pr.1454.)
[Setting example 1]
Configuration
In this case, the IP address range in which Ethernet communication is permitted is "192.168.50.xxx (100 to 110)".
[Setting example 2]
Pr.1449 Pr.1450 Pr.1451 Pr.1452
Ethernet IP address
192 168 1 100
for command source selection
The range is between The range is between
the values set in both the values set in both
parameters. parameters.
Pr.1453 Pr.1454
Command source selection range setting
for the Ethernet IP address ― ― 3 150
In this case, the IP address range for command source selection via Ethernet communication is
"192.168.x (1 to 3).xxx (100 to 150)".
• When "9999 (initial value)" is set in Pr.1453 or Pr.1454, the range is invalid.
Connected device 2
Inverter
Inverter
Connected device
Check starts Fault (E.EHR) 3
Pr.1432
Communication
check counter Time 4
E.EHR OFF ON
LF OFF ON 5
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
145
Initial
Pr. Name Setting range Description
value
12288 to 13787,
16384 to 16483,
20488, 20489, 20981
1330 to to 20990, Set the instance number of Inverter Configuration Object
User Defined Cyclic
1343 20992*2, 24639, (64h) or the index number of CiA402 drive profile. Users can
N850 to Communication Output 1 to 9999
24643, 24644, 24673 assign a function to the configurable input instance.
14 Mapping
N863*1 to 24676, 24692,
24695, 24820,
24826, 24828, 25858
9999 Function disabled
Pr.1389 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the instance/index
User Defined Cyclic
*1 0 to 2, 256 to 258, number is specified using Pr.1320
1389 Communication Input Sub 1 0
512 to 514 Pr.1389 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the instance/index
and 2 Mapping
number is specified using Pr.1321
Pr.1390 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the instance/index
User Defined Cyclic
*1 0 to 2, 256 to 258, number is specified using Pr.1322
1390 Communication Input Sub 3 0
512 to 514 Pr.1390 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the instance/index
and 4 Mapping
number is specified using Pr.1323
Pr.1391 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the instance/index
User Defined Cyclic
*1 0 to 2, 256 to 258, number is specified using Pr.1324
1391 Communication Input Sub 5 0
512 to 514 Pr.1391 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the instance/index
and 6 Mapping
number is specified using Pr.1325
Pr.1392 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the instance/index
User Defined Cyclic
*1 0 to 2, 256 to 258, number is specified using Pr.1326
1392 Communication Input Sub 7 0
512 to 514 Pr.1392 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the instance/index
and 8 Mapping
number is specified using Pr.1327
Pr.1393 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the instance/index
User Defined Cyclic
*1 0 to 2, 256 to 258, number is specified using Pr.1328
1393 Communication Input Sub 9 0
512 to 514 Pr.1393 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the instance/index
and 10 Mapping
number is specified using Pr.1329
[Setting example 2]
Pr.1442 Pr.1443 Pr.1444 Pr.1445
IP filter address (Ethernet) 192 168 2 100
The range is between
the values set in both
parameters.
Pr.1446 Pr.1447 Pr.1448
IP filter address range specification
(Ethernet) ― 9999 9999 50
In this case, the IP address range in which Ethernet communication is permitted is "192.168.2.xxx (50 to 100)".
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
147
• When "9999 (initial value)" is set in Pr.1446 to Pr.1448, the range is invalid.
CAUTION
• The IP filtering function (Ethernet) (Pr.1442 to Pr.1448) is provided as a means to prevent unauthorized access, DoS
attacks, computer viruses, or other cyberattacks from external devices, but the function does not prevent such access
completely. In order to protect the inverter and the system against unauthorized access by external systems, take
additional security measures. We shall have no responsibility or liability for any problems involving inverter trouble and
system trouble by DoS attacks, unauthorized access, computer viruses, and other cyberattacks. The following are
examples of measures to prevent them.
- Install a firewall.
- Install a personal computer as a relay station, and control the relaying of transmission data using an application
program.
- Install an external device as a relay station to control access rights. (For the details of external devices used to control
access rights, contact the distributors of the external devices.)
Service
Class Instance
Get_Attribute_Single
Get_Attribute_Single Set_Attribute_Single
Get_Attributes_All Get_Attributes_All
Reset*1 (inverter reset)
*1 Writing is restricted by the settings of Ethernet IP address for command source selection (Pr.1449 to Pr.1454).
Class attribute
No. Name Access Type Description
1 Revision Get UINT 0001h (Revision of the object)
Instance 1 attributes
No. Name Access Type Description
1 Vendor ID Get UINT 00A1h (Mitsubishi Electric)
2 Device Type Get UINT 0002h (AC Drive)
3 Product Code Get UINT 003Eh (Product code)
Revision Structure Major revision and minor revision
4 Major revision Get USINT 0001h (Major revision number)
Minor revision USINT 0001h (Minor revision number)
5 Status Get WORD Refer to "Status (Attribute 5)" on page 149.
6 Serial Number Get UDINT Serial number of the inverter
SHORT_
7 Product Name Get FR-E800-(SC)E (product name)
STRING
0
Bit
Module Owned
Name
CIP connection established
Description
4
1 — Fixed to 0
2 Configured Fixed to 1 (configured)
3 — Fixed to 0 5
0000b: Unknown
0010b: Faulted I/O Connection (Exclusive Owner connection timed out)
0011b: No I/O connection establish (I/O connection not established)
4 to 7 Extended Device Status
0100b: Non volatile configuration bad 6
0101b: Major fault (Bit 10 = 1)
0110b: Connection in Run mode (I/O connection established, with Run mode
connection)
0111b: Connection in Idle mode (I/O connection established) 7
8 Minor Recoverable Fault Warning or alarm
9 Minor Unrecoverable Fault Fixed to 0
10 Major Recoverable Fault Fault
11 Major Unrecoverable Fault Fixed to 0 8
12 to 15 — Fixed to 0
9
Assembly Object (04h)
The Assembly object uses static assemblies and holds the Process Data sent/received by the inverter. Instance 20 to 23 and
70 to 73 are predefined for specific drive profile parameters. Users can select communication data using Instance 100 and 150.
10
Service
Class Instance
Get_Attribute_Single
Get_Attribute_Single
Set_Attribute_Single
Class attribute
No. Name Access Type Description
1 Revision Get UINT 0002h (Revision of the object)
2 Max Instance Get UINT (Highest instance number)
Instance attribute
No. Name Access Type Description
3*1 Data Set/Get USINT array Inverter I/O data
*1 The number corresponds to the instance number described in the output/input assembly.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
149
• Instance 21 (15h) - Extended Speed Control Output
Byte Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0 0 NetRef NetCtrl 0 0 Fault reset Run rev Run fwd
1 00h
2 Speed reference (Low byte)
3 Speed reference (High byte)
*1 "n" indicates the data length of the instance specified in Pr.1318 (4 or 6 bytes).
Name
Object
Instance No.
Attribute 6
Name No. Name No.
Run rev Control Supervisor 29h 1 Run2 4
Run fwd Control Supervisor 29h 1 Run1 3
Fault reset Control Supervisor 29h 1 FaultRst 12
7
NetCtrl Control Supervisor 29h 1 NetCtrl 5
NetRef AC/DC Drive 2Ah 1 NetRef 4
Speed reference AC/DC Drive 2Ah 1 SpeedRef 8 8
Torque reference AC/DC Drive 2Ah 1 TorqueRef 12
*1 For drive states and behavior, refer to the Control Supervisor Object (29h) or the instance attribute on page 154.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
151
• Instance 73 (49h) - Extended Speed and Torque Control Input
Byte Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
Running 2 Running1
0 At reference Ref from net Ctrl from net Ready Warning Faulted
(Rev) (Fwd)
1*1 Drive state
2 Speed actual (Low byte)
3 Speed actual (High byte)
4 Torque actual (Low byte)
5 Torque actual (High byte)
*1 For drive states and behavior, refer to the Control Supervisor Object (29h) or the instance attribute on page 154.
*1 "n" indicates the data length of the instance specified in Pr.1319 (4 or 6 bytes).
Service
Class Instance
Forward_Open
—
Forward_Close
Service
Class Instance
Get_Attribute_Single
Get_Attribute_Single
Set_Attribute_Single
Class attribute
No. Name Access Type Description
1 Revision Get UINT 0001h (Revision of the object)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
153
Instance attribute
No. Name Access Type Description
3: PM synchronous motor
3*1 MotorType Set/Get*2 USINT
7: Squirrel cage induction motor
Rated motor current (0.1 A increments)
6*3 Rated Current Set/Get UINT Instance 1: Pr.9
Instance 2: Pr.51
Rated motor voltage (V)
7*3 Rated Voltage Set/Get UINT Instance 1: Pr.83
Instance 2: Pr.456
Rated motor frequency (Hz)
9*3 RatedFreq Set/Get UINT Instance 1: Pr.84
Instance 2: Pr.457
Number of motor poles
12*3 PoleCount Set/Get UINT Instance 1: Pr.81
Instance 2: Pr.454
Nominal speed (rpm) at rated frequency from nameplate*4
15*3 Rated Speed Set/Get UINT Instance 1: Pr.84 × 120/Pr.81
Instance 2: Pr.457 × 120/Pr.454
*1 Instances 1 and 2 are supported.
*2 Writing is enabled only when the setting is the same as that of the inverter.
*3 When Pr.77 Parameter write selection ≠ "2", writing is restricted by the settings of Ethernet IP address for command source selection (Pr.1449
to Pr.1454).
*4 When Pr.81 (Pr.454) = "9999", the formula is calculated with 4 poles.
Service
Class Instance
Get_Attribute_Single
Set_Attribute_Single
Get_Attribute_Single
Reset*1 (operation command clear, output shutoff, protective function
reset)
Class attribute
No. Name Access Type Description
1 Revision Get UINT 0001h (Revision of the object)
Instance 1 attributes
No. Name Access Type Description
*1 *2 Set/Get BOOL Forward rotation
3 Run1
4*1 Run2*2 Set/Get BOOL Reverse rotation
Operation command source
0: Pr.338 = "1"
5*1 NetCtrl Set/Get BOOL 1: Pr.338 = "0"
The actual status of the operation command source can be
monitored with Attribute 15.
0: Vendor Specific (Pr.502 = "2": communication fault detection
enabled)
1: Startup (During inverter reset)
2: Not_Ready (Communication ready and RY signal-OFF)
3: Ready (Operation ready)
6 State Get USINT
4: Enabled (During acceleration, constant-speed operation, or
reverse rotation deceleration)
5: Stopping (During deceleration)
6: Fault_Stop (Deceleration by setting Pr.502 = "1")
7: Faulted (Fault)
Class attribute 9
No. Name Access Type Description
1 Revision Get UINT 0001h (Revision of the object)
Instance 1 attributes 10
No. Name Access Type Description
During speed control
0: SU signal OFF
1: SU signal ON
During torque control
0: The actual torque (monitor code: 07h) is out of the range of
3 At Reference Get BOOL
±10% of the torque command value (monitor code: 20h).
1: The actual torque (monitor code: 07h) is within the range of
±10% of the torque command value (monitor code: 20h).
During position control
Fixed to "0"
Speed/torque command source
0: Pr.339 = "1"
4*2 NetRef Set/Get BOOL 1: Pr.339 = "0 or 2"
The actual status of the speed/torque command source can be
monitored with Attribute 29.
0: Vendor specific mode
1: Speed control without encoder
6 DriveMode Set/Get*1 USINT 2: Speed control with encoder
3: Torque control
5: Position control
Actual drive speed
7*3*4 Speed Actual Get INT
Unit: rpm / 2SpeedScale
Speed setting value
8*2*4*5 SpeedRef Set/Get INT
Unit: rpm / 2SpeedScale
Motor phase current
9 Current Actual Get INT
Unit: 100 mA / 2CurrentScale
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
155
No. Name Access Type Description
Actual torque
11*3 Torque Actual Get INT
Unit: N·m / 2TorqueScale
Torque command value (Pr.805)
12*2 TorqueRef Set/Get INT
Unit: N·m / 2TorqueScale
Output power
15 Power Actual Get INT
Unit: W
Output voltage
17 Output Voltage Get INT
Unit: V
Acceleration time = Pr.7 (Pr.44) × Pr.18/Pr.20
18*2 AccelTime Set/Get UINT Time from 0 to HighSpdLimit
Unit: ms
Deceleration time = Pr.8 (Pr.45) × Pr.18/Pr.20
19*2 DecelTime Set/Get UINT Time from HighSpdLimit to 0
Unit: ms
Minimum speed limit (Pr.2)
20*2*4 LowSpd Limit Set/Get UINT
Unit: rpm / 2SpeedScale
Maximum speed limit (Pr.18)
21*2*4 HighSpd Limit Set/Get UINT
Unit: rpm / 2SpeedScale
Speed scaling factor
22*2*6 SpeedScale Set/Get SINT
Applied to attributes 7, 8, 20, and 21.
Current scaling factor
23*2*6 Current Scale Set/Get SINT
Applied to attribute 9.
Torque scaling factor
24*2*6 Torque Scale Set/Get SINT
Applied to attributes 11 and 12.
Speed/torque command source monitoring
29 RefFromNet Get BOOL 0: Local reference
1: Network reference
*1 Writing is enabled only when the setting is the same as that of the inverter.
*2 Writing is restricted by the settings of Ethernet IP address for command source selection (Pr.1449 to Pr.1454). However, the restriction is not
applied to attributes 18, 19, 20, and 21 when Pr.77 Parameter write selection = "2".
*3 Use Pr.290 to enable display of negative numbers during monitoring. For details, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
*4 Use the speed scale of Inverter Configuration Object (64h) to set a scaling factor. (Refer to page 158.)
*5 When Pr.541 Frequency command sign selection = "1", the set frequency is a signed value. When the setting value is negative, the command
is the inverse from the start command. (Refer to page 146.)
*6 At power-ON or inverter reset, executing the reset service of the Identity Object (01h) resets the value to "0" (initial value).
NOTE
• When the data in attributes of AC/DC Drive Object (2Ah) is larger than the size of data type, the data is limited to the size of
data size.
Service
Class Instance
Get_Attribute_Single
—
Set_Attribute_Single
Instance
No. Name Access Type Remarks
12288 to 16383 The inverter parameter number*2 + 12288 (3000h)
(3000h to 3FFFh) Inverter Parameters*1 Set/Get UINT
is the instance number.
16384 to 20479 The monitor code*3 + 16384 (4000h) is the index
(4000h to 4FFFh) Monitor Data*4*5 Get UINT
number.
20480 to 24575
Inverter Control Parameters Set/Get UINT Inverter control parameter
(5000h to 5FFFh)
*1 When parameter write is performed, data are written to RAM for I/O message communication. Writing to EEPROM or RAM is selected according
to the setting in Pr.342 Communication EEPROM write selection for explicit message communication.
*2 For the numbers and names of inverter parameters, refer to the parameter list of the Instruction Manual (Function).
*3 For details of the monitor codes and monitor items, refer to the description of Pr.52 in the Instruction Manual (Function).
20488 (5008h)
Inverter status / control input command
(extended)*3
Set/Get Refer to page 158. 5
20489 (5009h) Inverter status / control input command*3 Set/Get Refer to page 158.
20981 (51F5h) Fault record 1 Set/Get
20982 (51F6h) Fault record 2 Get 6
20983 (51F7h) Fault record 3 Get Being 2 bytes in length, the data is stored as "00○○h".
20984 (51F8h) Fault record 4 Get Refer to the lowest 1 byte for the error code. (For
details on error codes, refer to the list of fault displays
20985 (51F9h)
20986 (51FAh)
Fault record 5
Fault record 6
Get
Get
in the Instruction Manual (Maintenance).) 7
The fault history is batch-cleared by writing to 20981
20987 (51FBh) Fault record 7 Get (51F5h).
20988 (51FCh) Fault record 8 Get Set any value as data.
20989 (51FDh) Fault record 9 Get 8
20990 (51FEh) Fault record 10 Get
20992 (5200h)*4 Safety input status Get Refer to page 158.
21216 (52E0h) *1 Speed scale (numerator) Set/Get Refer to page 158. 9
*1 Speed scale (denominator) Set/Get Refer to page 158.
21217 (52E1h)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
157
• Inverter status / control input command, and inverter status / control input command (extended)
Inverter status / control input command Inverter status / control input command (extended)
Definition Definition
Bit Bit
Control input command Inverter status Control input command Inverter status
0 — RUN (Inverter running)*2 0 NET X1 (—)*1 NET Y1 (0)*2
1 — During forward rotation 1 NET X2 (—)*1 NET Y2 (0)*2
2 — During reverse rotation 2 NET X3 (—)*1 NET Y3 (0)*2
RH (High-speed operation
3 Up to frequency 3 NET X4 (—)*1 NET Y4 (0)*2
command)*1
RM (Middle-speed operation
4 Overload alarm 4 NET X5 (—)*1 0
command)*1
RL (Low-speed operation
5 0 5 — 0
command)*1
FU (Output frequency
6 JOG operation selection 2 6 — 0
detection)*2
7 Second function selection ABC (Fault)*2 7 — 0
8 Terminal 4 input selection ABC2 (0) 8 — 0
9 — Safety monitor output 2 9 — 0
10 MRS (Output stop)*1 0 10 — 0
11 — 0 11 — 0
12 RES (—)*1 0 12 — 0
13 — 0 13 — 0
14 — 0 14 — 0
15 — Fault occurrence 15 — 0
*1 The signal within parentheses ( ) is assigned in the initial status. The function changes depending on the setting of Pr.180 to Pr.189 (Input
terminal function selection).
For details, refer to the description of Pr.180 to Pr.189 (Input terminal function selection) in the Instruction Manual (Function).
The signals assigned to the input terminals may be valid or invalid in the NET operation mode. (Refer to the Instruction Manual (Function).)
*2 The signal within parentheses ( ) is assigned in the initial status. The function changes depending on the setting of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output
terminal function selection).
For details, refer to the description of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output terminal function selection) in the Instruction Manual (Function).
• Speed scale
A scaling factor can be set for attributes 7, 8, 20, and 21 of AC/DC Drive Object (2Ah). (Refer to page 155.)
Instance No. Name Access Initial value Setting range
21216 (52E0h)*1 Speed scale (numerator) Set/Get 1 1 to 65535
21217 (52E1h)*1 Speed scale (denominator) Set/Get 1 1 to 65535
*1 The setting value is applied immediately. At power-ON or inverter reset, executing the reset service of the Identity Object (01h) resets the value
to the initial value.
Relationship between the set speeds of the master and the inverter
Set speed (inverter) = Set speed to be scaled (master) × (Speed scale (numerator) / Speed scale (denominator))
Instance attribute
No. Name Access Type Description
Inverter parameters, monitor data, and inverter control
100*1 Data Set/Get UINT
parameters.
• Calibration parameter 3
Instance No. Attribute Name Description
100 Data C0 (Pr.900)
13188 (3384h)
101 Sub Data — 4
100 Data C1 (Pr.901)
13189 (3385h)
101 Sub Data —
100 Data C2 (Pr.902)
13190 (3386h)
101 Sub Data C3 (Pr.902) 5
100 Data 125 (Pr.903)
13191 (3387h)
101 Sub Data C4 (Pr.903)
13192 (3388h)
100 Data C5 (Pr.904) 6
101 Sub Data C6 (Pr.904)
100 Data 126 (Pr.905)
13193 (3389h)
101 Sub Data C7 (Pr.905)
100 Data C38 (Pr.932) 7
13220 (33A4h)
101 Sub Data C39 (Pr.932)
100 Data C40 (Pr.933)
13221 (33A5h)
101
100
Sub Data
Data
C41 (Pr.933)
C42 (Pr.934)
8
13222 (33A6h)
101 Sub Data C43 (Pr.934)
100 Data C44 (Pr.935)
13223 (33A7h)
101 Sub Data C45 (Pr.935) 9
NOTE
• Set 65520 (FFF0h) as a parameter value "8888" and 65535 (FFFFh) as "9999". 10
• To specify subindices in Pr.1389 to Pr.1398, set "0" in attribute 100 and set "1" in attribute 101.
Service
Class Instance
Get_Attribute_All
Get_Attribute_Single Get_Attribute_Single
Set_Attribute_Single
Class attribute
No. Name Access Type Description
1 Revision Get UINT 0004h (Revision of the object)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
159
Instance 1 attributes
No. Name Access Type Description
1 Status Get DWORD Refer to "Status (Attribute 1)" on page 160.
80 (0050h):
2 Configuration Capability Get DWORD
Refer to "Configuration Capability (Attribute 2)" on page 160.
3 Configuration Control Set/Get DWORD Refer to "Configuration Control (Attribute 3)" on page 160.
Physical Link Object Structure Path size and Path
Path size UINT 0002h
4 Get
Padded Path to Ethernet Link Object
Path 20 F6 24 03h
EPATH
Interface Configuration Structure TCP/IP interface setting
IP Address UDINT IP address (Pr.1434 to Pr.1437)
Network Mask UDINT Subnet mask (Pr.1438 to Pr.1441)
5 Gateway Address Set/Get UDINT Default gateway (Pr.442 to Pr.445)
Name Server UDINT Fixed to 0
Name Server 2 UDINT Fixed to 0
Domain Name STRING Fixed to 0
6 Host Name Set/Get STRING Host name
0: Inactive
Encapsulation Inactivity 1 to 3600 s: TCP connection timeout after the message is
13 Set/Get UINT
Timeout received
(Initial value: 120 s)
• Status (Attribute 1)
Bit Name Description
How to configure Attribute 5
0: Not configured
0 to 3 Interface Configuration Status
1: Configured by setting parameters, BOOTP, DHCP
2: Configured by hardware setting
4 — Fixed to 0
Attribute 5, setting change during pending.
5 Interface Configuration Pending
"1" is set when inverter reset is required to enable the setting change.
6 to 31 — Fixed to 0
• Configuration Capability (Attribute 2)
Bit Name Description
0: Not supported
0 BOOTP Client
1: Supported
0: Not supported
1 DNS Client
1: Supported
0: Not supported
2 DHCP Client
1: Supported
3 DHCP-DNS Update Fixed to 0
Attribute 5, access condition
4 Configuration Settable 0: Setting not allowed
1: Setting allowed
Attribute 5, hardware configuration condition
5 Hardware Configurable 0: Setting not allowed
1: Setting allowed
Attribute 5, change application condition
Interface Configuration Change
6 0: Immediately
Requires Reset
1: After reset
0: Not supported
7 AcdCapable
1: Supported
8 to 31 — Fixed to 0
• Configuration Control (Attribute 3)
Bit Name Description
Network setting acquisition method after startup of the inverter
0: Parameter setting
0 to 3 Configuration Method
1: BOOTP
2: DHCP
4 to 31 — Fixed to 0
Class attribute 3
No. Name Access Type Description
1 Revision Get UINT 0004h (Revision of the object)
2 Max Instance Get UINT (Highest instance number) 4
3 Number of instances Get UINT (Number of instances)
Instance attribute
No. Name Access Type Description
5
10 or 100:
1*1 Interface Speed Get UDINT
Actual Ethernet interface speed (Mbps)
2*1 Interface Flags Get DWORD Refer to "Interface Flags (Attribute 2)" on page 161. 6
*1 Array of 6
3 Physical Address Get (MAC ID): Assigned MAC address
USINT
Interface Control Structure Control Bits and Forced Interface Speed
Control Bits WORD Refer to "Control Bits (Attribute 6)" on page 162. 7
6*1*2 Set/Get 0, 10, or 100:
Forced Interface Speed UINT Speed at which the interface shall be forced to operate.
Returns 'Object state Conflict' if auto-negotiation is enabled.
Instance 1, 2: 2 (Twisted pair cable)
8
7 Interface Type Get USINT
Instance 3: 1 (Embedded interface)
Instance 1: Port 1
SHORT_
10 Interface Label Get
STRING
Instance 2: Port 2
Instance 3: Internal
9
Interface Capability Structure Capability Bits and Speed/Duplex Options
11 (000Bh):
Capability Bits DWORD
Structure
Refer to "Capability Bits (Attribute 11)" on page 162.
—
10
USINT 4: Number of arrays
11*1 Get Structure
—
array
Speed/Duplex Options
10 or 100:
UINT
Ethernet interface speed (Mbps)
0: Half duplex
USINT
1: Full duplex
*1 Instances 1, 2, and 3 are supported.
*2 When Pr.77 Parameter write selection ≠ "2", writing is restricted by the settings of Ethernet IP address for command source selection (Pr.1449
to Pr.1454).
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
161
• Control Bits (Attribute 6)
Bit Name Description
0: Inactive
0 Auto-negotiate
1: Active
Duplex mode when Auto-negotiate (Bit 0) = 0
1 Forced Duplex Mode 0: Half duplex
1: Full duplex
2 to 15 — Fixed to 0
• Capability Bits (Attribute 11)
Bit Name Description
Attribute 6, change application condition
0 Manual Setting Requires Reset 0: Immediately (Instance 3)
1: After reset (Instance 1, 2)
0: Not supported (Instance 3)
1 Auto-negotiate
1: Not supported (Instance 1, 2)
2 Auto-MDIX Fixed to 0 (not supported)
3 Manual Speed/Duplex Fixed to 1 (supported)
4 to 31 — Fixed to 0
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
163
Sub
Index Name Description Access Type
index
Deceleration time constant (ms)
<Position control>
Set the deceleration time in the direct command mode.
Initial value: 5000
Setting range: 10 to 360000
The last digit is rounded off. (For example, 1358 ms becomes 1350
ms.)
24708
00h Profile deceleration (For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Set/Get Unsigned32
(6084h)
Manual (Function).)
<Other than position control>
Set Pr.8 Deceleration time in ms.
Setting range: 0 to 3600 s
The last two digits are rounded off when Pr.21 Acceleration/
deceleration time increments = "0", and the last digit is rounded
off when Pr.21 = "1".
Position encoder
— Encoder resolution (machine side / motor side) — —
resolution
Highest sub-index
00h Maximum value of subindex: 02h (fixed) Get Unsigned8
24719 supported
(608Fh) Encoder resolution
Encoder
01h Set Pr.369 Number of encoder pulses. Set/Get Unsigned32
increments
Setting range: 2 to 4096
02h Motor revolutions Motor speed (rev): 00000001h (fixed) Set/Get Unsigned32
— Gear ratio Gear ratio — —
Highest sub-index
00h Maximum value of subindex: 02h (fixed) Get Unsigned8
supported
Motor shaft revolutions*2
01h Motor revolutions Set Pr.420 Command pulse scaling factor numerator Set/Get Unsigned32
24721
(6091h) (electronic gear numerator).
Setting range: 1 to 32767
Drive shaft revolutions*2
02h Shaft revolutions Set Pr.421 Command pulse multiplication denominator Set/Get Unsigned32
(electronic gear denominator).
Setting range: 1 to 32767
Home position return method
Set the home position return method in the direct command
24728
(6098h)
00h Homing method mode.*3 Set/Get Integer8
(For the direct command mode and the home position return
method, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
— Homing speeds Home position return speed — —
Highest sub-index
00h Maximum value of subindex: 01h (fixed) Get Unsigned8
supported
24729 Motor speed during home position returning (r/min)
(6099h) Set the home position return speed in the direct command mode.
Speed during Initial value: 120 × 2 Hz / Pr.81
01h Set/Get Unsigned32
search for switch Setting range: 0 to (120 × 400 Hz / Pr.81)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
Home position return acceleration/deceleration time (ms)
Set the home position return acceleration/deceleration time in the
direct command mode.
Initial value: 5000
24730 Homing
00h Setting range: 10 to 360000 Set/Get Unsigned32
(609Ah) acceleration
The last digit is rounded off. (For example, 1358 ms becomes 1350
ms.)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
24820 Following error Droop pulse (pulse)
00h Get Integer32
(60F4h) actual value The droop pulse before the electronic gear operation is read.
24826
00h Control effort Speed command after position loop*1 Get Integer32
(60FAh) The ideal speed command is read.
24828 Position demand Position command (pulse)
00h Get Integer32
(60FCh) internal value The position command after the electronic gear operation is read.
25858 Supported drive Supported control mode: 00010000h (vendor specific operation
00h Get Unsigned32
(6502h) modes mode)
10
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
165
Data format
Explicit Message communication (request format)
Byte No. Field Remarks
0 Service Service code
1 Request Path Size Data size of Request Path
Common Industrial Protocol
2 to n Request Path Application path
n+1 to m Data Service specific data
Error number
The error information for request command is stored in General Status of the response format for the Explicit Message
communication.
Error No. Name Description
00h Success The service was successfully executed by the specified object.
The path is unknown or references an object class, instance, or
05h Path destination unknown
structure element not included in the processing node.
09h Invalid attribute value Invalid attribute data was detected.
The requested service cannot be executed in the current mode/state of
10h Device state conflict
the device.
20h Invalid parameter A parameter assigned to the request was invalid.
Programming examples
The following explains the programming examples for controlling the inverter with sequence programs.
Check that "44818" (EtherNet/IP) is set in any of Pr.1427 to Pr.1430 (Ethernet function selection).
K1500
Setting example
• The following tables show example settings when user defined cyclic communication data are selected (Assembly Object
(04h)). Data are written to the inverter when I/O communications are in run state and the data are updated by the master.
(The response time to write the data is 100 ms at the most.)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.11 EtherNet/IP
167
• Instance 100 (64h): Configurable Output
Byte Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0 0 NetRef NetCtrl 0 0 Fault reset Run rev Run fwd
1 00h
2 Speed reference (Low byte)
3 Speed reference (High byte)
4 User Defined Cyclic Communication Input 1 (lower bytes) (Pr.1320)
5 User Defined Cyclic Communication Input 1 (upper bytes) (Pr.1320)
6 User Defined Cyclic Communication Input 2 (lower bytes) (Pr.1321)
7 User Defined Cyclic Communication Input 2 (upper bytes) (Pr.1321)
• Parameters
Pr. Name Setting example Remarks
User Defined Cyclic
1318 Communication Input fixing format 21 (15h) Extended Speed Control Output
selection
User Defined Cyclic P.7 Acceleration time
1320 12295 (3007h)
Communication Input 1 Mapping 7 (0007h) + 12288 (3000h)
User Defined Cyclic Pr.8 Deceleration time
1321 12296 (3008h)
Communication Input 2 Mapping 8 (0008h) + 12288 (3000h)
User Defined Cyclic
1319 Communication Output fixing 71 (47h) Extended Speed Control Input
format selection
User Defined Cyclic P.7 Acceleration time
1330 12295 (3007h)
Communication Output 1 Mapping 7 (0007h) + 12288 (3000h)
User Defined Cyclic Pr.8 Deceleration time
1331 12296 (3008h)
Communication Output 2 Mapping 8 (0008h) + 12288 (3000h)
User Defined Cyclic Monitored output current
1332 16386 (4002h)
Communication Output 3 Mapping 2 (0002h) + 16384 (4000h)
User Defined Cyclic Pr.255 Life alarm status display
1333 12543 (30FFh)
Communication Output 4 Mapping 255 (00FFh) + 12288 (3000h)
User Defined Cyclic
1334 20981 (51F5h) Fault record 1
Communication Output 5 Mapping
• Connection settings in the engineering software
Set "Configurable" for the "Connections" setting of the FR-E800-E. Change the setting according to the data length set in
instance 100/150. (When the settings are inconsistent, communication is not established.)
Change the "Input Size" setting to "14bytes".
Change the "Output Size" setting to "8bytes".
Names of setting items may differ depending of the engineering software used.
2.12.1 Outline 2
4
PROFINET is available only for the FR-E800-EPB and the FR-E800-SCEPB.
When the PROFINET communication operation is performed through the Ethernet connector on the inverter, data transmission 5
is enabled for parameters, command data, and feedback data between a master and inverters.
Some functions are not supported depending on the date of manufacture of the inverter. For details of specification changes,
refer to page 284. 6
Communication specifications
The communication specification varies depending on the specification of the master.
7
Item Description
Category 100BASE-TX
Communication speed 100 Mbps (10 Mbps is not supported.)
Maximum number of
No upper limit on the same Ethernet network
8
branches
Number of cascade
Maximum: 2
connection stages
Ethernet cable (IEEE 802.3 100BASE-TX compliant cable and ANSI/TIA/EIA-568-B (Category 9
Connection cable
5e) compliant shielded 4-pair branched cable)
Topology Line, star, or a combination of line and star
PROFINET
communication PROFINET IO Device V2.35
10
specifications
Wiring method
• When only one connector is used in star topology, use PORT 1.
• When two connectors are used in line topology, use PORT1 for connection with the master, and use PORT2 for connection
with PORT1 of the adjacent inverter.
Connection between
PORT2 and PORT1
To the next
connector for
communication
To the master station (PORT1)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.12 PROFINET
169
Operation status LEDs
LED name Description LED status Remarks
OFF Power-OFF / during inverter reset
No connections established with the master /
Blinking green Connections established with the master (The master is in
NS Communication status
the stop state.)
Connections established with the master (The master is in
Solid green
the run state.)
OFF Power-OFF / during inverter reset
MS Inverter status ON (green) Operating properly
Red Fault detected
OFF Power-OFF/link-down
Connector for communication (PORT1)
LINK1 Blinking green Link-up (Data reception in progress)
status
Solid green Link-up
OFF Power-OFF/link-down
Connector for communication (PORT2)
LINK2 Blinking green Link-up (Data reception in progress)
status
Solid green Link-up
NOTE
• Depending on packets sent to the inverter while the master is in the stop state, the NS LED may not turn blinking green. The
run/stop state is determined by IOCS of the packet sent from the master to the inverter (Good (80h): run, Bad (60h): stop).
When the following master is used, the above-mentioned operation is performed in the stop state.
GSDML file
A GSDML file is available for download.
Model Classification GSDML file
FR-E800-E
PROFINET GSDML-V2.35-MitsubishiElectric-FR-E800-E-[yyyymmdd].xml
FR-E800-SCE
FR-E800-SCE PROFINET + PROFIsafe GSDML-V2.35-MitsubishiElectric-FR-E800-SCE-[yyyymmdd].xml
([yyyymmdd]: revision date)
NOTE
• The GSDML file is used in engineering software. To install the GSDML file properly, refer to the instruction manual of the
applicable engineering software.
Before communication
1. Connect each unit with an Ethernet cable. (Refer to page 15.)
3
2. Set "34962" (PROFINET) in any of Pr.1427 to Pr.1430 Ethernet function selection 1 to 4. (Refer to page 171.)
(Example: Pr.1429 = "45238" (CC-Link IE TSN) (initial value) → "34962" (PROFINET)) 4
When Pr.1429 = "45238 (initial value)" (CC-Link IE TSN), change the value to "34962" (PROFINET). When "45238"
is set in any of Pr.1427 to Pr.1430, the priority is given to CC-Link IE TSN, disabling PROFINET.
Checking communication 8
The following table shows the status of the LEDs when communication is established between the programmable controller
and the inverter.
NS MS LINK1 LINK2
9
Solid green Solid green Blinking green*1
*1 The LED on either LINK1 or LINK2 will blink depending on the port (port 1 or 2) the Ethernet cable is connected to. 10
2.12.3 Initial setting for PROFINET
Use the following parameters to perform required settings for Ethernet communication between the inverter and other devices.
To make communication between other devices and the inverter, perform the initial settings of the inverter parameters to match
the communication specifications of the devices. Data communication cannot be made if the initial settings are not made or if
there is any setting error.
Initial
Pr. Name Setting range Description
value
1427 Ethernet function selection
5001
N630*1 1
1426 Link speed and duplex Set the communication speed and the communication mode
0 0 to 4
N641*1 mode selection (full-duplex/half-duplex).
NOTE
• For PROFINET, the IP filtering function (Ethernet) (Pr.1442 to Pr.1448) settings are invalid.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.12 PROFINET
171
Precautions for PROFINET communication
• For PROFINET, do not change initial values of Pr.1449 to Pr.1454 used to specify the Ethernet IP address range for
command source selection as the IP address is not used. Setting a value other than the initial value in any of the above
parameters may cause an Ethernet communication fault (E.EHR). If the fault occurs, reset the setting of the relevant
parameter to the initial value, or set "9999" in Pr.1432 Ethernet communication check time interval.
• When the device settings (IP address, subnet mask, and default gateway address settings) are inconsistent between the
engineering tool and the connected inverter, "0" is set in Pr.442 to Pr.445, Pr.1434 to Pr.1441 (EEPROM).
NOTE
• Change the setting if selected communication protocols cannot be used together. (Refer to page 7 and page 223.)
1394*1
User Defined Cyclic
Communication Output Sub 0
0 to 2, 256 to 258, is specified using Pr.1330 6
512 to 514 Pr.1394 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the signal number
1 and 2 Mapping
is specified using Pr.1331
Pr.1395 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the signal number
1395*1
User Defined Cyclic
Communication Output Sub 0
0 to 2, 256 to 258, is specified using Pr.1332 7
512 to 514 Pr.1395 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the signal number
3 and 4 Mapping
is specified using Pr.1333
Pr.1396 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the signal number
1396*1
User Defined Cyclic
Communication Output Sub 0
0 to 2, 256 to 258, is specified using Pr.1334 8
512 to 514 Pr.1396 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the signal number
5 and 6 Mapping
is specified using Pr.1335
Pr.1397 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the signal number
1397*1
User Defined Cyclic
Communication Output Sub 0
0 to 2, 256 to 258, is specified using Pr.1336 9
512 to 514 Pr.1397 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the signal number
7 and 8 Mapping
is specified using Pr.1337
Pr.1398 (lower 8 bits): Subindex to which the signal number
1398*1
User Defined Cyclic
Communication Output Sub 0
0 to 2, 256 to 258, is specified using Pr.1338 10
512 to 514 Pr.1398 (upper 8 bits): Subindex to which the signal number
9 and 10 Mapping
is specified using Pr.1339
N870 to User Defined Cyclic
Subindices to which the signal numbers are specified using
Communication Output Sub 0 0 to 2
N879*1 1 to 10 Mapping
Pr.1330 to Pr.1339
Telegram types
Select a telegram type according to the control mode. Users can select communication data using Telegram 102.
Telegram Description Size (words)
1 Standard Telegram 1 (Speed control) 2
100 Telegram 100 (Torque control) 3
Setpoint Telegram: 21
102 Telegram 102 (Custom)
Actual Value Telegram: 29
Which telegram type is used, can be read using PROFIdrive parameter P922
2. Ethernet Communication
2.12 PROFINET
173
NOTE
• Only one telegram module can be used at a time.
Data mapping
• Standard Telegram 1
Type IO Data number Name Abbreviation Data length (bit)
Setpoint Telegram 1 Control word 1 STW1 16
(master to inverter) 2 Speed setpoint A NSOLL_A 16
Actual Value Telegram 1 Status word 1 ZSW1 16
(inverter to master) 2 Speed actual value A NIST_A 16
• Telegram 100
Type IO Data number Name Abbreviation Data length (bit)
1 Control word 1 STW1 16
Setpoint Telegram
2 Target torque — 16
(master to inverter)
3 Speed setpoint A NSOLL_A 16
1 Status word 1 ZSW1 16
Actual Value Telegram
2 Actual torque — 16
(inverter to master)
3 Speed actual value A NIST_A 16
• Telegram 102
Data
IO Data Sub index
Type Name length Remarks
number specification
(bit)
Control word 1
1 — 16 Fixed
(STW1)
Pr.1389 (lower 8
2 Pr.1320 32
bits)
Pr.1389 (upper 8
3 Pr.1321 32
bits)
The following signal numbers are selectable.
Pr.1390 (lower 8
4 Pr.1322 32 5: Speed setpoint A (NSOLL_A) (Refer to page
bits)
176.)
Pr.1390 (upper 8 100: Target torque (Refer to page 177.)
5 Pr.1323 32
bits) 12288 to 13787: Inverter Parameters (Refer to
Setpoint Telegram Pr.1391 (lower 8 page 183.)
6 Pr.1324 32
(master to inverter) bits) 20488, 20489: Inverter Control Parameters
Pr.1391 (upper 8 (Refer to page 184.)
7 Pr.1325 32
bits) 24639, 24643, 24644, 24673 to 24676, 24692,
Pr.1392 (lower 8 24695, 24820, 24826, 24828, 25858: CiA402
8 Pr.1326 32 Drive Profile (Refer to page 186.)
bits)
When the data length of the selected signal is
Pr.1392 (upper 8
9 Pr.1327 32 16 bits, only the setting value for the lower 16
bits)
bits is valid.
Pr.1393 (lower 8
10 Pr.1328 32
bits)
Pr.1393 (upper 8
11 Pr.1329 32
bits)
2 Pr.1330
Pr.1394 (lower 8
bits)
32 2
Pr.1394 (upper 8
3 Pr.1331 32
bits)
4 Pr.1332
Pr.1395 (lower 8
bits)
32 3
Pr.1395 (upper 8 The following signal numbers are selectable.
5 Pr.1333 32 6: Speed actual value A (NIST_A) (Refer to
bits)
page 176.)
6 Pr.1334
Pr.1396 (lower 8
bits)
32 101: Actual torque (Refer to page 177.) 4
12288 to 13787: Inverter Parameters (Refer to
Actual Value Telegram Pr.1396 (upper 8 page 183.)
7 Pr.1335 32
(inverter to master) bits) 16384 to 16483: Monitor Data (Refer to page
8 Pr.1336
Pr.1397 (lower 8
32
184.) 5
bits) 20488, 20489, 20981 to 20990, 20992: Inverter
Pr.1397 (upper 8 Control Parameters (Refer to page 184.)
9 Pr.1337 32
bits) 24672, 24689, 24698, 24703, 24705, 24707,
10 Pr.1338
Pr.1398 (lower 8
32
24708, 24719, 24721, 24728 to 24730: CiA402
Drive Profile (Refer to page 186.)
6
bits)
20992 is available for the Ethernet model only.
Pr.1398 (upper 8
11 Pr.1339 32
bits)
12 Pr.1340 32 7
13 Pr.1341 32
Fixed to "0"
14 Pr.1342 32
15 Pr.1343 32
8
NOTE
• If the same signal number is specified in two or more of Pr.1320 to Pr.1329, the number set in the parameter with the smallest
parameter number is valid. The same number set in the other parameters is regarded as "9999". 9
• When a nonexistent signal number or "9999" is set in Pr.1320 to Pr.1329, the data is not written.
• When a nonexistent signal number or "9999" is set in Pr.1330 to Pr.1343, "0" is read.
10
• Control word 1 (STW1) details
Bit Name Inverter operation
0: OFF
0 ON/OFF
1: ON
0: Output shutoff
1 No Coast Stop/Coast Stop
1: Output shutoff release
0: Emergency stop
2 No Quick Stop/Quick Stop
1: Emergency stop release
0: Disabled
3 Enable/Disable Operation
1: Enabled
4 — Not used (fixed to "0")
0: Acceleration/deceleration stopped
1: Acceleration/deceleration not stopped
5 Acceleration/deceleration interruption*1 Valid during speed control.
Unfreeze/Freeze Ramp Generator Invalid when the start command is OFF or during automatic restart after
instantaneous power failure.
0: NSOLL_A disabled (frequency setting / speed limit value = "0")
6 Enable/Disable Setpoint
1: NSOLL_A enabled
When 20 ms or more elapses after the bit is turned ON, the fault buffer is
7 Fault Acknowledge (0→1) cleared (when the inverter is in a fault status, the protective function is
reset).*2
8 — Not used (fixed to "0")
9 — Not used (fixed to "0")
0: STW1 disabled
10 Control By PLC/No Control By PLC
1: STW1 enabled
2. Ethernet Communication
2.12 PROFINET
175
Bit Name Inverter operation
Target torque enabled 0: Target torque disabled (torque command = "0")
11
(Device-specific) 1: Target torque enabled (torque command = target torque)
Start command direction selection 0: Forward when NSOLL_A > 0, reverse when NSOLL_A < 0
12
(Device-specific) 1: Reverse when NSOLL_A > 0, forward when NSOLL_A < 0
0: Start command OFF
Home position return/positioning operation start 1: Start command ON
13
(Device-specific) Enabled when both conditions are satisfied: During position control and in
S4 state (page 178)
14, 15 — Not used (fixed to "0")
*1 Specifications differ depending on the date of manufacture of the inverter.
*2 E.16 to E.20, E.PE6, E.PE2, E.CPU, E.CMB, E.1, E.5 to E.7, and E.13 are not reset. In this case, take an appropriate corrective action first, and
reset them by power reset or inverter reset.
*1 When the calculation result is larger than 590 Hz, the value is applied to the set frequency.
NOTE 1
• When the target torque is assigned to Telegram 100 or Telegram 102, use bit 12 of STW1 to select the start command
direction. The input to NSOLL_A is treated as an absolute value.
• When the HMS PROFINET network option A8NPRT is installed in the FR-A800 or FR-F800 inverter, Pr.3 Base frequency is
used as reference. In the network configuration that includes the above, consider the difference of the reference value. 2
NOTE 5
• To use the torque command in Telegram 102, select 100 (Target torque) instead of 13093 (Pr.805).
10
2. Ethernet Communication
2.12 PROFINET
177
State transition diagram of the inverter
Power supply ON
(0)
(16)
(10) Quick Stop
(STW1 bit 2 = false)
• Definition
Inverter operation
Symbol Name Description
Other than position control Position control*2
*1 Switching On Inhibited During stop (initial status) Output shutoff (RY signal OFF)
S1
S2 Ready For Switching On During stop (ready) Output shutoff (RY signal OFF)
S3 Switched On During stop (standby) Output shutoff canceled (RY signal ON)*3
Start command ON (rotation
S4*4 Operation During operation (enabled) direction depends on STW1 and Servo-ON status
NSOLL_A settings)
S5 Switching Off Deceleration stop —
Servo-OFF status
Start command OFF, normal
S5-1 ramp stop Normal deceleration stop Start command OFF, output
deceleration stop
shutoff
Start command OFF,
deceleration stop according to Servo-OFF status
S5-2 quick stop Emergency stop the Pr.1103 and Pr.815 Start command OFF, output
shutoff
settings*5
Deceleration stop due to a
S5-3 fault stop Deceleration stop due to a communication error (Pr.502 = "1 or 2")
communication error
*1 The inverter state is forcefully changed to S1 when any of the following conditions is met:
When an inverter fault occurs
Mode other than Network operation mode
During commercial power supply operation during emergency drive
Master is in the stop state while the inverter is running.
• Transition No. 2
Symbol Description Remarks
(0) Power supply ON
(7)
Coast stop command from the master
Quick stop command from the master
6
(8) Coast stop command from the master
(9) OFF command from the master
(10) Quick stop command from the master 7
Motor stop
(11)
Disable operation command from the master
(12) Quick stop command from the master
(13) ON command from the master 8
Status transition will occur even while the master is in
(14) Motor stop
the stop state.
(15) Coast stop command from the master
Process data communication interrupted (Pr.502 = "1
9
(16)
or 2")
(17) Process data communication restarted (Pr.502 = "2")
(18)
Process data communication interrupted (Pr.502 = "1
or 2")
10
(19) Process data communication restarted (Pr.502 = "2")
When the process data communication with the master
(20) Quick stop command from the master (Pr.502 = "1")
is not restarted, status transition will not occur.
NOTE
• Depending on packets sent to the inverter while the master is in the stop state, the inverter state may not be changed to S1.
The run/stop state is determined by IOCS of the packet sent from the master to the inverter (Good (80h): run, Bad (60h): stop).
When the following master is used, the above-mentioned operation is performed in the stop state.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.12 PROFINET
179
• Command and control word 1 (STW1) combinations
STW1
Transition
Command Bit 3 (Enable Bit 2 (No Bit 1 (No Operation
Bit 0 (ON) No.
Operation) Quick Stop) Coast Stop)
OFF — 1 1 0 Transition to S2 (1)
ON — 1 1 1 Transition to S3 (2)
Enable operation 1 1 1 1 Operation (3)
Disable operation 0 1 1 1 Stop (4)
Emergency stop (deceleration
Quick stop — 0 — — (6), (7)
stop)
Output shutoff (coasting to
Coast stop — — 0 — (6), (7)
stop)
NSOLL_A = (5000 (50 Hz) × 16384 (4000h)) / 12000 (Pr.1 = 120 Hz) = 6827 (1AABh)
P980
Parameter Database
Handling and R
Array[n]
are assigned in the following order: PROFIdrive parameters,
PROFINET parameters, inverter parameters, monitor data, inverter
9
Unsigned16
Identification control parameters, and CiA402 drive profile. The first parameter of
the list of PNU numbers is marked by a subindex with the value "0".
10
CiA402 drive profile Inverter control parameter Monitor data Inverter parameter
P12288
Array[n] The inverter parameter number + 12288 (3000h) is the PNU
to Inverter Parameters R/W
Unsigned16 number.
P16383
P16384
to Monitor Data R Unsigned16 The monitor code + 16384 (4000h) is the PNU number.
P20479
P20480
Inverter Control
to R/W Unsigned16 Inverter control parameter
Parameters
P24575
P24576
to CiA402 Drive Profile R/W — CiA402 drive profile
P28671
2. Ethernet Communication
2.12 PROFINET
181
Group PNU Name Access Data Type Description
P61000 Name of station R Octetstring240 Station name of device
PROFINET parameter
• Selection switch Setpoint telegram, Selection switch Actual value telegram (P915/P916)
PNU Sub Access Name Data Type Description Default
Selection switch Array[n] Setpoint data assigned to the cyclic data is
915 0 to n R —
Setpoint telegram Unsigned16 sent back.
Selection switch Array[n] Actual value data assigned to the cyclic data
916 0 to n R —
Actual value telegram Unsigned16 is sent back.
Details of the read values are as follows.
Signal number Description
1 Control word 1 (STW1)
2 Status word 1 (ZSW1)
5 Speed setpoint A (NSOLL_A)
6 Speed actual value A (NIST_A)
100 Target torque
101 Actual torque
12288 to 16383 Inverter Parameters
16384 to 20479 Monitor Data
20480 to 24575 Inverter Control Parameters
24576 to 28671 CiA402 Drive Profile
2
identification Unsigned16
Firmware version:
—
2
FR-E800-(SC)E firmware version
• DO identification (P975) 8
The drive object identification information is sent back.
PNU Sub Access Name Data Type Description Default
0
Manufacturer ID:
540 9
Manufacturer ID of Mitsubishi Electric
1 Drive Object type 0
Firmware version:
2
Array[8]
FR-E800-(SC)E firmware version
—
10
975 R DO identification PROFIdrive DO type class
5 Unsigned16 1
1: Axis
PROFIdrive DO sub class 1
6 1
1: Application Class 1 supported
Drive Object ID (DO-ID)
7 1
Number of Drive Objects(DO)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.12 PROFINET
183
Calibration parameters
PNU Sub Name Description
0 Data C0 (Pr.900)
13188 (3384h)
1 Sub Data —
0 Data C1 (Pr.901)
13189 (3385h)
1 Sub Data —
0 Data C2 (Pr.902)
13190 (3386h)
1 Sub Data C3 (Pr.902)
0 Data 125 (Pr.903)
13191 (3387h)
1 Sub Data C4 (Pr.903)
0 Data C5 (Pr.904)
13192 (3388h)
1 Sub Data C6 (Pr.904)
0 Data 126 (Pr.905)
13193 (3389h)
1 Sub Data C7 (Pr.905)
0 Data C38 (Pr.932)
13220 (33A4h)
1 Sub Data C39 (Pr.932)
0 Data C40 (Pr.933)
13221 (33A5h)
1 Sub Data C41 (Pr.933)
0 Data C42 (Pr.934)
13222 (33A6h)
1 Sub Data C43 (Pr.934)
0 Data C44 (Pr.935)
13223 (33A7h)
1 Sub Data C45 (Pr.935)
For the numbers and names of inverter parameters, refer to the parameter list of the Instruction Manual (Function).
NOTE
• Set 65520 (FFF0h) as a parameter value "8888" and 65535 (FFFFh) as "9999".
• When parameter write is performed, data are written to RAM for Cyclic Data Exchange. Writing to EEPROM or RAM is selected
according to the setting in Pr.342 Communication EEPROM write selection for Acyclic Data Exchange.
NOTE
• Display of negative numbers during monitoring set in Pr.290 Monitor negative output selection is disabled.
• The display can be changed from the frequency to rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.53. When the machine
speed is displayed, the value is incremented by one.
Bit
Definition
Bit
Definition 10
Control input command Inverter status Control input command Inverter status
0 — RUN (Inverter running)*2 0 NET X1 (—)*1 NET Y1 (0)*2
1 — During forward rotation 1 NET X2 (—)*1 NET Y2 (0)*2
2 — During reverse rotation 2 NET X3 (—)*1 NET Y3 (0)*2
RH (High-speed operation
3 Up to frequency 3 NET X4 (—)*1 NET Y4 (0)*2
command)*1
RM (Middle-speed operation
4 Overload alarm 4 NET X5 (—)*1 0
command)*1
RL (Low-speed operation
5 0 5 — 0
command)*1
FU (Output frequency
6 JOG operation selection 2 6 — 0
detection)*2
7 Second function selection ABC (Fault)*2 7 — 0
8 Terminal 4 input selection ABC2 (0) 8 — 0
9 — Safety monitor output 2 9 — 0
10 MRS (Output stop)*1 0 10 — 0
11 — 0 11 — 0
12 RES (—)*1 0 12 — 0
13 — 0 13 — 0
14 — 0 14 — 0
15 — Fault occurrence 15 — 0
*1 The signal within parentheses ( ) is assigned in the initial status. The function changes depending on the setting of Pr.180 to Pr.189 (Input
terminal function selection).
For details, refer to the description of Pr.180 to Pr.189 (Input terminal function selection) in the Instruction Manual (Function).
The signals assigned to the input terminals may be valid or invalid in the NET operation mode. (Refer to the Instruction Manual (Function).)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.12 PROFINET
185
*2 The signal within parentheses ( ) is assigned in the initial status. The function changes depending on the setting of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output
terminal function selection).
For details, refer to the description of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output terminal function selection) in the Instruction Manual (Function).
—
Position encoder
Encoder resolution (machine side / motor side) — —
8
resolution
Highest sub-index
0 Maximum value of subindex: 02h (fixed) R Unsigned8
24719 supported
(608Fh)
Encoder
Encoder resolution 9
1 Set Pr.369 Number of encoder pulses. R/W Unsigned32
increments
Setting range: 2 to 4096
2 Motor revolutions Motor speed (rev): 00000001h (fixed) R/W Unsigned32
— Gear ratio Gear ratio — — 10
Highest sub-index
0 Maximum value of subindex: 02h (fixed) R Unsigned8
supported
Motor shaft revolutions*2
24721 1 Motor revolutions Set Pr.420 Command pulse scaling factor numerator R/W Unsigned32
(electronic gear numerator).
(6091h)
Setting range: 1 to 32767
Drive shaft revolutions*2
2 Shaft revolutions Set Pr.421 Command pulse multiplication denominator R/W Unsigned32
(electronic gear denominator).
Setting range: 1 to 32767
Home position return method
Set the home position return method in the direct command
24728
(6098h)
0 Homing method mode.*3 R/W Integer8
(For the direct command mode and the home position return
method, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
— Homing speeds Home position return speed — —
Highest sub-index
0 Maximum value of subindex: 01h (fixed) R Unsigned8
supported
24729 Motor speed during home position returning (r/min)
(6099h) Set the home position return speed in the direct command mode.
Speed during Initial value: 120 × 2 Hz / Pr.81
1 R/W Unsigned32
search for switch Setting range: 0 to (120 × 400 Hz / Pr.81)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.12 PROFINET
187
PNU Sub Name Description Access Data type
Home position return acceleration/deceleration time (ms)
Set the home position return acceleration/deceleration time in the
direct command mode.
Initial value: 5000
24730 Homing
0 Setting range: 10 to 360000 R/W Unsigned32
(609Ah) acceleration
The last digit is rounded off. (For example, 1358 ms becomes 1350
ms.)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
24820 Following error Droop pulse (pulse)
0 R Integer32
(60F4h) actual value The droop pulse before the electronic gear operation is read.
24826
0 Control effort Speed command after position loop*1 R Integer32
(60FAh) The ideal speed command is read.
24828 Position demand Position command (pulse)
0 R Integer32
(60FCh) internal value The position command after the electronic gear operation is read.
25858 Supported drive Supported control mode: 00010000h (vendor specific operation
0 R Unsigned32
(6502h) modes mode)
*1 The value is displayed and set in r/min regardless of the settings in Pr.53.
The frequency is converted to the rotation speed for reading, and the setting value is converted to the frequency for writing.
*2 When parameter write is performed, data are written to RAM for Cyclic Data Exchange. Writing to EEPROM or RAM is selected according to the
setting in Pr.342 Communication EEPROM write selection for Acyclic Data Exchange.
*3 The following table shows home position return methods corresponding to P24728 (6098h) setting values.
NOTE
• The command interface in the Network operation mode is determined by the Pr.550 NET mode operation command source
selection setting. (Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
• When the data is read, the value is displayed with a sign regardless of the Pr.290 Monitor negative output selection setting.
• IP address (P61001)
PNU Sub Access Name Data Type Description Default
0 IP address first octet —
1 IP address second octet —
61001 R IP address Octetstring4
2 IP address third octet —
3 IP address fourth octet —
2. Ethernet Communication
2.12 PROFINET
189
Parameter read Parameter change
Byte No. Field Description
Positive Negative Positive Negative
Data Type
Unsigned16: 06h
4 Format Octetstring: 0Ah ○ ○ × ○
V2: 73h
44h for error response
5 Number of data Number of arrays ○ ○ × ○
6 ○ ○ × ○
Parameter
value 7 ○ ○ × ○
8 *1 × × ×
○
9 Parameter value / Parameter reading value or error ○*1 × × ×
error number number
10 to 237 *1 × × ×
○
238 ○*1 × × ×
239 *1 × × ×
○
*1 Availability depends on the format or data size.
Error number
Error No. Name Description
00h Impermissible parameter number Access is attempted to a nonexistent PROFIdrive parameter.
01h Parameter value cannot be changed Writing is attempted to a writing-disabled PROFIdrive parameter.
02h Low or high limit exceeded Setting is out of range.
03h Faulty subindex Access is attempted to a nonexistent subindex.
Access is attempted to a PROFIdrive parameter which does not have a
04h No array
subindex.
05h Incorrect data type Data type does not match.
Request cannot be executed because of
11h Access is disabled temporarily due to the operating status.
operating state
16h Parameter address impermissible Value, number of elements, or PNU number is invalid for the subindex.
17h Illegal format PROFIdrive parameter data format is invalid.
19h Axis/DO nonexistent Access is attempted to a nonexistent shaft or object.
21h Service not supported Service is out of range. (Request ID is invalid.)
23h Multi parameter access not supported Access is attempted to multiple parameters at the same time.
Programming examples
The following explains the programming examples for controlling the inverter with sequence programs when Standard
Telegram 1 is selected.
Check that "34962" (PROFINET) is set in any of Pr.1427 to Pr.1430 (Ethernet function selection).
2. Ethernet Communication
2.12 PROFINET
191
Turning OFF M0 stops operation.
K6826
Setting example
• The following tables show example settings when user defined cyclic communication data are selected (Telegram 102).
When bit 10 of Control word 1 (STW1) is turned ON, data are written to the inverter. While bit 10 of Control word 1 (STW1)
is ON, the data is always updated. (The response time to write the data is 100 ms at the most.)
• Telegram 102
Type IO Data number Name
1 Control word 1 (STW1)
Setpoint Telegram 2 Pr.1320
(master to inverter) 3 Pr.1321
4 Pr.1322
1 Status word 1 (ZSW1)
2 Pr.1330
3 Pr.1331
Actual Value Telegram
4 Pr.1332
(inverter to master)
5 Pr.1333
6 Pr.1334
7 Pr.1335
10
2. Ethernet Communication
2.12 PROFINET
193
2.13 EtherCAT
2.13.1 Outline
Communication specifications
Item Description
Communication speed 100 Mbps (Full duplex)
Maximum number of connected units 65535*1
Ethernet cable (IEEE 802.3 100BASE-TX compliant cable and ANSI/TIA/EIA-
Connection cable
568-B (Category 5e) compliant shielded 4-pair branched cable)
Topology Line, star, ring, or a combination of line and star*2
PDO (Process Data Object) Communication method Cyclic communication
communication Cycle time Depends on the master
SDO (Service Data Object)
Communication method Mailbox communication (acyclic communication)
communication
Free-run mode
Synchronization mode
Local cycle time: 4 ms
*1 The number varies depending on the specification of the master.
*2 For star or ring topology, a general-purpose switching hub cannot be used. Use an EtherCAT branch slave.
Wiring method
• For the FR-E800-EPC, PORT1 is the IN connector and PORT2 is the OUT connector. Use PORT1 for connection with the
master or the upstream station, and use PORT2 for connection with the downstream station.
IN OUT IN OUT
4
LED name Description LED status Remarks
OFF Power-OFF / Init state
Blinking green
Pre-Operational state
5
(200 ms intervals)
Flashing green, 1
EC RN EtherCAT state machine (ESM) status Safe-Operational state
flash
Blinking green
Initialization state
6
(50 ms intervals)
Solid green Operational state
OFF
Blinking red (200
No error.
EtherCAT state change commanded by the
7
ms intervals) master is impossible.
Flashing red, 1
EtherCAT state is changed due to internal fault.
EC ER Error status flash
Flashing red, 2
8
Watchdog fault of sync managers (SM).
flashes
Blinking red (50
An error is detected at a start.
ms intervals) 9
OFF Power-OFF/link-down
Blinking green
L/A 1 Connector for communication (PORT1) status Link-up (Data reception in progress)
(50 ms intervals)
Solid green Link-up 10
OFF Power-OFF/link-down
Blinking green
L/A 2 Connector for communication (PORT2) status Link-up (Data reception in progress)
(50 ms intervals)
Solid green Link-up
ESI file
An ESI file is available for download.
NOTE
• The ESI file is used in engineering software. To install the ESI file properly, refer to the instruction manual of the applicable
engineering software.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.13 EtherCAT
195
Initial
Pr. Name Setting range Description
value
NOTE 1
• The FR-E800-EPC does not support the following parameters.
• Default gateway address (Pr.442 to Pr.445)
• Inverter-to-inverter link function (Pr.1124 and Pr.1125)
• Ethernet relay operation at reset selection (Pr.1386) 2
• Inverter identification enable/disable selection (Pr.1399)
• Ethernet communication network number (Pr.1424), Ethernet communication station number (Pr.1425)
• Link speed and duplex mode selection (Pr.1426) 3
• Ethernet function selection (Pr.1427 to Pr.1430)
• Ethernet communication check time interval (Pr.1432)
• IP address (Pr.1434 to Pr.1437)
• Subnet mask (Pr.1438 to Pr.1441) 4
• IP filtering function (Ethernet) (Pr.1442 to Pr.1448)
• Ethernet IP address for command source selection (Pr.1449 to Pr.1454)
• Keepalive time (Pr.1455)
• Network diagnosis selection (Pr.1456)
5
• Extended setting for Ethernet signal loss detection function selection (Pr.1457)
6
Node address setting
The node address is either automatically set by the master using the engineering software or set in the inverter parameter.
• Configured Station Alias (Setting by the master via EtherCAT communication, which is to be set in SII (Slave Information 7
Interface) of the inverter)
Set Configured Station Alias using the engineering software. The setting becomes valid after next power ON of the inverter.
• Requesting ID (ID-Selector set in the inverter parameter) 8
Set Device ID to be used as Requesting ID in Pr.1305 EtherCAT node address setting.
Device ID Setting range
Pr.1305 1 to 65535 ("0" is set when Device ID is not set.) 9
2.13.3 EtherCAT state machine (ESM)
• Definition
10
Power on
(1)
Init
(2) (3)
Pre-Operational (6)
(4) (5)
(9)
(10) Safe-Operational
(7) (8)
Operational
Status Description
Init (INIT) Initialization of communication
Pre-Operational (PREOP) SDO communication enabled
SDO communication enabled
Safe-Operational (SAFEOP)
Only TxPDO (inverter to master) transmission enabled for PDO communication
SDO communication and PDO communication enabled
Operational (OP)
Writing using SDO communication is not available to the object mapped in RxPDO (master to inverter).
2. Ethernet Communication
2.13 EtherCAT
197
• Transition No.
Transition No. Description
(1) Power-ON, inverter reset
SDO communication configuration set by the master
(2)
Request from the master for transition to the Pre-Operational state
PDO communication configuration set by the master
(4)
Request from the master for transition to the Safe-Operational state
Output of command values from the master started
(7)
Request from the master for transition to the Operational state
(5) (10) Request from the master for transition to the Pre-Operational state
(8) Request from the master for transition to the Safe-Operational state
(3) (6) (9) Request from the master for transition to the Init state
2. Write the index number of the PDO mapping object to be used in Sub index H01.
2. Write the setting values in Sub index H01 to H0n (n: number of data).
2
Index H1620 (33rd receive PDO mapping)
Mapping content
Sub index Name Data length (bit) Remarks
(initial value) 3
Index H6040
H01 Mapped object 001 (controlword) 16 Unchangeable
(fixed)
NOTE
• When a nonexistent index number or "9999" is set in Pr.1330 to Pr.1343, the data is regarded as H0.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.13 EtherCAT
199
Index H1A20 (33rd transmit PDO mapping)
Mapping content
Sub index Name Data length (bit) Remarks
(initial value)
Index H6041
H01 Mapped object 001 (statusword) 16 Unchangeable
(fixed)
Index H6043
H02 Mapped object 002 16
(vl velocity demand)
H03 Mapped object 003
H04 Mapped object 004
H05 Mapped object 005
H06 Mapped object 006
H07 Mapped object 007
H08 Mapped object 008 The number of data sets is changeable.
Determined by the (Specify the number in Sub index H00.)
H09 Mapped object 009 No function
mapping content
H0A Mapped object 010
H0B Mapped object 011
H0C Mapped object 012
H0D Mapped object 013
H0E Mapped object 014
H0F Mapped object 015
2. Ethernet Communication
2.13 EtherCAT
201
Sub
Index Name Description Read/write Data type
index
H6064 Position actual Current position (pulse)
H00 Read Integer32
(24676) value The current position before the electronic gear operation is read.
Droop pulse error judgment value (pulse)
H6065 Following error
H00 Initial value: 40000 (H9C40) Read/write Unsigned32
(24677) window
Setting range: H00000000 to HFFFFFFFF
H6066 Following error
H00 Droop pulse error judgment time: H0000 (fixed) Read/write Unsigned16
(24678) time out
In-position judgment value (pulse)
H6067 Set the in-position width.
H00 Position window Read/write Unsigned32
(24679) Initial value: 100 (H64)
Setting range: H00000000 to HFFFFFFFF
H6068 Position window
H00 In-position judgment time: H0000 (fixed) Read/write Unsigned16
(24680) time
Target torque (%)
Set Pr.805 Torque command value (RAM).
H6071
H00 Target torque Setting range: 600% to 1400% Read/write Integer16
(24689)
When the value is set in 0.1 increments, the first decimal place is
rounded off.
H6074 Torque demand value (%)
H00 Torque demand Read Integer16
(24692) The torque command is read.
H6077 Torque actual Torque actual value (%)
H00 Read Integer16
(24695) value The motor torque is read.
Target position (pulse)
Set the target position in the direct command mode.
H607A Initial value: 0
H00 Target position Read/write Integer32
(24698) Setting range: -2147483647 to 2147483647
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
Direction of rotation: 0 or 128
H607E Bit 0 to 6: 0
H00 Polarity Read/write Unsigned8
(24702) Bit 7: Direction of rotation set by the controlword during position
control (0: Forward, 1: Reverse)
Maximum profile speed (r/min)*2*3
H607F Max profile Set Pr.18 High speed maximum frequency in r/min.
H00 Setting range: 0 to 590 Hz Read/write Unsigned32
(24703) velocity
Do not change the settings of this index and index H6046, sub index
H02 at the same time.
Profile speed (r/min)
Set the maximum speed in the direct command mode.
H6081 Initial value: 0
H00 Profile velocity Read/write Unsigned32
(24705) Setting range: 0 to (120 × 590 Hz / Pr.81)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
Acceleration time constant (ms)
<Position control>
Set the acceleration time in the direct command mode.
Initial value: 5000
Setting range: 10 to 360000
The last digit is rounded off. (For example, 1358 ms becomes 1350
ms.)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
H6083 Profile
H00 Manual (Function).) Read/write Unsigned32
(24707) acceleration
<Other than position control>
Set Pr.7 Acceleration time in ms.
Setting range: 0 to 3600 s
The last two digits are rounded off when Pr.21 Acceleration/
deceleration time increments = "0", and the last digit is rounded off
when Pr.21 = "1".
Do not change the settings of this index and index H6048, sub index
H02 at the same time.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.13 EtherCAT
203
Sub
Index Name Description Read/write Data type
index
Home position return acceleration/deceleration time (ms)
Set the home position return acceleration/deceleration time in the
direct command mode.
Initial value: 5000
H609A Homing
H00 Setting range: 10 to 360000 Read/write Unsigned32
(24730) acceleration
The last digit is rounded off. (For example, 1358 ms becomes 1350
ms.)
(For the direct command mode, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
H60F4 Following error Droop pulse (pulse)
H00 Read Integer32
(24820) actual value The droop pulse before the electronic gear operation is read.
H60FA
H00 Control effort Speed command after position loop*2 Read Integer32
(24826) The ideal speed command is read.
H60FC Position demand Position command (pulse)
H00 Read Integer32
(24828) internal value The position command after the electronic gear operation is read.
Set speed (r/min)*2*4
Set the set frequency in r/min.
Monitoring range: -32768 (H8000) to 32767 (H7FFF)
H60FF When Pr.81 = "9999", the number of motor poles is regarded as 4.
H00 Target velocity Read/write Integer32
(24831) For writing the value after the unit switchover using Pr.53, the lower
24 bits of the data are valid and the upper 8 bits are ignored.
Do not change the settings of this index and index H6042 at the same
time.
H6502 Supported drive Supported control mode: H00010000 (vendor specific operation
H00 Read Unsigned32
(25858) modes mode)
Device type
Bit 0 to 15 Device Profile Number: H0192
H67FF Single device (402: Drive Profile)
H00 Read Unsigned32
(26623)*1 type Bit 16 to 23 Additional Information (Type): H01 (Frequency Converter:
inverter)
Bit 24 to 31 Additional Information (mode bits): H00
*1 Not available for PDO communication.
*2 The value is displayed and set in r/min regardless of the settings in Pr.53.
The frequency is converted to the rotation speed for reading, and the setting value is converted to the frequency for writing.
*3 When parameter write is performed, data are written to RAM for PDO communication. Writing to EEPROM or RAM is selected according to the
setting in Pr.342 Communication EEPROM write selection for SDO communication.
*4 Writing is not restricted by the Pr.18 and Pr.2 settings.
*5 The following table shows home position return methods corresponding to the Index H6098 setting values.
NOTE
• The command interface in the Network operation mode is determined by the Pr.550 NET mode operation command source
selection setting. (Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
• When the data is read, the value is displayed with a sign regardless of the Pr.290 Monitor negative output selection setting.
0
3
Not ready to
switch on
4
1
Switch on
15
Fault
5
disabled
2 7 14
12 3 6 9
7
Switched on 8
4 5 8
Quick stop Operation
active enabled
11
9
Inverter operation*1
Name Status
Position control Other than position control
During stop (initialization in 10
Not ready to switch on Output shutoff (RY signal OFF)
progress)
Switch on disabled During stop (initial status) Output shutoff (RY signal OFF)
Ready to switch on During stop (ready) Output shutoff (RY signal OFF)
Switched on During stop (standby) Output shutoff canceled (RY signal ON)*2
• Enable operation command received
(Same operation as when the start
NOTE
• When all the following conditions are satisfied, the control using the controlword and the state transition is enabled.
• NET operation mode
• The Ethernet connector is the command interface enabled in the NET operation mode (Pr.550).
• Pr.338 Communication operation command source = "0"
• The main circuit capacitor's life cannot be measured when the control using the controlword is enabled. (For the measurement
of the main circuit capacitor's life, refer to the Instruction Manual (Function).)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.13 EtherCAT
205
• Transition No.
Transition No. Controlword Other than controlword
0 — Power-ON, inverter reset
1 — Automatic transition after initialization
2 Shutdown command —
3 Switch on command —
Enable operation command (transition
4 —
disabled when the RY signal is OFF)
Disable operation command*1
Transition after the inverter is stopped Transition enabled when the RY signal turns
5
(transition disabled during DC injection brake OFF*1
operation or pre-excitation)
6 Shutdown command —
7 Disable voltage or Quick stop command *3
8 Shutdown command*1 —
9 Disable voltage command*1 *3
*1 The servo ON (LX signal ON) state (during position control) or the start command ON state (during control other than position control) that is
activated by inputting the command will be canceled.
*2 When the command is not used and the X87 or X92 signal is assigned for an emergency stop, transition to the "Quick stop active" state is disabled.
*3 When any one of the following conditions is not satisfied, transition to the "Switch on disabled" state will occur.
NET operation mode
The Ethernet connector is the command interface enabled in the NET operation mode (Pr.550).
Pr.338 Communication operation command source = "0"
*4 E.16 to E.20, E.PE6, E.PE2, E.CPU, E.SAF, E.CMB, E.1, E.5 to E.7, and E.13 are not reset. In this case, take an appropriate corrective action
first, and reset them by power reset or inverter reset.
—: Not used
2. Ethernet Communication
2.13 EtherCAT
207
• Status during emergency drive operation
Emergency drive operating status State after transition
During commercial power supply operation during emergency
Switch on disabled
drive
When a critical fault occurs Fault reaction active to Fault
Others Operation enabled
Statusword (H6041)
• Position control
After home position return is completed and bit 4 of controlword is changed from 1 to 0, positioning operation starts. However,
bit 4 operation is not required when the home position return method is ignoring the home position (servo ON position as the
home position), or the roll feed mode, current position retention function, or JOG operation is used.
Bit Name Home position return Positioning
0 ready to switch on (rtso)
1 switched on (so)
Refer to page 209.
2 operation enabled (oe)
3 Fault (f)
4 Not used
5 quick stop (qs)
Refer to page 209.
6 switch on disabled (sod)
0: Without warning or alarm
7 warning (w)
1: With warning or alarm
8 Not used
0: Control using the controlword disabled
9 remote (rm)
1: Control using the controlword enabled*1
• Without home position return failure (ZA
signal OFF)
0: PBSY signal ON
1: PBSY signal OFF
hm (tr)*2 • With home position return failure (ZA signal
—
ON)
0: Ideal speed command other than 0
1: Ideal speed command 0
10
0: Target position not reached
1: Target position reached
The bit is changed to 1 when the difference
(absolute value) of the target position (H607A)
target reached (tr) —
and the position actual value (H6064) is equal
to or less than the position window (H6067)
setting for the time set in the position window
time (H6068).
0: Forward or reverse stroke end not reached (LP signal OFF)
11 internal limit active
1: Forward or reverse stroke end reached (LP signal ON)
0: Home position return not completed (ZP
signal OFF)
12 hm (oms)*2 1: Home position return completed (ZP signal
—
ON)
0: Without home position return failure (ZA
signal OFF)
hm (oms)*2 1: With home position return failure (ZA signal
—
ON)
0: No following error
1: Following error
13
The bit is changed to 1 when the difference
(absolute value) of the position demand value
Following error (oms) —
(H6062) and the position actual value (H6064)
exceeds the following error window (H6065)
setting for the time set in the following error
time out (H6066).
14, 15 Not used
Status
Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 10
sod qs f oe so rtso
Not ready to switch on 0 — 0 0 0 0
Switch on disabled 1 — 0 0 0 0
Ready to switch on 0 1 0 0 0 1
Switched on 0 1 0 0 1 1
Operation enabled 0 1 0 1 1 1
Quick stop active 0 0 0 1 1 1
Fault reaction active 0 — 1 1 1 1
Fault 0 — 1 0 0 0
—: Not used
2. Ethernet Communication
2.13 EtherCAT
209
• Calibration parameter
Index Sub index Name Description Read/write Size
H00 Highest sub-index supported — Read 8 bits
13188 (H3384) H01 Data C0 (Pr.900) Read/write 16 bits
H02 Sub Data — Read/write 16 bits
H00 Highest sub-index supported — Read 8 bits
13189 (H3385) H01 Data C1 (Pr.901) Read/write 16 bits
H02 Sub Data — Read/write 16 bits
H00 Highest sub-index supported — Read 8 bits
13190 (H3386) H01 Data C2 (Pr.902) Read/write 16 bits
H02 Sub Data C3 (Pr.902) Read/write 16 bits
H00 Highest sub-index supported — Read 8 bits
13191 (H3387) H01 Data 125 (Pr.903) Read/write 16 bits
H02 Sub Data C4 (Pr.903) Read/write 16 bits
H00 Highest sub-index supported — Read 8 bits
13192 (H3388) H01 Data C5 (Pr.904) Read/write 16 bits
H02 Sub Data C6 (Pr.904) Read/write 16 bits
H00 Highest sub-index supported — Read 8 bits
13193 (H3389) H01 Data 126 (Pr.905) Read/write 16 bits
H02 Sub Data C7 (Pr.905) Read/write 16 bits
H00 Highest sub-index supported — Read 8 bits
13220 (H33A4) H01 Data C38 (Pr.932) Read/write 16 bits
H02 Sub Data C39 (Pr.932) Read/write 16 bits
H00 Highest sub-index supported — Read 8 bits
13221 (H33A5) H01 Data C40 (Pr.933) Read/write 16 bits
H02 Sub Data C41 (Pr.933) Read/write 16 bits
H00 Highest sub-index supported — Read 8 bits
13222 (H33A6) H01 Data C42 (Pr.934) Read/write 16 bits
H02 Sub Data C43 (Pr.934) Read/write 16 bits
H00 Highest sub-index supported — Read 8 bits
13223 (H33A7) H01 Data C44 (Pr.935) Read/write 16 bits
H02 Sub Data C45 (Pr.935) Read/write 16 bits
For the numbers and names of inverter parameters, refer to the parameter list of the Instruction Manual (Function).
NOTE
• Set 65520 (HFFF0) as a parameter value "8888" and 65535 (HFFFF) as "9999".
• When parameter write is performed, data are written to RAM for PDO communication. Writing to EEPROM or RAM is selected
according to the setting in Pr.342 Communication EEPROM write selection for SDO communication.
Monitor data
Index Sub index Name Remarks Read/write Size
Monitor data #nnnn
16384 to 16483 The monitor code (decimal) + 16384 (H4000) is
H00 (nnnn: monitor code Read 16 bits
(H4000 to H4063) the index number.
(decimal))
For details of the monitor codes and monitor items, refer to the description of Pr.52 in the Instruction Manual (Function).
NOTE
• Display of negative numbers during monitoring set in Pr.290 Monitor negative output selection is disabled.
• The display can be changed from the frequency to rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.53. When the machine
speed is displayed, the value is incremented by one.
Index
Sub
Name Remarks
Read/
Size
1
index write
Set H9966 for the written value. Read/
20482 (H5002)*1 H00 Inverter reset
The read value is fixed to H0000. write
16 bits
24574 (H5FFE)
H04 Index: Pr.1323, Sub index: Pr.1390 (high) values in the same format as mapping object
are read.
Read 32 bits 10
H05 Index: Pr.1324, Sub index: Pr.1391 (low) Read 32 bits
H06 Index: Pr.1325, Sub index: Pr.1391 (high) Bit 16 to 31: Index Read 32 bits
Bit 8 to 15: Subindex
H07 Index: Pr.1326, Sub index: Pr.1392 (low) Read 32 bits
Bit 0 to 7: Object size (bit)
H08 Index: Pr.1327, Sub index: Pr.1392 (high) Sub index H01: H60420020 (initial value) Read 32 bits
H09 Index: Pr.1328, Sub index: Pr.1393 (low) Sub index H02 to H0A: H00000020 (initial Read 32 bits
H0A Index: Pr.1329, Sub index: Pr.1393 (high) value) Read 32 bits
- TxPDO Parameter Mapping — —
H00 Highest sub-index supported Read 8 bits
H01 Index: Pr.1330, Sub index: Pr.1394 (low) PDO mapping object for H1A00 Read 32 bits
H02 Index: Pr.1331, Sub index: Pr.1394 (high) For reading using PDO communication, the Read 32 bits
H03 Index: Pr.1332, Sub index: Pr.1395 (low) values corresponding to the objects selected Read 32 bits
using Pr.1330 to Pr.1343 and Pr.1394 to
H04 Index: Pr.1333, Sub index: Pr.1395 (high) Read 32 bits
Pr.1398 are read.
H05 Index: Pr.1334, Sub index: Pr.1396 (low) For reading using SDO communication, the Read 32 bits
H06 Index: Pr.1335, Sub index: Pr.1396 (high) values in the same format as mapping object Read 32 bits
24575 (H5FFF)
H07 Index: Pr.1336, Sub index: Pr.1397 (low) are read. Read 32 bits
H08 Index: Pr.1337, Sub index: Pr.1397 (high) Bit 16 to 31: Index Read 32 bits
Bit 8 to 15: Subindex
H09 Index: Pr.1338, Sub index: Pr.1398 (low) Read 32 bits
Bit 0 to 7: Object size (bit)
H0A Index: Pr.1339, Sub index: Pr.1398 (high) Sub index H01: H60430020 (initial value) Read 32 bits
H0B Index: Pr.1340, Sub index: 0x00 Sub index H02 to H0E: H00000020 (initial Read 32 bits
H0C Index: Pr.1341, Sub index: 0x00 value) Read 32 bits
H0D Index: Pr.1342, Sub index: 0x00 Read 32 bits
H0E Index: Pr.1343, Sub index: 0x00 Read 32 bits
2. Ethernet Communication
2.13 EtherCAT
211
• Inverter status / control input command, and inverter status / control input command (extended)
Inverter status / control input command Inverter status / control input command (extended)
Definition Definition
Bit Bit
Control input command Inverter status Control input command Inverter status
0 — RUN (Inverter running)*2 0 NET X1 (—)*1 NET Y1 (0)*2
1 — During forward rotation 1 NET X2 (—)*1 NET Y2 (0)*2
2 — During reverse rotation 2 NET X3 (—)*1 NET Y3 (0)*2
RH (High-speed operation
3 Up to frequency 3 NET X4 (—)*1 NET Y4 (0)*2
command)*1
RM (Middle-speed operation
4 Overload warning 4 NET X5 (—)*1 0
command)*1
RL (Low-speed operation
5 0 5 — 0
command)*1
FU (Output frequency
6 JOG operation selection 2 6 — 0
detection)*2
7 Second function selection ABC (Fault)*2 7 — 0
8 Terminal 4 input selection ABC2 (0) 8 — 0
9 — Safety monitor output 2 9 — 0
10 MRS (Output stop)*1 0 10 — 0
11 — 0 11 — 0
12 RES (—)*1 0 12 — 0
13 — 0 13 — 0
14 — 0 14 — 0
15 — Fault occurrence 15 — 0
*1 The signal within parentheses ( ) is the initial status. The function changes depending on the setting of Pr.180 to Pr.189 (Input terminal function
selection).
For details, refer to the description of Pr.180 to Pr.189 (Input terminal function selection) in the Instruction Manual (Function).
The signals assigned to the input terminals may be valid or invalid in the NET operation mode. (Refer to the Instruction Manual (Function).)
*2 The signal within parentheses ( ) is assigned in the initial status. The function changes depending on the setting of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output
terminal function selection).
For details, refer to the description of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output terminal function selection) in the Instruction Manual (Function).
2. Ethernet Communication
2.13 EtherCAT
213
Index Sub index Name Description Read/write Size
33rd transmit PDO
— — — —
mapping
Maximum value of subindex
Highest sub-index
H00
supported
Setting range: H00 to H0F Read/write*1 8 bits
Initial value: H02
H01 Mapped object 001 Read/write*1 32 bits
H02 Mapped object 002 Read/write*1 32 bits
H03 Mapped object 003 Read/write*1 32 bits
H04 Mapped object 004 *1 32 bits
Read/write
H05 Mapped object 005 Objects mapped using SDO communication Read/write*1 32 bits
H1A20 H06 Mapped object 006 Bit 16 to 31: Index Read/write *1 32 bits
Bit 8 to 15: Subindex
H07 Mapped object 007
Bit 0 to 7: Object size (bit) Read/write*1 32 bits
H08 Mapped object 008 Sub index H01: H60410010 (statusword) (fixed) *1 32 bits
Read/write
Sub index H02: H60430010 (initial value)
H09 Mapped object 009 Read/write*1 32 bits
Sub index H03 to H0F: H00000000 (initial value)
H0A Mapped object 010 Except for SDO Complete Access, to write data in Sub Read/write*1 32 bits
H0B Mapped object 011 index H01 to H0F, set "0" in Sub index H00 first. Read/write*1 32 bits
H0C Mapped object 012 Read/write*1 32 bits
H0D Mapped object 013 *1 32 bits
Read/write
H0E Mapped object 014 Read/write*1 32 bits
H0F Mapped object 015 *1 32 bits
Read/write
Sync Manager
— — — —
Communication Type
Highest sub-index
H00 Maximum value of subindex: H04 Read 8 bits
supported
H1C00
H01 Sync Manager 0 Mailbox in (master to inverter) Read 8 bits
H02 Sync Manager 1 Mailbox out (inverter to master) Read 8 bits
H03 Sync Manager 2 PDO output (master to inverter) Read 8 bits
H04 Sync Manager 3 PDO input (inverter to master) Read 8 bits
Sync Manager RxPDO
— — — —
Assign
Maximum value of subindex
Highest sub-index
H00
supported
Setting range: H00 and H01 Read/write*1 8 bits
Initial value: H01
H1C12
PDO mapping object assigned to sync manager 2 (RxPDO)
Setting range: H1600 and H1620
H01 assigned RxPDO Initial value: H1600 Read/write*1 16 bits
Except for SDO Complete Access, to write data in Sub
index H01, set "0" in Sub index H00 first.
Sync Manager TxPDO
— — — —
Assign
Maximum value of subindex
Highest sub-index
H00
supported
Setting range: H00 and H01 Read/write*1 8 bits
Initial value: H01
H1C13
PDO mapping object assigned to sync manager 3 (TxPDO)
Setting range: H1A00 and H1A20
H01 assigned TxPDO Initial value: H1A00 Read/write*1 16 bits
Except for SDO Complete Access, to write data in Sub
index H01, set "0" in Sub index H00 first.
Sync Manager 2
— — — —
Synchronization
Highest sub-index
H00 Maximum value of subindex: H04 Read 8 bits
supported
H1C32
Synchronization mode
H01 Synchronization Type Read 16 bits
H0000: Free-Run
Synchronization Types Supported synchronization mode
H04 Read 16 bits
supported H0001: Free-Run is supported.
—
Sync Manager 3
Synchronization
— — — 1
Highest sub-index
H00 Maximum value of subindex: H04 Read 8 bits
supported
H1C33
H01 Synchronization Type
Synchronization mode
H0000: Free-Run
Read 16 bits 2
Synchronization Types Supported synchronization mode
H04 Read 16 bits
supported H0001: Free-Run is supported.
*1 Writing is enabled only in the Pre-Operational state. 3
2.13.6 Operation when a communication error occurs
4
Signal loss detection function
• Signal loss detection is enabled according to the setting in Pr.1431 Ethernet signal loss detection function selection.
The FR-E800-EPC does not support Pr.1457 Extended setting for Ethernet signal loss detection function selection. 5
The operation is the same as the one performed when Pr.1457 = "9999". (Refer to page 224.)
Set the speed command to 1500 r/min (when Pr.81 Number of motor poles is set to 4 poles (initial value)).
Speed command: vl target velocity (H6042) = 1500 r/min
2. Ethernet Communication
2.13 EtherCAT
215
Turning ON E001_Rotation turns ON Enable operation to start forward rotation at 1500 r/min.
Turning OFF E001_Rotation stops operation.
Set a negative value for vl target velocity for reverse rotation.
Inverter 1
established*1 Inverter 1 error*1 E001_Output_enable
0
Inverter 1_Output_enable
Inverter 1_Input_enable
Switch on disabled Shutdown
E001_Input_enable E001_Output_enable = MOVE
1 EN EN ENO
Inverter 1_Input_ Inverter 1_Output_ uint#16#240 In1 UINT#16#6 In Out E001_Controlword
enable enable
E001_Statusword In2
E001_Statusword In2
*1 Differs depending on the master used. Refer to the Master Module User's Manual.
2.14.1 Outline 2
A backup/restore tool is available for backing up inverter parameters and the data used in the PLC function of inverter. The
backup data can be used to restore the data in the inverter. (Not compatible with safety parameters of the FR-E800-SCE) 3
This function is not supported depending on the date of manufacture of the inverter. For details of specification changes, refer
to page 284.
System configuration 4
Ethernet cable
5
Personal computer
(Backup/restore tool) Inverter
6
2.14.2 Initial setting for the backup/restore function
Use the following parameters to perform required settings for Ethernet communication between the inverter and other devices. 7
To make communication between other devices and the inverter, perform the initial settings of the inverter parameters to match
the communication specifications of the devices. Data communication cannot be made if the initial settings are not made or if
there is any setting error. 8
Initial
Pr. Name Setting range Setting range
value
1427 Ethernet function selection
5001 9
N630*1 1 502, 5000 to 5002,
1428 Ethernet function selection 5006 to 5008, 5010 to
45237
N631*1 2 5013, 9999, 34962*3,
1429 Ethernet function selection 44818*2, 45237,
Set the application, protocol, and so on. 10
*1 45238 *2
N632 3 45238, 47808 ,
1430 Ethernet function selection 61450
9999
N633*1 4
*1 The setting is applied after an inverter reset or next power-ON.
*2 The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPA and the FR-E800-SCEPA.
*3 The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPB and the FR-E800-SCEPB.
NOTE
• When files used in the PLC function are backed up while password protection is enabled for the files (read protection) and then
the backed-up files are restored, password protection will be disabled.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.14 Backup/restore
217
Backup/restore operation
• All inverter parameters and all data used in the PLC function of inverter can be backed up and restored.
• After restore operation, check the parameter setting values before starting operation.
• The backup/restore cannot be performed in the following cases.
Operation Inverter status
Backup During an inverter reset
A password is registered or password protection is enabled (Pr.297 ≠ "9999").
During restore
While password protection is enabled for files used in the PLC function (read protection)
Restore During an inverter reset
During running
During auto tuning
A password is registered or password protection is enabled (Pr.297 ≠ "9999").
While parameter write is disabled (Pr.77 = "1")
During backup operation
During the RUN status of the PLC function
While password protection is enabled for files used in the PLC function (write protection)
• "RD" is displayed during backup and "WR" is displayed during restore on the operation panel, and the MS LED blinks in
red.
NOTE
• Restore operation is not available between different models (such as between the FR-E800 series and the FR-A800 series,
the FR-E800-EPA inverter and the FR-E800-EPB inverter, and the Ethernet model and the safety communication model). An
error occurs in the backup/restore tool.
The inverter-to-inverter link function enables communication between multiple inverters connected by Ethernet in a small-scale
system by using the I/O devices and special registers of the PLC function. 2
The inverter-to-inverter link function is enabled by simply setting Pr.1124 Station number in inverter-to-inverter link and
Pr.1125 Number of inverters in inverter-to-inverter link system.
Initial
3
Pr. Name Setting range Description
value
1124 Station number in inverter- 0 to 5 Set the station number for the inverter-to-inverter link function.
9999
N681*1*2 to-inverter link 9999 Inverter-to-inverter link function disabled 4
1125 Number of inverters in
Set the total number of inverters used for the inverter-to-inverter
inverter-to-inverter link 2 2 to 6
N682*1*2 system
link function.
Communication specifications
The communication specification varies depending on the specification of the master. 6
Item Description
Communication speed 100 Mbps
NOTE
• Use different station numbers for different devices. (If different devices have the same station number, the communication
cannot be performed properly.)
• Set consecutive numbers for the station numbers. (Do not skip any numbers like 1, 2, then 4.)
• When Pr.1124 is set to a value equal to or greater than the value set in Pr.1125, normal communication is not available.
• Use the Inverter-to-inverter linkup (LNK) signal to check that the master-slave communication is established. (For details of
the LNK signal, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
• To detect the interruption of the inverter-to-inverter link communication and activate the protective function, set Pr.997 Fault
initiation in advance, and create and execute a sequence program to activate the protective function by the input of the signal
loss detection signal from the external sensor.
• For the details of the PLC function, refer to the PLC Function Programming Manual and the Instruction Manual of FR
Configurator2. For the details of FR Configurator2, refer to the Instruction Manual of FR Configurator2.
System configuration
The following shows the system configuration for using the inverter-to-inverter link function. The master inverter can
communicate with the slave inverters through one or two hubs (refer to the description of Pr.1124 for the master/slave setting).
2. Ethernet Communication
2.15 Inverter-to-inverter link function
219
(Communication using the inverter-to-inverter function is not available for the inverters directly connected to the router.)
Personal computer
Router (FR Configurator2)
Hub Hub
100 Mbps
Device map
The following shows the I/O devices and special registers used for the inverter-to-inverter link function. (For the details of the
other I/O devices and special registers, refer to the PLC Function Programming Manual.)
Troubleshooting 4
Condition Possible cause Countermeasure
The same station number is assigned to multiple
inverters.
Set Pr.1124 correctly. 5
Set Pr.1124 so that the station numbers are
The station numbers are not consecutive.
consecutive.
The specified number of inverters in the system is
not correct. (Pr.1124 is set to a value equal to or Set Pr.1125 correctly.
6
Communication is not
greater than the value set in Pr.1125.)
established.
Use full-duplex connection. (When Pr.1426 Link
The connection is half-duplex.
speed and duplex mode selection = "0 (initial
value)", check that the hub and the Ethernet cable
7
are compatible with full-duplex connection.)
The inverter is not reset after Pr.1124 and Pr.1125
Reset the inverter.
10
2. Ethernet Communication
2.15 Inverter-to-inverter link function
221
2.16 Ethernet communication parameters
The following table shows parameters used in common for Ethernet communication protocols. Set the parameters as required.
Initial
Pr. Name Setting range Description
value
442 Default gateway address
0
N620*1*4 1
443 Default gateway address
0
N621*1*4 2
0 to 255 Enter the default gateway address.
444 Default gateway address
0
N622*1*4 3
445 Default gateway address
0
N623*1*4 4
1399 Inverter identification 0 Inverter identification disabled
1
N649*4 enable/disable selection 1 Inverter identification enabled
1427 Ethernet function
5001
N630*1*4 selection 1 502, 5000 to
5002, 5006 to
1428 Ethernet function
45237 5008, 5010 to
N631*1*4 selection 2
5013, 9999 to Set the application, protocol, etc.
1429 Ethernet function
45238 34962*3, 44818*2,
N632*1*4 selection 3 45237, 45238,
1430 Ethernet function 47808*2, 61450
9999
N633*1*4 selection 4
0 Signal loss detection disabled
A warning (EHR) is output for a
1
signal loss.
A warning (EHR) and the Alarm Set the availability of the signal
Ethernet signal loss 2 (LF) signal are output for a signal loss detection and select the
1431
detection function 3 loss. action when Ethernet
N643*5 selection communication is interrupted
A warning (EHR) and the Alarm
(LF) signal are output for a signal by physical factors.
3 loss.
A protective function is activated
for a signal loss.*6*7
1438
Subnet mask 1 255
N610*1*4
1439
Subnet mask 2 255
N611*1*4
0 to 255 Enter the subnet mask of the network to which the inverter belongs.
1440
Subnet mask 3 255
N612*1*4
1441
Subnet mask 4 0
N613*1*4
1455 When no response is returned for an alive check message (Keep
Keepalive time 60 s 1 to 7200 s Alive ACK) for the time (s) set in Pr.1455 multiplied by 8 elapsed,
N642*4 the connection will be forced to be closed.
0 Disabled
1 SNMP enabled
1456 Duplicate IP address detection is enabled when link-up events
Network diagnosis 2
9999 occur.
N647*4*8 selection
SNMP enabled
9999 Duplicate IP address detection is enabled when link-up events
occur.
2
A warning (EHR) and the Alarm
(LF) signal are output for a signal
applied to the operation when
signal loss is detected at
2
loss PORT1, and the setting of
Extended setting for A warning (EHR) and the Alarm Pr.1457 will be applied when
1457 Ethernet signal loss
N648*4*5 detection function
9999
3
(LF) signal are output for a signal
loss.
signal loss is detected at
PORT2.
3
selection
A protective function is activated
for a signal loss.*6*7
8888
When a signal loss is detected for both PORT1 and PORT2, the 4
Pr.1431 setting is applied.
When a signal loss is detected for either PORT1 or PORT2, the
9999
Pr.1431 setting is applied.
1386 Ethernet relay operation
0 0, 9999
Select the relay operation for packets addressed to the other 5
N652*4 at reset selection stations for resetting the inverter connected in line topology.
*1 The setting is applied after an inverter reset or next power-ON.
*2
*3
The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPA and the FR-E800-SCEPA.
The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPB and the FR-E800-SCEPB.
6
*4 The setting is not available for the FR-E800-EPC.
*5 For CC-Link IE TSN communication, a protective function (E.EHR) is activated regardless of the Pr.1431 and Pr.1457 settings when a signal loss
is detected during cyclic communication.
*6 The protective function is not activated while the inverter stops. 7
*7 The operation follows the Pr.502 Stop mode selection at communication error setting. (Refer to page 276.)
*8 When "34962" is set in any of Pr.1427 to Pr.1430, SNMP is disabled regardless of the Pr.1456 setting.
10
* * * . * * * . * * * . * * *
NOTE
• The setting is not available for the FR-E800-EPC.
2. Ethernet Communication
2.16 Ethernet communication parameters
223
Number of connectable
Pr.1427 to Pr.1430 setting*1 Application Protocol
clients
45238 (Pr.1429 initial value) CC-Link IE TSN — No limit
47808*4 BACnet/IP UDP No limit
61450 CC-Link IE Field Network Basic UDP No limit
9999 (Pr.1430 initial value) Unselected
*1 If both application and protocol settings are identical in Pr.1427 to Pr.1430, the priority of the setting is defined as follows: Pr.1427> Pr.1428>
Pr.1429> Pr.1430.
(Example) When Pr.1427 = "5001", Pr.1428 = "5006", Pr.1429 = "5010", and Pr.1430 = "5012", "5001", "5010" and "5012" are valid.
*2 To connect the inverter and FR Configurator2 via the MELSOFT / FA product for Ethernet communication, set "5001 (initial value)" or "5002"
according to the protocol type (UDP or TCP/IP) in any of Pr.1427 to Pr.1430.
*3 When the inverter is connected with other equipment via a hub, and if the communication between the other equipment and the hub is interrupted
and resumed, the communication between the inverter and the other equipment may not be established depending on the specifications of the
hub. To re-establish communication with the other equipment, reset the inverter to forcefully close the connection. (Setting a shorter time in
Pr.1455 Keepalive time is also effective as a preventive measure (refer to page 225).)
*4 The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPA and the FR-E800-SCEPA.
*5 The setting is available only for the FR-E800-EPB and the FR-E800-SCEPB.
NOTE
• The setting is not available for the FR-E800-EPC.
• For details of communication protocols that cannot be used together, refer to page 7.
Operation
LF signal
Pr.1457 setting Description Applicable port panel
output
indication
0 Detection disabled — Not available
1 Warning output EHR Not available
2 Warning and alarm output PORT2 EHR Available
Warning and alarm output EHR Available
3
Protective function activation*1 *2 *2
NOTE 5
• Setting Pr.1457 is not available for the FR-E800-EPC. The operation is the same as the one performed when Pr.1457 =
"9999".
• For CC-Link IE TSN communication, a protective function (E.EHR) is activated regardless of the Pr.1431 and Pr.1457 settings
when a signal loss is detected during cyclic communication. 6
8
Set the value in the second octet in Pr.1439.
Set the value in the third octet in Pr.1440.
Set the value in the fourth octet in Pr.1441.
* * * . * * * . * * * . * * *
9
NOTE
• The setting is not available for the FR-E800-EPC.
10
Keepalive time (Pr.1455)
An alive check message (KeepAlive ACK) is sent to a device if the device does not return any response within the time set in
Pr.1455 Keepalive time while a TCP connection is established. When no response is returned after the seventh transmission,
the connection will be forced to be closed.
Inverter Connected device
Normal communication
Time set
in Pr.1455
KeepAlive ACK (first)
No response
Time set
in Pr.1455
KeepAlive ACK (second)
No response
Time set
in Pr.1455
KeepAlive ACK (seventh)
No response
Time set
in Pr.1455
Timeout
Time (connection close)
2. Ethernet Communication
2.16 Ethernet communication parameters
225
NOTE
• The setting is not available for the FR-E800-EPC.
NOTE
• The setting is not available for the FR-E800-EPC.
• When "34962" is set in any of Pr.1427 to Pr.1430, SNMP is disabled regardless of the Pr.1456 setting.
NOTE
• The setting is not available for the FR-E800-EPC.
• When the setting in Pr.1426 Link speed and duplex mode selection or Pr.1434 to Pr.1437 (IP address) is changed, the
packet relay operation is stopped even when Pr.1386 = "0".
10
227
3 RS-485 Communication
3.1 Outline
RS-485 communication is available for the standard model.
Use the following parameters to perform required settings for RS-485 communication between the inverter and a personal
computer.
• Use the PU connector on the inverter as communication interface.
• The Mitsubishi inverter protocol, MODBUS-RTU protocol, or BACnet MS/TP protocol is used. Parameter setting,
monitoring, etc. can be performed through communication.
• To make communication between the personal computer and inverter, setting of the communication specifications must
be made to the inverter in advance. Data communication cannot be made if the initial settings are not made or if there is
any setting error.
• Position control using point tables is not available for RS-485 communication.
3.2 Wiring
2. Turn OFF the power of the programmable controller and the inverters.
*1 The conversion cable cannot connect multiple inverters. (The computer and inverter are connected in a 1:1 pair.) This is a USB-to-RS485
converter-embedded conversion cable. No additional cable or connector is required. For the product details, contact the manufacturer.
Connection cable
Use Ethernet cables compliant with the following standards.
Ethernet cable Connector Standard
The cables compliant with the following standards:
Category 5e or higher straight cable (double
RJ-45 connector • IEEE 802.3 (1000BASE-T)
shielded/STP)
• ANSI/TIA/EIA-568-B (Category 5e)
Distributor
Use a distributor to connect a terminating resistor to the inverter.
Terminating resistor 3
Prepare a 100 Ω 1/2 W terminating resistor such as the following.
4
Precision
Brown
Brown
Black
5
1 0 1 =100Ω
(10¹)
6
• Connect the terminating resistor between pin No. 3 (RDA) and pin No. 6 (RDB).
• Connect the terminating resistor to only the inverter remotest from the programmable controller.
7
10
3. RS-485 Communication
3.2 Wiring
229
3.3 Wiring of PU connector
Using the PU connector as a computer network port enables communication operation from a personal computer, etc.
When the PU connector is connected with a personal, FA, or other computer by a communication cable, a user program can
run and monitor the inverter or read and write to parameters.
PU connector pin-outs
Inverter
(Receptacle side)
Front view
8 to 1
NOTE
• Pins No. 2 and 8 provide power to the operation panel or parameter unit. Do not use these pins for RS-485 communication.
• Do not connect the PU connector to the computer's LAN board, FAX modem socket, or telephone modular connector. The
product could be damaged due to differences in electrical specifications.
Wiring method
• Connecting one inverter (four-wire type)
Programmable controller
Distributor
Built-in RS-485 Communication
port cable
RDA 5 5 Terminating
RDB 4 4 resistor
SDA 3 3
SDB 6 6
SG 1 1
5 4 3 6 1
Inverter
PU connector S S R R S
D D D D G
A B A B
1
Programmable controller
Distributor Distributor Distributor
Built-in RS-485 Communication
port cable
RDA 5 5 5 5 5 5 Terminating
RDB
SDA
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
resistor
2
SDB 6 6 6 6 6 6
SG 1 1 1 1 1 1
5 4 3 6 1 5 4 3 6 1 5 4 3 6 1
3
Inverter Inverter Inverter
7
5 4 3 6 1
Inverter
PU connector S S R R S
D D D D G
A B A B 8
• Connecting multiple inverters (two-wire type)
Programmable controller
Distributor Distributor Distributor 9
Built-in RS-485 Communication
port cable
RDA 5 5 5 5 5 5 Terminating
RDB 4 4 4 4 4 4 resistor 10
SDA 3 3 3 3 3 3
SDB 6 6 6 6 6 6
SG 1 1 1 1 1 1
5 4 3 6 1 5 4 3 6 1 5 4 3 6 1
3. RS-485 Communication
3.3 Wiring of PU connector
231
3.4 Mitsubishi inverter protocol (computer link
communication)
Parameter setting and monitoring, etc. are possible by using the Mitsubishi inverter protocol (computer link communication) via
the PU connector on the inverter.
To use the Mitsubishi inverter protocol (computer link communication), set "0 (initial value)" in Pr.549 Protocol selection.
Setting
Pr. Name Initial value Description
range
0 Mitsubishi inverter protocol (computer link)
549
Protocol selection 0 1 MODBUS RTU protocol
N000
2 BACnet MS/TP protocol
Specify the inverter station number.
117 PU communication
N020 station number
0 0 to 31*1 Enter the inverter station numbers when two or more inverters are
connected to one personal computer.
48, 96, 192, Select the communication speed.
118 PU communication
192 384, 576, The setting value × 100 equals the communication speed.
N021 speed
768, 1152 For example, enter 192 to set the communication speed of 19200 bps.
PU communication 0 Data length 8 bits
N022 0
data length 1 Data length 7 bits
PU communication 0 Stop bit length 1 bit
N023 1
stop bit length 1 Stop bit length 2 bits
0 Stop bit length 1 bit
PU communication Data length 8 bits
1 Stop bit length 2 bits
119 stop bit length / data 1
10 Stop bit length 1 bit
length Data length 7 bits
11 Stop bit length 2 bits
0 Parity check disabled.
120 PU communication
2 1 Parity check (odd parity) enabled.
N024 parity check
2 Parity check (even parity) enabled.
Set the permissible number of retries for unsuccessful data reception.
0 to 10 If the number of consecutive errors exceeds the permissible value, the
121 PU communication
1 inverter output is shut off.
N025 retry count
The inverter output will not be shut off even when a communication
9999
error occurs.
RS-485 communication is enabled. However, the inverter output is
0 shut off if the operation mode is changed to the one for the selected
command interface.
122 PU communication Set the interval of the communication check (signal loss detection)
0
N026 check time interval 0.1 to 999.8 time
s If a no-communication state persists for longer than the permissible
time, the inverter output will be shut off.
9999 No communication check (signal loss detection)
0 to 150 ms Set the delay between data transmission to the inverter and response.
123 PU communication
9999 The time delay is not set in this parameter but in communication data.
N027 waiting time setting 9999
Delay time: Number set in the data × 10 ms
0 Without CR/LF
124 PU communication CR/
1 1 With CR
N028 LF selection
2 With CR/LF
*1 When a value outside the setting range is set, the inverter operates at the initial value.
NOTE
• Always reset the inverter after making the initial settings of the parameters. After changing the communication-related
parameters, communication cannot be made until the inverter is reset.
Communication specifications
• The communication specifications are shown in the following table.
Item Description Related parameter
Communication protocol Mitsubishi inverter protocol (computer link communication) Pr.549
*1 If a data error is detected and a retry must be made, perform retry operation with the user program. The inverter output is shut off if the number 9
of consecutive retries exceeds the parameter setting.
*2 On receipt of a data error occurrence, the inverter returns reply data (c) to the computer again. The inverter output is shut off if the number of
consecutive data errors reaches or exceeds the parameter setting.
10
Communication operation presence/absence and data format types
• Data communication between the computer and inverter is made in ASCII code (hexadecimal code).
• Communication operation presence/absence and data format types are as follows.
Operation Running Multi Parameter Inverter Parameter
Symbol Operation Monitor
command frequency command write reset read
Communication request is sent to the
a inverter in accordance with the user A, A1 A (A2)*1 *3
A (A2)*2 A B B
program in the computer.
b Inverter data processing time With With With With Without With With
No
E, E1,
error*4 (Request C C *3*6 C C*5 E (E2)*2
Reply data from the E2, E3*1
accepted)
c inverter (Data a is
checked for an error.) With error
(Request D D D D D*5 D D
rejected)
d Computer processing delay time 10 ms or more
No error*4
(No Without Without
Reply from computer in inverter Without Without Without Without Without
(C) (C)
response to reply data c processing)
e
(Data c is checked for With error
error.) (Inverter outputs Without Without Without Without Without F F
c again.)
*1 When Pr.53 = "4" and the data code HFF = 1, the data format is A2 or E2. (Refer to page 239.)
*2 The data writing format is A2 and the data reading format is E2 for Pr.37. (Refer to page 239.)
*3 Refer to page 243 for multi command data formats.
*4 In the communication request data from the computer to the inverter, the time of 10 ms or more is also required after an acknowledgment (ACK)
signal showing "No data error detected" is sent. (Refer to page 237.)
3. RS-485 Communication
3.4 Mitsubishi inverter protocol (computer link communication)
233
*5 Reply from the inverter to the inverter reset request can be selected. (Refer to page 239.)
*6 At mode error and data range error, data on page 243 contains an error code. Except for those errors, the error is returned with data format D.
c. Reply data from the inverter to the computer (Data error detected)
Number of characters
Format
1 2 3 4 5
D NAK*1 Inverter station number*2 Error code *4
c. Reply data from the inverter to the computer (No data error detected)
Number of characters
Format
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
Inverter station
E STX*1 Read data ETX*1 Sum check *4
number*2
Inverter station
E1 STX*1 Read data ETX*1 Sum check *4
number*2
Inverter station
E2 STX*1 Read data ETX*1 Sum check *4
number*2
Number of characters
Format
1 2 3 4 to 23 24 25 26 27
Inverter station
E3 STX*1 Read data (Inverter model information) ETX*1 Sum check *4
number*2
Format
Number of characters 1
1 2 3 4 5
Inverter station Error
D NAK*1 *4
number*2 code
2
e. Transmission data from the computer to the inverter when reading data
Number of characters
Format
1 2 3 4 3
C (No data error *1
Inverter station *4
ACK
detected) number*2
Inverter station
F (Data error
detected) NAK*1
number*2
*4
4
*1 Indicates a control code.
*2 The inverter station number is specified in hexadecimal in the range of H00 to H1F (stations No. 0 to 31).
*3 Set the delay time. When Pr.123 PU communication waiting time setting is set to other than "9999", create the communication request data 5
without "delay time" in the data format. (The number of characters decreases by 1.)
*4 CR+LF code: When a computer transmits data to the inverter, some computers automatically provide either one or both of the codes CR (carriage
return) and LF (line feed) at the end of a data group. In this case, the same setting is required for data sent from the inverter to the computer. Use
Pr.124 PU communication CR/LF selection for the CR+LF code setting. 6
Data definitions
• Control code
Signal name ASCII code Description
7
STX H02 Start Of Text (Start of data)
ETX H03 End Of Text (End of data)
ENQ H05 Enquiry (Communication request) 8
ACK H06 Acknowledge (No data error detected)
LF H0A Line Feed
CR
NAK
H0D
H15
Carriage Return
Negative Acknowledge (Data error detected)
9
• Inverter station number
Specify the station number of the inverter which communicates with the computer.
• Instruction code
10
Specify the processing request, for example, operation or monitoring, given by the computer to the inverter. Therefore, the
operation or monitoring an item is enabled by specifying the corresponding instruction code. (Refer to page 239.)
• Data
Indicates the data such as frequency and parameters transferred to and from the inverter. The definitions and ranges of
set data are determined in accordance with the instruction codes. (Refer to page 239.)
• Time delay
Specify the delay time (time period between the time when the inverter receives data from the computer and the time when
the inverter starts transmission of reply data). Set the delay time in accordance with the response time of the computer in
the range of 0 to 150 ms in 10 ms increments. (For example, "1" for 10 ms or "2" for 20 ms.)
When Pr.123 PU communication waiting time setting is set to other than "9999", create the communication request data
without "delay time" in the data format. (The number of characters decreases by 1.)
Inverter
Computer
*1 When Pr.123 = "9999", the waiting time is the data setting value × 10 ms. When Pr.123 ≠ "9999", the waiting time is the value set in Pr.123.
*2 Approximately 5 to 50 ms. It varies depending on the instruction code.
NOTE
• The data check time varies depending on the instruction code. (Refer to page 237.)
3. RS-485 Communication
3.4 Mitsubishi inverter protocol (computer link communication)
235
• Sum check code
The sum check code is a 2-digit ASCII (hexadecimal) representing the lower 1 byte (8 bits) of the sum derived from the
checked ASCII data.
(Example 1) Sum
*Waiting
Instruction
ENQ Station code Data check
time
Computer Inverter code
number
0 1 E 1 1 0 7 A D F 4 Binary code
ASCII Code H05 H30 H31 H45 H31 H31 H30 H37 H41 H44 H46 H34
H30+H31+H45+H31+H31+H30+H37+H41+H44
= H1F4
Sum
* When Pr.123 PU communication waiting time setting "9999", create the communication
request data without "waiting time" in the data format. (The number of characters decreases by 1.)
(Example 2) Sum
Data read
STX Station ETX
check
Inverter Computer number code
0 1 1 7 7 0 3 0 Binary code
ASCII Code H02 H30 H31 H31 H37 H37 H30 H03 H33 H30
H30+H31+H31+H37+H37+H30
= H130
Sum
• Error code
If any error is found in the data received by the inverter, its error definition is sent back to the computer together with the
NAK code.
Error code Error item Error description Inverter operation
The number of errors consecutively detected in
H0 Computer NAK error communication request data from the computer is greater
than the permissible number of retries.
H1 Parity error The parity check result does not match the specified parity.
The sum check code in the computer does not match that of The inverter output is shut off
H2 Sum check error
the data received by the inverter. (E.PUE) if error occurs
The data received by the inverter has a grammatical mistake. continuously more than the
Or, data receive is not completed within the predetermined permissible number of retries.
H3 Protocol error
time. The CR or LF code specification is not the same as the The LF signal is output.
setting of the parameter.
H4 Framing error The stop bit length differs from the initial setting.
New data has been sent by the computer before the inverter
H5 Overrun error
completes receiving the preceding data.
H6 — — —
The inverter does not accept the
The character received is invalid (other than 0 to 9, A to F,
H7 Character error received data. However, the
control code).
inverter output is not shut off.
H8 — — —
H9 — — —
Parameter write was attempted when the inverter does not
perform computer link communication, when the operation
HA Mode error
commands are not given through communication, or during The inverter does not accept the
inverter operation. received data. However, the
HB Instruction code error The specified instruction code does not exist. inverter output is not shut off.
Invalid data has been specified for parameter writing,
HC Data range error
frequency setting, etc.
HD — — —
HE — — —
HF Normal (no error) — —
Fault (E.PUE)
ENQ
ENQ
NAK
NAK
Inverter Computer
ALM ON
ENQ
ENQ
NAK
NAK
ACK
Inverter Computer
LF OFF ON ON
ALM OFF
3. RS-485 Communication
3.4 Mitsubishi inverter protocol (computer link communication)
237
NOTE
• The operation at a communication error occurrence depends on the setting of Pr.502 Stop mode selection at
communication error. (Refer to page 276.)
Computer Inverter
Inverter Computer
Fault (E.PUE)
Check start
Pr.122
Communication
check counter
Time
ALM OFF ON
Programming instructions
• When data from the computer has any error, the inverter does not accept that data. Hence, in the user program, always
insert a retry program for data error.
• All data communication, for example, run command or monitoring, are started when the computer gives a communication
request. The inverter does not return any data without the computer's request. Hence, design the program so that the
computer gives a data read request for monitoring, etc. as required.
CAUTION
• Always set the communication check time interval before starting operation to prevent hazardous conditions.
• Data communication is not started automatically but is made only once when the computer provides a communication
request. If communication is disabled during operation due to signal cable breakage etc., the inverter cannot be stopped.
When the communication check time interval has elapsed, the inverter output will be shut off (E.PUE). Turn the RES
signal of the inverter ON or shut off the power supply to coast the motor to a stop.
• If communication is broken due to signal cable breakage, computer fault etc., the inverter does not detect such a fault.
This should be fully noted.
Operation
command Write HF9 4 digits (A and C/D)
(extended)
Control input commands such as the Forward rotation command (STF)
Operation
Write HFA signal and the Reverse rotation command (STR) signal can be set. (For 2 digits (A1 and C/D)
command
the details, refer to page 241.)
Operation
command Write HFE 4 digits (A and C/D)
(extended 2)
Inverter status
Read H79 4 digits (B and E/D)
monitor (extended)
Inverter status The states of the output signals such as the Forward rotation output,
Read H7A 2 digits (B and E1/D)
monitor Reverse rotation output, and Inverter running (RUN) signals can be
Inverter status monitored. (For the details, refer to page 242.)
monitor (extended Read H7E 4 digits (B and E/D)
2)
3. RS-485 Communication
3.4 Mitsubishi inverter protocol (computer link communication)
239
Number of data
Read/ Instruction
Item Data description digits
write code
(format)*1
Set frequency Read the set frequency or rotations per minute (machine speed) from the
H6D
(RAM) RAM or EEPROM.
4 digits (B and E (E2)
Read H0000 to HFFFF: Set frequency in 0.01 Hz increments (The display can
Set frequency / D)
H6E be changed to the rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.37 and
(EEPROM) Pr.53. Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
Set frequency Write the set frequency or rotations per minute (machine speed) into the
HED
(RAM) RAM or EEPROM.
H0000 to HE678 (0 to 590.00 Hz): Frequency in 0.01 Hz increments.
(The display can be changed to the rotations per minute (machine speed) 4 digits (A (A2) and
Write
Set frequency using Pr.37 and Pr.53. Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual C/D)
HEE
(RAM, EEPROM) (Function).)
To change the set frequency consecutively, write data to the RAM of the
inverter. (Instruction code: HED)
H9696: Inverter reset
As the inverter is reset at the start of communication by the computer, the 4 digits (A and C/D)
inverter cannot send reply data back to the computer.
Inverter reset Write HFD H9966: Inverter reset
After the computer correctly starts communication and send data to the
4 digits (A and D)
inverter, the inverter returns the ACK signal to the computer before being
reset.
Fault history clear Write HF4 H9696: Fault history is cleared. 4 digits (A and C/D)
All parameters return to initial values.
Whether to clear communication parameters or not can be selected
according to the data.
• Parameter clear
H9696: Parameters including communication parameters are cleared.
H5A5A: Parameters other than communication parameters are
cleared.*3
• All parameter clear
H9966: Parameters including communication parameters are cleared.
Parameter clear /
Write HFC H55AA: Parameters other than communication parameters are 4 digits (A and C/D)
All parameter clear
cleared.*3
For the details of whether or not to clear parameters, refer to the FR-E800
Instruction Manual (Function).
When a clear is performed with H9696 or H9966, communication related
parameter settings also return to the initial values. When resuming the
operation, set the parameters again. Performing a clear will clear the
instruction code HEC, HF3, and HFF settings.
Only H9966 and H55AA (All parameter clear) are valid when a password
is set (refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function)).
Read H00 to H6B Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function) for the instruction 4 digits (B and E/D)
Parameter codes, and write and/or read parameter values as required. When setting
Write H80 to HEB 4 digits (A and C/D)
Pr.100 and later, set the link parameter extended setting.
Read H7F Parameter settings are changed according to the instruction code 2 digits (B and E1/D)
Link parameter settings.
extended setting Write HFF For details of the settings, refer to the instruction code list in the FR-E800 2 digits (A1 and C/D)
Instruction Manual (Function).
Second parameter Read H6C When setting the calibration parameters*4 2 digits (B and E1/D)
changing H00: Frequency*5
(instruction code Write HEC H01: Parameter-set analog value 2 digits (A1 and C/D)
HFF = 1, 9) H02: Analog value input from terminal
Read/ Available for writing 2 commands, and monitoring 2 items for reading data.
Multi command
write
HF0
(Refer to page 243 for details.) 10 digits (*2/D)
H46, H52, H2D, H45, H38, H32, H30, H2D, H31, H20, H20 ... H20
The capacity in the inverter model can be read in ASCII code.
Data is read in increments of 0.1 kW, and rounds down to 0.01 kW
Capacity Read H7D increments. 6 digits (B and E2/D)
"H20" (blank code) is set for blank area.
Example) 0.75K: " 7" (H20, H20, H20, H20, H20, H37)
*1 Refer to page 233 for data formats (A, A1, A2, B, C, D, E, E1, E2, E3, F).
*2 Refer to page 243 for multi command data formats.
*3 Turning OFF the power supply while clearing parameters with H5A5A or H55AA returns the communication parameter settings to the initial
settings.
NOTE
1
• Set 65520 (HFFF0) as a parameter value "8888" and 65535 (HFFFF) as "9999".
• For the instruction codes HFF, HEC, and HF3, their values once written are held, but cleared to zero when an inverter reset
or all clear is performed. 2
• When a 32-bit parameter setting or monitor item is read and the value to be read exceeds HFFFF, HFFFF is returned.
Example) When reading the C3 (Pr.902) and C6 (Pr.904) settings from the inverter of station No. 0. 3
Computer send data Inverter send data Description
a ENQ 00 FF 0 01 7D ACK 00 "H01" is set in the extended link parameter.
b ENQ 00 EC 0 01 79 ACK 00 "H01" is set in the second parameter changing. 4
c ENQ 00 5E 0 0A STX 00 0000 ETX 20 C3 (Pr.902) is read. 0% is read.
d ENQ 00 60 0 F6 STX 00 0000 ETX 20 C6 (Pr.904) is read. 0% is read.
To read/write C3 (Pr.902) or C6 (Pr.904) after inverter reset or parameter clear, execute from (a) again. 5
List of calibration parameters
Pr. Name
Instruction code 6
Read Write Extended
C2 (902) Terminal 2 frequency setting bias frequency 5E DE 1
C3 (902) Terminal 2 frequency setting bias 5E DE 1
125 (903) Terminal 2 frequency setting gain frequency 5F DF 1
7
C4 (903) Terminal 2 frequency setting gain 5F DF 1
C5 (904) Terminal 4 frequency setting bias frequency 60 E0 1
C6 (904) Terminal 4 frequency setting bias 60 E0 1 8
126 (905) Terminal 4 frequency setting gain frequency 61 E1 1
C7 (905) Terminal 4 frequency setting gain 61 E1 1
C38 (932) Terminal 4 bias command (torque/magnetic flux) 20 A0 9
C39 (932) Terminal 4 bias (torque/magnetic flux) 20 A0 9 9
C40 (933) Terminal 4 gain command (torque/magnetic flux) 21 A1 9
C41 (933) Terminal 4 gain (torque/magnetic flux) 21 A1 9
C42 (934) PID display bias coefficient 22 A2 9 10
C43 (934) PID display bias analog value 22 A2 9
C44 (935) PID display gain coefficient 23 A3 9
C45 (935) PID display gain analog value 23 A3 9
Operation command
Instruction Bit
Item Description Example
code length
b0: Terminal 4 input selection
b1: Forward rotation command
b2: Reverse rotation command [Example 1] H02 Forward rotation
b3: RL (Low-speed operation b7 b0
command)*1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
Operation b4: RM (Middle-speed operation
HFA 8 bits
command
command)*1 [Example 2] H00 Stop
b5: RH (High-speed operation b7 b0
command)*1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
b6: Second function selection
b7: MRS (Output stop)*1
3. RS-485 Communication
3.4 Mitsubishi inverter protocol (computer link communication)
241
Instruction Bit
Item Description Example
code length
b0: Terminal 4 input selection
b1: Forward rotation command
b2: Reverse rotation command
b3: RL (Low-speed operation
command)*1 [Example 1] H0002 Forward rotation
b4: RM (Middle-speed operation b15 b0
command)*1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
Operation b5: RH (High-speed operation
command HF9 16 bits [Example 2] H0804 Low-speed reverse operation
(extended) command)*1
(When Pr.184 RES terminal function selection is set to "0")
b6: Second function selection
b7: MRS (Output stop)*1 b15 b0
b8: JOG operation selection 2 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0
b9: —
b10: —
b11: RES (Inverter reset)*1*2
b12 to b15: –
b0: NET X1 (—)*1
b1: NET X2 (—)*1 [Example] H0001 Low-speed operation
Operation (When Pr.185 NET X1 terminal function selection is set to "0")
command HFE 16 bits b2: NET X3 (—)*1
(extended 2) b3: NET X4 (—)*1 b15 b0
*1 The signal within parentheses ( ) is the initial status. The description changes depending on the setting of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output terminal
function selection). For details, refer to the description of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output terminal function selection) in the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).
*2
data type.
Specify the data type of reply data (from inverter to computer). To use the data type 4, specify "4" for both the send data type and the receive
5
data type.
*3 Combination of data 1 and data 2 for sending
5
Operation command
(extended)
Operation command
(extended 2) Operation command (extended) is the same as instruction code HF9.
8
Operation command (Refer to page 241.)
6 Set frequency (RAM)
(extended 2) Operation command (extended 2) is the same as instruction code
HFE. (Refer to page 241.)
7
Operation command
(extended 2)
Set frequency (RAM,
EEPROM)
9
*4 Combination of data 1 and data 2 for reply
*5 The error code for sending data 1 is set in error code 1, and the error code for sending data 2 is set in error code 2. The mode error (HA), instruction
code error (HB), data range error (HC) or no error (HF) is returned. (Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Maintenance) for the details of the
error codes.)
3. RS-485 Communication
3.4 Mitsubishi inverter protocol (computer link communication)
243
3.5 MODBUS RTU
Operation or parameter setting via communication is possible using the MODBUS RTU communication protocol through the
PU connector on the inverter.
To use MODBUS RTU, set "1" in Pr.549 Protocol selection.
Setting
Pr. Name Initial value Description
range
0 Mitsubishi inverter protocol (computer link)
549 *1
Protocol selection 0 1 MODBUS RTU protocol
N000
2 BACnet MS/TP protocol
0 Broadcast communication
117 PU communication Specify the inverter station number.
0
N020 station number 1 to 247 Enter the inverter station numbers when two or more inverters are
connected to one personal computer.
48, 96, 192, Select the communication speed.
118 PU communication
N021 speed
192 384*1, 576, The setting value × 100 equals the communication speed.
768, 1152 For example, enter 96 to set the communication speed of 9600 bps.
PU communication 0 Stop bit length 1 bit
N023 1 Valid when Pr.N024 (Pr.120) = "0"
stop bit length 1 Stop bit length 2 bits
0 Stop bit length 1 bit
PU communication
1 Stop bit length 2 bits
119 stop bit length / data 1 Valid when Pr.120 = "0"
10 Stop bit length 1 bit
length
11 Stop bit length 2 bits
Parity check disabled.
0 Stop bit length selectable between 1 bit and 2 bits (depending on the
setting of Pr.119).
120 PU communication
2 Parity check (odd parity) enabled.
N024 parity check 1
Stop bit length: 1 bit.
Parity check (even parity) enabled.
2
Stop bit length: 1 bit.
RS-485 communication is enabled. However, the inverter output is
0 shut off if the operation mode is changed to the one for the selected
command interface.
122 PU communication Set the interval of the communication check (signal loss detection)
0
N026 check time interval 0.1 to 999.8 time
s If a no-communication state persists for longer than the permissible
time, the inverter output will be shut off.
9999 No communication check (signal loss detection)
343 Communication error Displays the communication error count during MODBUS RTU
0 —
N080 count communication. Read-only.
*1 When Pr.549 = "1 (MODBUS RTU)" and Pr.118 = "384 (38400 bps)", the parameter unit is not available. To use the parameter unit, set a value
other than "384" in Pr.118 and perform an inverter reset.
NOTE
• If MODBUS RTU communication is performed from the master to the address 0 (station number 0), the data is broadcasted,
and the inverter does not send any reply to the master. To obtain replies from the inverter, set Pr.117 PU communication
station number ≠ "0 (initial value)".
• Some functions are disabled in broadcast communication. (Refer to page 246.)
• If a communication option is installed with Pr.550 NET mode operation command source selection = "9999 (initial value)",
commands (operation commands) transmitted through the PU connector become invalid. (Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).)
• Always reset the inverter after making the initial settings of the parameters. After changing the communication-related
parameters, communication cannot be made until the inverter is reset.
Communication specifications
• The communication specifications are shown in the following table.
Item Description Related parameter
Communication protocol MODBUS RTU protocol Pr.549
Communication
Stop bit length Select from the following three types:
No parity check, stop bit length 1 bit / 2 bits (depends on the setting of Pr.119) Pr.119 3
specifications Parity check Odd parity check, stop bit length 1 bit Pr.120
Even parity check, stop bit length 1 bit
Error check CRC code check —
Terminator Not available —
4
Time delay setting Not available —
Outline 5
• The MODBUS communication protocol was developed by Modicon for programmable controllers.
• The MODBUS protocol uses exclusive message frames to perform serial communication between a master and clients.
These exclusive message frames are provided with a feature called "functions" that allows data to be read or written. These
6
functions can be used to read or write parameters from the inverter, write input commands to the inverter or check the
inverter's operating status, for example. This product classifies the data of each inverter into holding register area (register
address 40001 to 49999). The master can communicate with inverters (clients) by accessing pre-assigned holding register
7
addresses.
NOTE
• There are two serial transmission modes, the ASCII (American Standard Code for Information Interchange) mode and the RTU 8
(Remote Terminal Unit) mode. However, this product supports only the RTU mode, which transfers 1 byte data (8 bits) as it
is. Also, only communication protocol is defined by the MODBUS protocol. Physical layers are not stipulated.
9
Message format
Inverter response time
Query communication (Refer to the following table for the
data check time)
10
Query Message
Programmable controller
(Master)
Inverter (client) Response Message
Data absence time
(3.5 bytes or more)
Broadcast communication
Query Message
Programmable controller
(Master)
Inverter (client) No Response
• Query
A message is sent to the client (the inverter) having the address specified by the master.
• Normal Response
After the query from the master is received, the client executes the request function, and returns the corresponding normal
response to the master.
3. RS-485 Communication
3.5 MODBUS RTU
245
• Error Response
When an invalid function code, address or data is received by the client, the error response is returned to the master.
This response is appended with an error code that indicates the reason why the request from the master could not be
executed.
This response cannot be returned for errors, detected by the hardware, frame error and CRC check error.
• Broadcast
The master can broadcast messages to all clients by specifying address 0. All clients that receive a message from the
master execute the requested function. With this type of communication, clients do not return a response to the master.
NOTE
• During broadcast communication, functions are executed regarded of the set inverter station number (Pr.117).
Eight-Bit Eight-Bit
Data Bytes Data Bytes
Message frames comprise the four message fields shown in the figures above.
A client recognizes message data as one message when a 3.5 character long no-data time (T1: start/end) is added before
and after the data.
• Details of protocol
The following table explains the four message fields.
Start Address Function Data CRC check End
L H
T1 8 bits 8 bits n × 8 bits T1
8 bits 8 bits
3. RS-485 Communication
3.5 MODBUS RTU
247
Example) Read the register values of 41004 (Pr.4) to 41006 (Pr.6) from client address 17 (H11).
Query message
Client address Function code Starting address Quantity of registers CRC check
H11 H03 H03 HEB H00 H03 H77 H2B
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
Normal response (Response message)
Client address Function code Byte count Register value CRC check
H11 H03 H06 H17 H70 H0B HB8 H03 HE8 H2C HE6
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
Read value
Register 41004 (Pr.4): H1770 (60.00 Hz)
Register 41005 (Pr.5): H0BB8 (30.00 Hz)
Register 41006 (Pr.6): H03E8 (10.00 Hz)
Example) Write 60 Hz (H1770) to 40014 (set frequency RAM) of client address 5 (H05).
Query message
Client address Function code Register address Register value CRC check
H05 H06 H00 H0D H17 H70 H17 H99
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
Normal response (Response message)
The same data as those in the query message
NOTE
• With broadcast communication, no response is generated even if a query is executed, so when the next query is made, it must
be made after waiting for the inverter data processing time after the previous query is executed.
a. Client address
b. Function
code
c. Sub-function d. Data CRC check 1
H08 H00 H00 H L L H
(8 bits)
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
• Normal response (Response message) 2
b. Function
a. Client address c. Sub-function d. Data CRC check
code
(8 bits)
H08 H00 H00 H L L H 3
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
• Query message setting
Message Description 4
Set the address to send messages to. Broadcast communication is not possible. (Invalid when "0"
a Client address
is set.)
b Function code Set H08.
c Sub-function Set H0000. 5
d Data Any 2-byte long data can be set. The setting range is H0000 to HFFFF.
• Content of normal response
The contents in the normal response (a to d, including the CRC check) are the same as those in the query messages. 6
NOTE
• With broadcast communication, no response is generated even if a query is executed, so when the next query is made, it must
be made after waiting for the inverter data processing time after the previous query is executed.
7
(8 bits)
H10
(8 bits)
H
(8 bits)
L
(8 bits)
H
(8 bits)
L
(8 bits)
(8 bits)
H
(8 bits)
L
(8 bits)
... L
(n × 2 × 8 bits) (8 bits)
H
(8 bits)
10
• Normal response (Response message)
b. Function
a. Client address c. Starting address d. Quantity of registers CRC check
code
H10 H L H L L H
(8 bits)
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
• Query message setting
Message Description
a Client address Set the address to send messages to. Setting "0" enables broadcast communication.
b Function code Set H10.
Set the holding register address from which to start writing the data.
c Starting address Starting address = start register address (decimal) - 40001
For example, when starting address 0001 is set, data is written to holding register 40002.
d Quantity of registers Set the number of holding registers for writing data. Data can be written to up to 125 registers.
e Byte count The setting range is H02 to HFA (2 to 250). Set twice the value specified by d.
Set the amount of data specified by d. Write data is output Hi bytes first followed by Lo bytes, and
f Register value is arranged as follows: data of start address, data of start address+1, data of start address+2, and
so forth.
• Content of normal response
The contents in the normal response (a to d, including the CRC check) are the same as those in the query messages.
3. RS-485 Communication
3.5 MODBUS RTU
249
Example) Write 0.5 s (H05) to 41007 (Pr.7) and 1 s (H0A) to 41008 (Pr.8) of client address 25
(H19).
Query message
Client Function Quantity of
Starting address Byte count Register value CRC check
address code registers
H19 H10 H03 HEE H00 H02 H04 H00 H05 H00 H0A H86 H3D
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
Normal response (Response message)
Client address Function code Starting address Quantity of registers CRC check
H19 H10 H03 HEE H00 H02 H22 H61
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
Example) Read the successful register start address and number of successful accesses from
client address 25 (H19).
Query message
Function
Client address CRC check
code
H19 H46 H8B HD2
(8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits) (8 bits)
The number of holding registers that were successfully accessed was returned as two with the start address 41007 (Pr.7).
NOTE
• No response is also returned in the case of broadcast communication. 2
3. RS-485 Communication
3.5 MODBUS RTU
251
NOTE
• The LF signal can be assigned to an output terminal by setting any of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output terminal function selection).
Changing the terminal assignment may affect other functions. Set parameters after confirming the function of each terminal.
MODBUS register
• The following shows the MODBUS registers for system environment variables (read/write), monitor codes (read),
parameters (read/write), fault history data (read/write), and model information monitor items (read).
• System environment variables
Register Definition Read/write Remarks
40002 Inverter reset Write Any value
40003 Parameter clear Write Set H965A.
40004 All parameter clear Write Set H99AA.
40006 Parameter clear *1 Write Set H5A96.
40007 All parameter clear*1 Write Set HAA99.
40008 Inverter status / control input command Read/write Refer to the following.
(extended)*2
40009 Inverter status / control input command*2 Read/write Refer to the following.
40010 Operation mode / inverter setting *3 Read/write Refer to the following.
40014 Set frequency (RAM value) Read/write (The display can be changed to the rotations per
40015 Set frequency (EEPROM value) Write minute (machine speed) using Pr.37 and Pr.53. Refer
to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
• Inverter status / control input command, and inverter status / control input command (extended)
Definition Definition
Bit Bit
Control input command Inverter status Control input command Inverter status
0 Stop command RUN (Inverter running)*2 0 NET X1 (—)*1 NET Y1 (0)*2
1 Forward rotation command Forward running 1 NET X2 (—)*1 NET Y2 (0)*2
*1
2 Reverse rotation command Reverse running 2 NET X3 (—) NET Y3 (0)*2
RH (High-speed operation
3 Up to frequency 3 NET X4 (—)*1 NET Y4 (0)*2
command)*1
RM (Middle-speed operation
4 Overload alarm 4 NET X5 (—)*1 0
command)*1
RL (Low-speed operation
5 0 5 — 0
command)*1
FU (Output frequency
6 JOG operation selection 2 6 — 0
detection)*2
7 Second function selection ABC (Fault)*2 7 — 0
8 Terminal 4 input selection ABC2 (0) 8 — 0
9 — Safety monitor output 2 9 — 0
10 MRS (Output stop)*1 0 10 — 0
11 — 0 11 — 0
12 RES (Inverter reset)*1 0 12 — 0
13 — 0 13 — 0
14 — 0 14 — 0
15 — Fault occurrence 15 — 0
*1 The signal within parentheses ( ) is the initial status. The description changes depending on the setting of Pr.180 to Pr.189 (Input terminal
function selection).
For details, refer to the description of Pr.180 to Pr.189 (Input terminal function selection) in the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
The signals assigned to the input terminals may be valid or invalid in the NET operation mode. (Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual
(Function).)
*1 Writing is available depending on the Pr.79 and Pr.340 settings. For details, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).
Restrictions in each operation mode conform with the computer link specification. 5
• Monitor code
For details of the register numbers and the monitor items, refer to the description of Pr.52 in the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).
6
• Parameters
Pr. Register Name Read/write Remarks 7
For details on parameter names,
41000 to refer to the parameter list in the FR-
0 to 999 Read/write The parameter number + 41000 is the register number.
41999 E800 Instruction Manual
(Function).
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias
8
C2 (902) 41902 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias
42092 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C3 (902)
C3 (902)
(analog value) 9
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias Analog value (%) of the voltage (current) applied to terminal
43902 Read
(terminal analog value) 2
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain
125 (903) 41903
(frequency)
Read/write
10
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain
42093 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C4 (903)
(analog value)
C4 (903)
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain Analog value (%) of the voltage (current) applied to terminal
43903 Read
(terminal analog value) 2
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias
C5 (904) 41904 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias
42094 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C6 (904)
(analog value)
C6 (904)
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
43904 Read
(terminal analog value) 4
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain
126 (905) 41905 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain
42095 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C7 (905)
(analog value)
C7 (905)
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
43905 Read
(terminal analog value) 4
Terminal 4 bias command (torque/
C38 (932) 41932 Read/write
magnetic flux)
Terminal 4 bias (torque/magnetic
42122 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C39 (932)
flux)
C39 (932)
Terminal 4 bias (torque/magnetic Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
43932 Read
flux) (terminal analog value) 4
Terminal 4 gain command (torque/
C40 (933) 41933 Read/write
magnetic flux)
Terminal 4 gain (torque/magnetic
42123 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C41 (933)
flux)
C41 (933)
Terminal 4 gain (torque/magnetic Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
43933 Read
flux) (terminal analog value) 4
3. RS-485 Communication
3.5 MODBUS RTU
253
Pr. Register Name Read/write Remarks
C42 (934) 41934 PID display bias coefficient Read/write
42124 PID display bias analog value Read/write Analog value (%) set in C43 (934)
C43 (934) PID display bias analog value Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
43934 Read
(terminal analog value) 4
C44 (935) 41935 PID display gain coefficient Read/write
42125 PID display gain analog value Read/write Analog value (%) set in C45 (935)
C45 (935) PID display gain analog value Analog value (%) of the current (voltage) applied to terminal
43935 Read
(terminal analog value) 4
For details on parameter names,
1000 to 45000 to refer to the parameter list in the FR-
Read/write The parameter number + 44000 is the register number.
1999 45999 E800 Instruction Manual
(Function).
• Fault history
Register Definition Read/write Remarks
40501 Fault record 1 Read/write
40502 Fault record 2 Read
40503 Fault record 3 Read
40504 Fault record 4 Read Being 2 bytes in length, the data is stored as H00○○.
Refer to the lowest 1 byte for the error code. (For details on error codes,
40505 Fault record 5 Read
refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Maintenance).)
40506 Fault record 6 Read The fault history is batch-cleared by writing to register 40501.
40507 Fault record 7 Read Set any value as data.
40508 Fault record 8 Read
40509 Fault record 9 Read
40510 Fault record 10 Read
• Product profile
Register Definition Read/write Remarks
44001 Model (1st and 2nd characters) Read
44002 Model (3rd and 4th characters) Read
44003 Model (5th and 6th characters) Read
44004 Model (7th and 8th characters) Read The inverter model can be read in ASCII code.
44005 Model (9th and 10th characters) Read "H20" (blank code) is set for blank area.
44006 Model (11th and 12th characters) Read Example) FR-E820-1:
44007 Model (13th and 14th characters) Read H46, H52, H2D, H45, H38, H32, H30, H2D, H31, H20 ... H20
44008 Model (15th and 16th characters) Read
44009 Model (17th and 18th characters) Read
44010 Model (19th and 20th characters) Read
44011 Capacity (1st and 2nd characters) Read The capacity in the inverter model can be read in ASCII code.
Data is read in increments of 0.1 kW, and rounds down to 0.01 kW
44012 Capacity (3rd and 4th characters) Read
increments.
"H20" (blank code) is set for blank area.
44013 Capacity (5th and 6th characters) Read
Example) 0.75K: " 7" (H20, H20, H20, H20, H20, H37)
NOTE
• When a 32-bit parameter setting or monitor item is read and the value to be read exceeds HFFFF, HFFFF is returned.
• The display can be changed from the frequency to rotations per minute (machine speed) using Pr.53. When the machine
speed is displayed, the value is incremented by one.
NOTE
• The communication error count is temporarily stored in the RAM memory. The value is not stored in the EEPROM, and so is
cleared to 0 when power is reset and the inverter is reset.
Master
Client
Alarm data Alarm data Normal data
Reply data
Alarm data Normal data
Reply data
2
Not increased
Communication
error count 0 1 2
(Pr.343) 3
Signal LF OFF ON OFF ON OFF
NOTE 5
• The LF signal can be assigned to an output terminal by setting Pr.190 to Pr.196. Changing the terminal assignment may affect
other functions. Set parameters after confirming the function of each terminal.
6
Signal loss detection (Pr.122)
• If a signal loss (communication stop) is detected between the inverter and computer as a result of a signal loss detection,
a communication error (E.PUE) occurs and the inverter output will be shut off. 7
• When a signal loss is detected, the LF signal is output.
• When the setting is "9999", communication check (signal loss detection) is not made.
• The monitor items and parameter settings can be read via RS-485 communication when "0" is set, but a communication 8
error (E.PUE) occurs instantly when the operation mode is switched to the one for the selected command interface
(Network operation mode in the initial setting).
• Setting any value from 0.1 second to 999.8 seconds will enable signal loss detection. To make a signal loss detection, it 9
is necessary to send data from the computer within the communication check time interval. (The inverter makes a
communication check (clearing of communication check counter) regardless of the station number setting of the data sent
from the master). 10
• Communication check is started at the initial communication in the operation mode for the selected command interface
(Network operation mode in the initial setting).
Example: Pr.122 = "0.1 to 999.8s"
Computer Inverter
Inverter Computer
Fault (E.PUE)
Check start
Pr.122
Communication
check counter
Time
ALM OFF ON
NOTE
• The operation at a communication error occurrence depends on the setting of Pr.502 Stop mode selection at
communication error. (Refer to page 276.)
3. RS-485 Communication
3.5 MODBUS RTU
255
3.6 BACnet MS/TP
Operation or parameter setting via communication is possible using the BACnet MS/TP protocol through the PU connector on
the inverter.
To use BACnet MS/TP, set "2" in Pr.549 Protocol selection.
Pr. Name Initial value Setting range Description
0, 5 to 14, 17 to 20, 22 to81: BACnet reception status
33, 35, 38, 40 to 42, 44, 82: BACnet token pass counter (Displays the count of
52 Operation panel main 45, 50 to 57, 61, 62, 64, received token)
0
M100 monitor selection 65, 67, 68, 81 to 84, 83: BACnet valid APDU counter (Displays the count of
85*1, 86*2, 91, 97, 100 valid APDU detection)
84: BACnet communication error counter (Displays the
774 Operation panel monitor
count of communication error)
M101 selection 1 1 to 3, 5 to 14, 17 to 20,
85: Terminal FM output level (Same display as Analog
22 to 33, 35, 38, 40 to
775 Operation panel monitor Output 0)
42, 44, 45, 50 to 57, 61, 86: Terminal AM output level (Same display as Analog
M102 selection 2 9999 62, 64, 65, 67, 68, 81 to
Output 1)
84, 85*1, 86*2, 91, 97, The count of the setting values "82" and "83" returns to "0"
776 Operation panel monitor
100, 9999 if the count exceeds "9999". The upper limit of the count of
M103 selection 3
the setting value "84" is "9999".
117 PU communication
N020 station number
0 0 to 127*3 Set the inverter station number (node).
NOTE
• Always reset the inverter after making the initial settings of the parameters. After changing the communication-related
parameters, communication cannot be made until the inverter is reset.
3. RS-485 Communication
3.6 BACnet MS/TP
257
• Setting any value from 0.1 second to 999.8 seconds will enable signal loss detection. To make a signal loss detection, it
is necessary to send data from the computer within the communication check time interval. (The inverter makes a
communication check (clearing of communication check counter) regardless of the station number setting of the data sent
from the master).
• Communication check is started at the initial communication in the operation mode for the selected command interface
(Network operation mode in the initial setting).
Example: Pr.122 = "0.1 to 999.8s"
ENQ
Computer Inverter
Inverter Computer
Fault (E.PUE)
Check start
Pr.122
Communication
check counter
Time
ALM OFF ON
NOTE
• The operation at a communication error occurrence depends on the setting of Pr.502 Stop mode selection at
communication error. (Refer to page 276.)
0.00 Hz
0% 100.00%
NOTE
• The % setting reference frequency cannot be set at less than the minimum frequency resolution of the inverter.
• The set frequency is written to RAM.
• The set frequency is applied at the writing of Speed scale. (The set frequency is not applied at the setting of Pr.390.)
3. RS-485 Communication
3.6 BACnet MS/TP
259
*2 This property is supported only for instances of this object where the Present Value property is commandable.
• ANALOG VALUE
Present value
Object identifier Object name Description Unit
access type*1
Output hertz
1 R Represents the output frequency value.
frequency*2 (27)
amperes
2 Output current R Represents the output current value.
(3)
volts
3 Output voltage R Represents the output voltage value.
(5)
revolution-
6 Running speed*2 R Represents the running speed value. per-minute
(104)
Converter output volts
8 R Represents the converter output voltage value.
voltage (5)
kilowatts
14 Output power R Represents the output power value.
(48)
3. RS-485 Communication
3.6 BACnet MS/TP
261
Present value
Object identifier Object name Description Unit
access type*1
percent
17 Load meter R Represents the load meter value.
(98)
Cumulative hours
20 R Represents the cumulative energization time value.
energization time (71)
Actual operation hours
23 R Represents the actual operation time value.
time (71)
kilowatt-
Cumulative
25 R Represents the cumulative power value. hours
power
(19)
no-units
52 PID set point R Represents the PID set point.
(95)
Represents the PID deviation.
no-units
54 PID deviation R (Minus display is available with reference to 0%, in 0.1%
(95)
increment.)
PID measured no-units
67 R Represents the PID measurement 2.
value2 (95)
no-units
200 Alarm history 1 R Represents the latest fault record (fault record 1).
(95)
no-units
201 Alarm history 2 R Represents the second latest fault (fault record 2).
(95)
no-units
202 Alarm history 3 R Represents the third latest fault (fault record 3).
(95)
no-units
203 Alarm history 4 R Represents the fourth latest fault (fault record 4).
(95)
Controls the ratio of the frequency command. (Setting range: 0.00 percent
300 Speed scale*3 C
to 100.00) (Refer to page 258.) (98)
Set the PID action set point.
• This object is the set point during dancer control if Pr.128 = "40 to
43" and Pr.609 = "4". (Setting range: 0.00 to 100.00)*5
• This object is the set point during PID operation if Pr.128 = "60 or
PID set point 61". (Setting range: 0.00 to 100.00)*4 no-units
310 C
CMD*3 • This object is the set point during PID operation if Pr.128 = "1000 (95)
or 1001" and Pr.609 = "4". (Setting range: 0.00 to 100.00)*4*5
• This object is the set point during PID operation if Pr.128 = "2000
or 2001" (not applied to the frequency) and Pr.609 = "4". (Setting
range: 0.00 to 100.00)*4*5
Set the PID measured value.
• This object is the measured value during dancer control if Pr.128
= "40 to 43" and Pr.610 = "4". (Setting range: 0.00 to 100.00)
• This object is the measured value during PID operation if Pr.128
= "60 or 61". (Setting range: 0.00 to 100.00)*4
PID measured no-units
311 C • This object is the measured value during PID operation if Pr.128
value CMD*3 = "1000 or 1001" and Pr.610 = "4". (Setting range: 0.00 to (95)
100.00)*4
• This object is the measured value during PID operation if Pr.128
= "2000 or 2001" (not applied to the frequency) and Pr.610 = "4".
(Setting range: 0.00 to 100.00)*4
Set the PID deviation. (0.01 increments)
• This object is the deviation during PID operation if Pr.128 = "50 or
51". (Setting range: -100.00 to 100.00)
PID deviation • This object is the deviation during PID operation if Pr.128 = "1010 percent
312 C
CMD*3 or 1011" and Pr.609 = "4". (Setting range: -100.00 to 100.00) (98)
• This object is the deviation during PID operation if Pr.128 = "2010
or 2011" (not applied to the frequency) and Pr.609 = "4". (Setting
range: -100.00 to 100.00)
Mailbox no-units
398 W
parameter Access to the properties which are not defined as objects are (95)
available. (Refer to page 264.) no-units
399 Mailbox value W
(95)
seconds
10007 Acceleration time W Set Pr.7 Acceleration time.
(73)
seconds
10008 Deceleration time W Set Pr.8 Deceleration time.
(73)
*5
setting, the writing value and the reading value may not be the same at the minimum digit.
When Pr.133 ≠ "9999", the Pr.133 setting is valid.
2
• BINARY INPUT
Present value Description
3
Object identifier Object name
access type*1 (0: inactive, 1: active)
0 Terminal STF R Represents actual input of terminal STF.
1 Terminal STR R Represents actual input of terminal STR. 4
4 Terminal RL R Represents actual input of terminal RL.
5 Terminal RM R Represents actual input of terminal RM.
6 Terminal RH R Represents actual input of terminal RH.
8 Terminal MRS R Represents actual input of terminal MRS. 5
10 Terminal RES R Represents actual input of terminal RES.
100 Terminal RUN R Represents actual output of terminal RUN.
104 Terminal FU R Represents actual output of terminal FU. 6
105 Terminal ABC R Represents actual output of terminals A, B, and C.
107 Terminal SO R Represents actual output of terminal SO.
*1 R: Read only, W: Read/Write (Commandable values not supported), C: Read/Write (Commandable values supported)
7
• BINARY OUTPUT
Present value Description
Object identifier Object name
access type*1 (0: inactive, 1: active) 8
Represents actual output of terminal RUN.
0 Terminal RUN CMD C Control is available when Pr.190 RUN terminal function selection = "82
or 182"*2. 9
Controls actual output of terminal FU.
4 Terminal FU CMD C Control is available when Pr.191 FU terminal function selection = "82 or
182"*2.
Controls actual output of terminals A, B, and C. 10
5 Terminal ABC CMD C Control is available when Pr.192 ABC terminal function selection = "82
or 182"*2.
*1 R: Read only, W: Read/Write (Commandable values not supported), C: Read/Write (Commandable values supported)
Values written to the objects that support the commandable values are stored in the Priority Array, even when "Write Access Denied" is returned
due to inconsistency of the writing requirements such as the operating mode, on condition that the values are written within the setting range.
*2 Available regardless of the operation mode, operation command source, and speed command source.
3. RS-485 Communication
3.6 BACnet MS/TP
263
• BINARY VALUE
Present value
Object identifier Object name Description
access type*1
0 Inverter running R Represents the Inverter running (RUN) signal status.
Inverter operation
11 R Represents the Inverter operation ready (RY) signal status.
ready
98 Alarm output R Represents the Alarm (LF) signal status.
99 Fault output R Represents the Fault (ALM) signal status.
Inverter running
200 R Represents inverter reverse running status.
reverse
Controls the function assigned to terminal RL.
Control input
302 C Setting 1 in this object turns ON the signal assigned to Pr.180 RL terminal
instruction RL
function selection.
Controls the function assigned to terminal RM.
Control input
303 C Setting 1 in this object turns ON the signal assigned to Pr.181 RM terminal
instruction RM
function selection.
Controls the function assigned to terminal RH.
Control input
304 C Setting 1 in this object turns ON the signal assigned to Pr.182 RH terminal
instruction RH
function selection.
Controls the function assigned to terminal MRS.
Control input
306 C Setting 1 in this object turns ON the signal assigned to Pr.183 MRS
instruction MRS
terminal function selection.
Control input Controls the function assigned to terminal RES.
308 C Setting 1 in this object turns ON the signal assigned to Pr.184 RES terminal
instruction RES*2 function selection.
Controls the start/stop command. The start command is written after the
• DEVICE
Object identifier Object name Description
0 to 4194302 Reads the device status or changes the setting.
Model information # device instance number
4194303*1 Device instance number: Pr.728 × 10000 + Pr.729
• NETWORK PORT
Object identifier Object name Description
0 BACnetMSTP on EIA-485 Reads the status of the PU connector or changes the setting.
4194303*1 Access is attempted as the object identifier of the port which receives the request.
*1 Available only for Read Property Service.
*1 Writing is available depending on the Pr.79 and Pr.340 settings. For details, refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function). 5
Restrictions in each operation mode conform with the computer link specification.
• Monitor code
6
For details of the register numbers and the monitor items, refer to the description of Pr.52 in the FR-E800 Instruction
Manual (Function).
• Parameter
7
Pr. Register Name Read/write Remarks
For details on parameter names,
refer to the parameter list in the FR- The parameter number + 41000 is the
0 to 999 41000 to 41999
E800 Instruction Manual
Read/write
register number. 8
(Function).
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias
C2 (902) 41902 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias 9
42092 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C3 (902)
(analog value)
C3 (902)
Terminal 2 frequency setting bias Analog value (%) of the voltage (current)
43902 Read
(terminal analog value) applied to terminal 2
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain
10
125 (903) 41903 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain
42093 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C4 (903)
(analog value)
C4 (903)
Terminal 2 frequency setting gain Analog value (%) of the voltage (current)
43903 Read
(terminal analog value) applied to terminal 2
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias
C5 (904) 41904 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias
42094 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C6 (904)
(analog value)
C6 (904)
Terminal 4 frequency setting bias Analog value (%) of the current (voltage)
43904 Read
(terminal analog value) applied to terminal 4
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain
126 (905) 41905 Read/write
(frequency)
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain
42095 Read/write Analog value (%) set in C7 (905)
(analog value)
C7 (905)
Terminal 4 frequency setting gain Analog value (%) of the current (voltage)
43905 Read
(terminal analog value) applied to terminal 4
C38 (932) 41932 Terminal 4 bias command (torque) Read/write
42122 Terminal 4 bias (torque) Read/write Analog value (%) set in C39 (932)
C39 (932) Terminal 4 bias (torque) (terminal Analog value (%) of the current (voltage)
43932 Read
analog value) applied to terminal 4
C40 (933) 41933 Terminal 4 gain command (torque) Read/write
42123 Terminal 4 gain (torque) Read/write Analog value (%) set in C41 (933)
C41 (933) Terminal 4 gain (torque) (terminal Analog value (%) of the current (voltage)
43933 Read
analog value) applied to terminal 4
C42 (934) 41934 PID display bias coefficient Read/write
3. RS-485 Communication
3.6 BACnet MS/TP
265
Pr. Register Name Read/write Remarks
42124 PID display bias analog value Read/write Analog value (%) set in C43 (934)
C43 (934) PID display bias analog value Analog value (%) of the current (voltage)
43934 Read
(terminal analog value) applied to terminal 4
C44 (935) 41935 PID display gain coefficient Read/write
42125 PID display gain analog value Read/write Analog value (%) set in C45 (935)
C45 (935) PID display gain analog value Analog value (%) of the current (voltage)
43935 Read
(terminal analog value) applied to terminal 4
For details on parameter names,
refer to the parameter list in the FR- The parameter number + 44000 is the
1000 to 1999 45000 to 45999 Read/write
E800 Instruction Manual register number.
(Function).
• Fault history
Register Definition Read/write Remarks
40501 Fault record 1 Read/write
40502 Fault record 2 Read
40503 Fault record 3 Read Being 2 bytes in length, the data is stored as H00○○.
40504 Fault record 4 Read Refer to the lowest 1 byte for the error code. (For details on
error codes, refer to the list of fault displays in the FR-E800
40505 Fault record 5 Read
Instruction Manual (Maintenance).)
40506 Fault record 6 Read The fault history is batch-cleared by writing to register
40507 Fault record 7 Read 40501.
40508 Fault record 8 Read Set any value as data.
40509 Fault record 9 Read
40510 Fault record 10 Read
• Product profile
Register Definition Read/write Remarks
44001 Model (1st and 2nd characters) Read
44002 Model (3rd and 4th characters) Read
44003 Model (5th and 6th characters) Read
44004 Model (7th and 8th characters) Read The model name can be read in ASCII code.
44005 Model (9th and 10th characters) Read "H20" (blank code) is set for blank area.
44006 Model (11th and 12th characters) Read Example) FR-E840-1 (FM type):
44007 Model (13th and 14th characters) Read H46, H52, H2D, H45, H38, H34, H30, H2D, H31, H20 ... H20
44008 Model (15th and 16th characters) Read
44009 Model (17th and 18th characters) Read
44010 Model (19th and 20th characters) Read
44011 Capacity (1st and 2nd characters) Read The inverter capacity can be read in ASCII code.
44012 Capacity (3rd and 4th characters) Read Data read is displayed in increments of 0.1 kW (rounded
down to one decimal place).
44013 Capacity (5th and 6th characters) Read "H20" (blank code) is set for blank area.
Example) 0.75K: " 7" (H20, H20, H20, H20, H20, H37)
NOTE
• When a 32-bit parameter setting or monitor item is read and the value to be read exceeds HFFFF, HFFFF is returned.
2
BACnet Protocol Implementation Conformance Statement
Date: 1st Sep 2021
Vendor Name: Mitsubishi Electric Corporation
Product Name: Inverter
3
Product Model Number: (FR-E800 series)
Application Software Version: 8650F
Firmware Revision: 1.00
4
BACnet Protocol Revision: 19
Product Description:
5
6
BACnet Standardized Device Profile (Annex L):
BACnet Cross-Domain Advanced Operator Workstation (B-XAWS) 7
BACnet Advanced Operator Workstation (B-AWS)
BACnet Operator Workstation (B-OWS)
BACnet Operator Display (B-OD) 8
BACnet Advanced Life Safety Workstation (B-ALSWS)
BACnet Life Safety Workstation (B-LSWS)
BACnet Life Safety Annunciator Panel (B-LSAP) 9
BACnet Advanced Access Control Workstation (B-AACWS)
BACnet Access Control Workstation (B-ACWS)
BACnet Access Control Security Display (B-ACSD)
10
BACnet Building Controller (B-BC)
BACnet Advanced Application Controller (B-AAC)
BACnet Application Specific Controller (B-ASC)
BACnet Smart Sensor (B-SS)
BACnet Smart Actuator (B-SA)
BACnet Advanced Life Safety Controller (B-ALSC)
BACnet Life Safety Controller (B-LSC)
BACnet Advanced Access Control Controller (B-AACC)
BACnet Access Control Controller (B-ACC)
BACnet Router (B-RTR)
BACnet Gateway (B-GW)
BACnet Broadcast Management Device (B-BBMD)
BACnet Access Control Door Controller (B-ACDC)
BACnet Access Control Credential Reader (B-ACCR)
BACnet General (B-GENERAL)
3. RS-485 Communication
3.6 BACnet MS/TP
267
List all BACnet Interoperability Building Blocks Supported (Annex K):
DS-RP-B, DS-WP-B, DM-DDB-B, DM-DOB-B, DM-DCC-B , DM-RD-B
Segmentation Capability:
1. Whether objects of this type are dynamically creatable using the CreateObject service
2. Whether objects of this type are dynamically deletable using the DeleteObject service
4. List of all properties that are writable where not otherwise required by this standard
5. List of all properties that are conditionally writable where not otherwise required by this standard
6. List of proprietary properties and for each its property identifier, datatype, and meaning
To check the object types supported by the FR-E800 series, refer to page 261.
Networking Options:
Router, Clause 6 - List all routing configurations, e.g., ARCNET-Ethernet, Ethernet-MS/TP, etc.
Annex H, BACnet Tunneling Router over IP
4
If this product is a communication gateway which presents a network of virtual BACnet devices, a separate PICS shall be
provided that describes the functionality of the virtual BACnet devices. That PICS shall describe a superset of the functionality
of all types of virtual BACnet devices that can be presented by the gateway. 5
Network Security Options:
Non-secure Device - is capable of operating without BACnet Network Security 6
Secure Device - is capable of using BACnet Network Security (NS-SD BIBB)
Multiple Application-Specific Keys
Supports encryption (NS-ED BIBB) 7
Key Server (NS-KS BIBB)
10
3. RS-485 Communication
3.6 BACnet MS/TP
269
MEMO
10
271
4 Other Communication Options
Initial
Pr. Name Setting range Description
value
547 USB communication
0 0 to 31 Specify the inverter station number.
N040*1 station number
USB communication is possible, however the inverter output is shut
0
off (E.USB) when the mode changes to the PU operation mode.
548 USB communication Set the communication check time interval.
9999
N041*1 check time interval 0.1 to 999.8 s If a no-communication state persists for longer than the permissible
time, the inverter output is shut off (E.USB).
9999 No communication check
*1 The changed value is applied after the next power-ON or inverter reset.
*1 USB bus power connection is available. The maximum SCCR is 500 mA. A PU connector cannot be used during USB bus power connection.
• At the initial setting (Pr.551 PU mode operation command source selection = "9999"), communication with FR
Configurator2 can be made in the PU operation mode simply by connecting a USB cable. To fix the command source to
the USB connector in the PU operation mode, set "3" in Pr.551.
• Parameter setting and monitoring can be performed by using FR Configurator2. For details, refer to the Instruction Manual
of FR Configurator2.
NOTE
• Operation is not guaranteed when multiple inverters are connected using a USB hub.
When the automatic connection is enabled in the GOT2000 series, the inverter can communicate with the GOT2000 series
with only setting the station number and connecting the GOT. This eliminates the need for setting each communication 2
parameter separately.
GOT2000
Terminating resistor 6
8
GOT2000 series automatic recognition
• Set the station number (Pr.117) of the inverter before the automatic recognition is performed. 9
• When the GOT2000 series is connected, the parameters required for the GOT connection are automatically changed by
setting the automatic recognition on the GOT2000 series side.
• Connect all the stations of inverters with GOT before the automatic recognition is performed. The inverter newly added 10
after automatic recognition will not be recognized automatically. (When an inverter is added, perform the initial setting in
Pr.999 Automatic parameter setting or set the automatic recognition on the GOT side again.)
Automatic change
Automatic change item Setting value after change
parameter
Communication speed Pr.118
Data length / stop bit Pr.119
Depending on the setting of the connected
Parity Pr.120
device on the GOT side.
Time delay setting Pr.123
CR/LF selection Pr.124
Number of communication
Pr.121 9999 (fixed)
retries
Communication check time
Pr.122 9999 (fixed)
interval
Protocol selection Pr.549 0 (fixed to Mitsubishi inverter protocol)
NOTE
• If the automatic recognition cannot be performed, initial setting in Pr.999 is required.
• For connection to a device other than the GOT2000 series, initial setting in Pr.999 is required.
• For details, refer to the GOT2000 Series Connection Manual (Mitsubishi Product).
10
275
5 Common Settings
Set the action when the inverter is performing operation via communication.
Set the action at fault occurrence or at reading/writing of parameters.
Initial Setting
Pr. Name Description
value range
Parameter values written by communication are written to the EEPROM and
RAM.
0
Communication When the index of inverter parameter is read via Ethernet communication
342
EEPROM write 0 (acyclic communication), the EEPROM value is read.
N001
selection Parameter values written by communication are written to the RAM.
1 When the index of inverter parameter is read via Ethernet communication
(acyclic communication), the RAM value is read.
349 Communication reset 0 Enables the error reset function in any operation mode.
0
N010*1 selection 1 Error reset is enabled in the Network operation mode.
500 Set the time from when the communication line error occurs until the inverter
Communication error
0 0 to 999.8 s starts the operation for the communication error (when a communication
N011*1 execution waiting time
option is used).
NOTE
• Turning OFF the inverter's power supply clears the modified parameter settings when Pr.342 = "1 (write only to RAM)".
Therefore, the parameter values at next power-ON are the values last stored in the EEPROM.
• The parameter setting written in the RAM cannot be checked on the operation panel. (The values displayed on the operation
panel are the ones stored in the EEPROM.)
Pr.779.*2*3 4
0 Output shutoff "E. 1" ON
Output to Output stop status
"E. 1" ON
Option fault (when
1, 2 decelerate and
stop the motor.
"E. 1" after stop ON after stop continues.
5
a communication
Operation Operation
option is used)
continues at the continues at the
6 "CF" warning OFF "CF" warning OFF
frequency set in
Pr.779.*2*3
frequency set in
Pr.779.
6
*1 When the communication error is removed during deceleration, the motor re-accelerates. During position control, the motor does not re-accelerate
even when the communication error is removed during deceleration.
*2 When the frequency command interface is switched to the one other than NET during operation, the frequency command given from an external
device can be made valid.
7
During position control, the operation is continued to the target position. When the communication operation command source is changed to the
External mode and the LX signal is not input via an external input terminal, the inverter output is shut off.
*3 During torque control, the Pr.779 setting becomes invalid when Pr.807 Speed limit selection = "1". In this case, operation continues at the
frequency set in Pr.808 Speed limit or Pr.809 Reverse-side speed limit.
8
• When a communication error is detected during communication through the PU connector or a communication option, the
Alarm (LF) signal is output to an output terminal of the inverter. (When an option fault occurs, the LF signal is output only 9
when "6" is set in Pr.502.)
• When a communication error is detected during communication via the Ethernet connector while Pr.1431 Ethernet signal
loss detection function selection = "2 or 3", the Alarm (LF) signal is output to an output terminal of the inverter. 10
NOTE
• To use the LF signal, set "98 (positive logic) or 198 (negative logic)" in any of Pr.190 to Pr.196 (Output terminal function
selection) to assign the function to the output terminal.
5. Common Settings
277
• The following charts show operations when a communication line error occurs.
Pr.502 = "0" (initial value) Pr.502 = "1"
Fault occurrence Fault removal Fault occurrence Fault removal
NOTE
• When the Pr.1431 setting is changed to a value other than "3" and the Pr.1457 setting is changed to a value other than "9999"
after the operation defined by the Pr.502 setting starts during Ethernet communication, the operation will be changed
according to the settings of Pr.1431 and Pr.1457.
• When the switchover mode (Pr.79 Operation mode selection = "6") is set, the operation can be switched between NET and
External during operation using the External/NET operation switchover (X66) signal. (Refer to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual
(Function).)
Motor coasting 2
Output frequency
Output frequency
Decelerates to stop
3
Time Fault display Time
Fault display
(E.1)
Fault output
Display (E.1)
Fault output
Display 4
(ALM) OFF ON (ALM) OFF ON
Alarm output Alarm output
5
(LF) OFF (LF) OFF
6
Fault OFF ON OFF
Pr.779 = “9999”
Output frequency
Pr.779
7
Pr.779 ≠“9999”
(Runs at the frequency setting of Pr.779)
Warning
display
Time 8
(CF) Display
Fault output
OFF
9
(ALM)
Alarm output
(LF) OFF ON
NOTE
• When a communication option is used, the protective function [E.OP1 (fault data: HA1)] is activated at error occurrences on
10
the communication line. The protective function [E.1 (fault data: HF1)] is activated at error occurrences in the communication
circuit inside the option.
• Fault output indicates the Fault (ALM) signal and an alarm bit output.
• When the fault output is set enabled, fault records are stored in the fault history. (A fault record is written to the fault history at
a fault output.)
• When the fault output is not enabled, a fault record is overwritten to the fault history temporarily but not stored.
• After the fault is removed, the fault indication goes back to normal indication on the monitor, and the fault history goes back to
the previous status.
• When Pr.502 = "1 or 2", the normal deceleration time setting (settings like Pr.8, Pr.44, and Pr.45) is applied as the deceleration
time. The Pr.464 or Pr.1223 deceleration time setting, whichever is smaller, is applied for position control.
• If a communication line error occurs, then the error is removed during deceleration while Pr.502 = "2", the motor re-accelerates
from that point. (During position control, the motor does not re-accelerate even when the communication error is removed
during deceleration.) The operation command and the speed command before the fault occurred will be applied for restarting.
The normal acceleration time setting (such as Pr.7/Pr.44 setting) is applied for restart. (Acceleration does not restart when a
communication option fault occurs.)
• The Pr.502 and Pr.779 settings are valid when communication is performed via the PU connector, Ethernet connector, or a
communication option.
• These parameters are valid under the Network operation mode. When performing communication through the PU connector,
set Pr.551 PU mode operation command source selection ≠ "2".
• Pr.502 is valid for the device that has the command source under the Network operation mode. When an error occurs for
communication through the PU connector or the Ethernet connector while Pr.550 = "9999 (initial value)" and a communication
option is installed, Pr.502 becomes invalid.
• If the communication error setting is disabled with Pr.121 = "9999" or Pr.122 = "9999" while Pr.502 = "6", the inverter does not
operate with the frequency set in Pr.779 when a communication error occurs.
5. Common Settings
279
CAUTION
• When Pr.502 = "6" and a communication line error (PU disconnection, Ethernet communication fault, communication
option fault) occurs, or a communication option fault occurs, the operation continues. When setting "6" in Pr.502, provide
a safety stop countermeasure other than via communication. For example, input a signal through an external terminal
(RES, MRS, or X92) or press the PU stop on the operation panel.
Waiting time setting from the communication line error occurrence to the
communication error activation (Pr.500)
• When a communication option is used, use Pr.500 Communication error execution waiting time to set the time from
when the communication line error occurs until the inverter starts the operation for the communication error.
• When a communication line error occurs and lasts longer than the time set in Pr.500, it is recognized as a communication
error. If the communication returns to normal within the time, it is not recognized as a communication error, and the
operation continues.
Normal Error Normal Error
Communication line status
*1 When the communication returns to normal within the time period set in Pr.500, the protective function (E.OP1) is not activated.
*2 When the frequency command interface is switched to the one other than NET during operation, the frequency command given from an external
device can be made valid.
During position control, the operation is continued to the target position. When the communication operation command source is changed to the
External mode and the LX signal is not input via an external input terminal, the inverter output is shut off.
*3 During torque control, the Pr.779 setting becomes invalid when Pr.807 Speed limit selection = "1". In this case, operation continues at the
frequency set in Pr.808 Speed limit or Pr.809 Reverse-side speed limit.
2
Error reset operation selection at inverter fault (Pr.349)
• An error reset command from a communication option can be invalidated in the External operation mode or the PU
operation mode. 3
Pr.349 setting Description
0 (initial value) Error reset is enabled independently of operation mode.
1 Error reset is enabled in the Network operation mode. 4
Operation mode switching and communication startup mode (Pr.79,
Pr.340) 5
• Check the following before switching the operation mode.
The inverter is at a stop.
Both the STF and STR signals are off. 6
The Pr.79 Operation mode selection setting is correct. (Check the setting on the operation panel of the inverter.) (Refer
to the FR-E800 Instruction Manual (Function).)
• The operation mode at power ON and at restoration from instantaneous power failure can be selected. Set a value other 7
than "0" in Pr.340 Communication startup mode selection to select the Network operation mode. (Refer to the FR-E800
Instruction Manual (Function).)
• After the inverter starts up in the Network operation mode, parameter write can be commanded via the network. 8
NOTE
• The changed value in Pr.340 is applied after the next power-ON or inverter reset.
• The Pr.340 setting can be changed on the operation panel in any operation mode. 9
• When setting a value other than "0" in Pr.340, make sure that the communication settings of the inverter are correct.
10
5. Common Settings
281
MEMO
10
283
6 Appendix
Appendix provides the reference information for use of this product.
Refer to the information as required.
284 6. Appendix
6.1 How to check specification changes
Functions available for the inverters manufactured in August 2020 or
later
1
• Firmware version: 2 or later
Item Details 2
The SF-V5RU 1.5 to 5.5 kW motors can be driven by the FR-E820-0110(2.2K) to 0330(7.5K)
Mitsubishi Electric vector control dedicated inverters.
motor (SF-V5RU (1500 r/min series)) The SF-V5RUH 1.5 to 5.5 kW motors can be driven by the FR-E840-0060(2.2K) to 0170(7.5K)
inverters. 3
Mitsubishi Electric high-performance
SF-PR-SC
energy-saving motor with encoder
Mitsubishi Electric inverter-driven geared
motor for encoder feedback control
GM-DZ, GM-DP
4
Plug-in option FR-A8AP E kit
Access to the parameters, monitor data, and terminals is available.
Inverter Configuration Object (64h)
EtherNet/IP communication specifications • Inverter Parameters (12288 to 16383) 5
• Monitor Data (16384 to 20479)
• Inverter Control Parameters (20480 to 24575)
Access to the parameters, monitor data, and terminals is available.
PROFINET communication specifications
• Inverter Parameters (12288 to 16383) 6
• Monitor Data (16384 to 20479)
• Inverter Control Parameters (20480 to 24575)
Pr.284, Pr.359, Pr.367, Pr.368, Pr.369, Pr.376, Pr.422, Pr.552, Pr.600 to Pr.604, Pr.607,
Added parameters Pr.608, Pr.690, Pr.692 to Pr.696, Pr.802, Pr.823, Pr.828, Pr.833, Pr.840 to Pr.848, Pr.854, 7
Pr.873, Pr.877 to Pr.881, P.A107 (Pr.285)
• Setting value "8888" added for Pr.11
• Setting values "19 and 35" added for Pr.52, Pr.774 to Pr.776, Pr.992, and Pr.1027 to Pr.1034
• Setting values "30 and 33" added for Pr.71 and Pr.450 8
• Setting values "13, 23, 42, 43, and 74" added for Pr.178 to Pr.189
Changed parameter setting range • Setting values "30 to 33, and 130 to 133" added for Pr.190 to Pr.196, and Pr.313 to Pr.319
• Setting values "30 to 33" added for Pr.320 to Pr.322
•
•
Setting values "0 to 2, and 9" added for Pr.800
Setting value "2" added for Pr.850
9
• Setting value "6" added for Pr.858
• Signal loss detection (E.ECT)
Added fault signals
• Brake sequence fault (E.MB1 to E.MB3)
10
6. Appendix
6.1 How to check specification changes
285
Functions available for the inverters manufactured in January 2021 or
later
• Firmware version: 3 or later
Item Details Related manuals
Position control (Vector control) is supported for induction motors.
• The following parameters are added: Pr.420, Pr.421, Pr.423, Pr.425 to Pr.427,
Pr.430, Pr.446, Pr.464 to Pr.478, Pr.510, Pr.511, Pr.538, Pr.698, Pr.1222, Pr.1223,
Pr.1225 to Pr.1227, Pr.1229 to Pr.1231, Pr.1233 to Pr.1235, Pr.1237 to Pr.1239,
Pr.1241 to Pr.1243, Pr.1245 to Pr.1247, Pr.1249, Pr.1282, Pr.1283, Pr.1285,
Pr.1286, Pr.1289, Pr.1290, Pr.1292 to Pr.1297.
Position control is available.
• Setting values "3 to 5" added for Pr.800
Signals for position control can be assigned to I/O terminals.
Connection/
• Setting values "76, and 87 to 89" added for Pr.178 to Pr.189
Function/
Position control (Vector control) • Setting values "24, 36, 38, 56, 60 to 63, 84, 124, 136, 138, 156, 160 to 163, and 184"
Communication/
added for Pr.190 to Pr.196 and Pr.313 to Pr.319
Maintenance
• Setting values "24, 36, 38, 56, 60 to 63, and 84" added for Pr.320 to Pr.322
Monitoring during position control is available (multifunction monitor).
• Setting values "26 to 31, and 65" added for Pr.52, Pr.774 to Pr.776, and Pr.992
• Setting value "65" added for Pr.54 and Pr.158
• Setting values "65, 222 to 227, and 229" added for Pr.1027 to Pr.1034
The following warnings are added: LP (Stroke limit warning), HP1 (Home position
return setting error), and HP2 (Home position return uncompleted)
The following faults are added: E.OD (Excessive position fault) and E.OA (acceleration
error).
CC-Link IE TSN communication User defined cyclic communication is supported. Function/
specifications • Setting values "38 and 138" of Pr.544 are available for remote registers. Communication
User defined cyclic communication is supported.
EtherNet/IP communication
• "Configurable" is added for the connections of Class 1 communication (I/O Message Communication
specifications
communication) (Instances 100 and 150).
PROFINET communication User defined cyclic communication is supported.
Communication
specifications • Telegram 102 is added for Process Data (Cyclic Data Exchange).
MODBUS/TCP communication CiA402 drive profile (24642 to 24644, 24646, 24648, 24649, and 26623) is added for
Communication
specifications MODBUS registers.
Motor overheat protection by the motor's built-in PTC thermistor is supported.
• Pr.561 and Pr.1016 are added. Connection/
PTC thermistor • Setting value "64" of Pr.52, Pr.774 to Pr.776, Pr.992, Pr.1027 to Pr.1034 is available Function/
(multifunction monitor). Maintenance
• E.PTC (PTC thermistor operation) is added.
Inverter parameters and the data used in the PLC function of inverter can be backed
Communication/
Backup/Restoration function up and restored.
Maintenance
• RD (Backup in progress) and WR (Restoration in progress) indications are added.
Increased magnetic excitation The function is available.
Function
deceleration • Pr.660 to Pr.662 are added.
Optimum excitation control The control can be enabled under Advanced magnetic flux vector control. Function
PLC Function
PLC function The structured text (ST) language is supported, and the jump command is supported. Programming
Manual
Connection/
200 V class: 11K to 22K are added. Function/
Capacity
400 V class: 11K to 22K are added. Communication/
Maintenance
Pr.375 added
Function/
Parameters User Defined Cyclic Communication Input/Output Mapping parameters (Pr.1318 to
Communication
Pr.1343) added
286 6. Appendix
6.1 How to check specification changes
Functions available for the inverters manufactured in May 2021 or later
• Firmware version: 5 or later
1
Item Details Related manuals
Applied motor setting
• Setting values "540 and 1140" (200 V class) added for Pr.71 and Pr.450 2
Connection/
PM motor (MM-GKR 0.4kW and Parameter initial setting
Function/
0.75kW, and EM-A 5.5kW and • Setting values "3024, 3044, 3124, and 3144" (200 V class) added for Pr.998
Communication/
7.5kW) Position control (Vector control) is supported for PM motors (MM-GKR and EM-A).
Control mode setting
Maintenance 3
• Setting values "13 and 14" added for Pr.451 and Pr.800
Added parameters
• Pr.350 to Pr.358, Pr.361 to Pr.366, Pr.393, Pr.396 to Pr.399
Setting values
4
• Setting value "22" added for Pr.52
• Setting value "22" added for Pr.178 to Pr.189 Function/
Orientation control Communication/
• Setting values "27, 28, 127, and 128" added for Pr.190 to Pr.196
• Setting values "27, 28, 127, and 128" added for Pr.313 to Pr.319 Maintenance 5
• Setting values "27 and 28" added for Pr.320 to Pr.322
• Setting value "22" added for Pr.774 to Pr.776
• Setting value "22" added for Pr.992
• Setting value "22" added for Pr.1027 to Pr.1034 6
The E800-EPC models are added. Connection/
EtherCAT communication Function/
Added parameters
specifications Communication/
• Pr.1305 Maintenance 7
Added parameters
• Pr.136, Pr.139, Pr.514, Pr.515, Pr.523, Pr.524, and Pr.1013
Setting values
• Setting value "68" added for Pr.52 8
• Setting value "84" added for Pr.178 to Pr.189
Connection/
Emergency drive (except for the • Setting values "18, 19, 65, 66, 165, and 166" added for Pr.190 to Pr.196
Function/
E800-SCE inverters) • Setting values "18, 19, 65, 66, 165, and 166" added for Pr.313 to Pr.319
• Setting values "18, 19, 65, and 66" added for Pr.320 to Pr.322
Maintenance
9
• Setting value "68" added for Pr.774 to Pr.776
• Setting value "68" added for Pr.992
• Setting value "68" added for Pr.1027 to Pr.1034
ED (Emergency drive) warning added 10
Simple positioning using CiA402 drive profile
Added parameters
• Pr.1220 added
Setting values
• Setting values added for Pr.1320 to Pr.1329
[E800-(SC)EPA][E800-(SC)EPB] "24672, 24689, 24698, 24703, 24705, 24707,
24708, 24719, 24721, and 24728 to 24730"
[E800-EPC] "12288 to 13787, 20488, 20489, 24642, 24646, 24648 to 24650, 24672,
24677 to 24680, 24689, 24698, 24702, 24703, 24705, 24707 to 24709, 24719,
24721, 24728 to 24730, 24831, and 9999"
Ethernet communication • Setting values added for Pr.1330 to Pr.1343
[E800-(SC)EPA][E800-(SC)EPB] "20992, 24639, 24643, 24644, 24673 to 24676, Communication
specifications
24692, 24695, 24820, 24826, 24828, and 25858"
[E800-EPC] "12288 to 13787, 16384 to 16483, 20488, 20489, 20981 to 20990,
20992, 24639, 24643, 24644, 24673 to 24676, 24692, 24695, 24820, 24826, 24828,
25858, and 9999"
User defined cyclic communication specifications
Added parameters
• Pr.1389 to Pr.1398
Ethernet relay operation at reset selection
Added parameter
• Pr.1386
Parameters added for the second functions
Parameters Function
• Pr.1298 and Pr.1299
6. Appendix
6.1 How to check specification changes
287
Functions available for the inverters manufactured in September 2021 or
later
• Firmware version: 6 or later
Item Details Related manuals
Added parameters
• Pr.726 and Pr.727
Setting values
• Setting values "81, 82, and 84 to 86" added for Pr.52, Pr.774 to Pr.776, and Pr.1027
BACnet MS/TP communication to Pr.1034 Function/
specifications • Setting values "81 to 86" added for Pr.992 Communication
• Setting value "85" added for Pr.54
• Setting value "86" added for Pr.158
• Setting values "82 and 182" added for Pr.190 and Pr.191
• Setting value "2" added for Pr.549
288 6. Appendix
6.1 How to check specification changes
Functions available for the inverters manufactured in November 2022 or
later
1
• Firmware version: 11 or later
Item Details Related manuals 2
200 V class: 0.1 kW to 0.4 kW are added. Connection/
EM-A motor capacity
400 V class: 2.2 kW is added. Function
Added parameters
Position accuracy • Pr.979 to Pr.981
Function
3
compensation gain tuning Setting values
• Setting value "301" added for Pr.96
Setting values
Anti-sway control function
• Setting value "54" added for Pr.178 to Pr.189
Function
4
BACnet/IP and BACnet MS/TP
Network Port Object is added. Communication
communication specifications
PROFINET communication
specifications
E.SAF can be reset by bit 7 of Control word 1 (STW1). Communication 5
10
6. Appendix
6.1 How to check specification changes
289
MEMO
290 6. Appendix
6.1 How to check specification changes
Warranty
When using this product, make sure to understand the warranty described below.
291
Revisions
*The manual number is given on the bottom left of the back cover.
Revision date *Manual number Revision
Dec. 2019 IB(NA)-0600871ENG-A First edition
Apr. 2020 IB(NA)-0600871ENG-B Added
• FR-E820S-0008(0.1K) to 0110(2.2K)(E/SCE)
• FR-E800-SCE (safety communication model)
Jun. 2020 IB(NA)-0600871ENG-C Added
• How to check specification changes
Jun. 2020 IB(NA)-0600871ENG-D Added
• Vector control
• Parameter unit (FR-PU07)
• EtherNet/IP: Inverter Configuration Object (64h)
• PROFINET: Inverter parameters, monitor data, and inverter control parameters
Nov. 2020 IB(NA)-0600871ENG-E Added
• FR-E820-0470(11K) to 0900(22K)(E)(SCE), FR-E840-0230(11K) to 0440(22K)(E)(SCE)
• Position control (Vector control)
• User defined cyclic communication (Pr.1318, Pr.1319, Pr.1320 to Pr.1343)
• MODBUS/TCP: CiA402 drive profile (speed control)
• Backup/restore
Apr. 2021 IB(NA)-0600871ENG-F Added
• FR-E800-EPC (EtherCAT)
• CC-Link IE TSN, MODBUS/TCP, EtherNet/IP, and PROFINET: CiA402 drive profile (torque control
and position control)
• User defined cyclic communication (Pr.1389 to Pr.1398)
Jul. 2021 IB(NA)-0600871ENG-G Added
• BACnet MS/TP
Mar. 2022 IB(NA)-0600871ENG-H Added
• CC-Link IE TSN communication specifications (Pr.1210)
• EtherNet/IP instance 21216 (Speed scale (numerator)) and instance 21217 (Speed scale
(denominator))
Aug. 2022 IB(NA)-0600871ENG-J Added
• FR-E810W-0008(0.1K) to 0050(0.75K)(E)(SCE)
Sep. 2022 IB(NA)-0600871ENG-K Added
• Network port for BACnet/IP and BACnet MS/TP
292 IB-0600871ENG-K
INVERTER
INVERTER
FR-E800
FR-E800
Instruction Manual (Communication)
Compact, high functionality inverters
FR-E800 Instruction
Model
Manual (Communication)
HEAD OFFICE: TOKYO BUILDING 2-7-3, MARUNOUCHI, CHIYODA-KU, TOKYO 100-8310, JAPAN